Docs typo in index entry. Fixes: #1551
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45. Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.83"
49.include ./local_params
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54.macro copyyear
552014
56.endmacro
57
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60. provided in the xfpt library.
61. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76. --- index entry.
77
78.macro option
79.arg 5
80.oindex "&%$5%&"
81.endarg
82.arg -5
83.oindex "&%$1%&"
84.endarg
85.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87.endtable
88.endmacro
89
90. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92. --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94.macro table2 196pt 254pt
95.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96.endmacro
97
98. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102.macro irow
103.arg 4
104.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105.endarg
106.arg -4
107.arg 3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109.endarg
110.arg -3
111.row "&I;$1" "$2"
112.endarg
113.endarg
114.endmacro
115
116. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119. --- ID that ties them together.
120
121.macro cindex
122&<indexterm role="concept">&
123&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124.arg 2
125&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126.endarg
127&</indexterm>&
128.endmacro
129
130.macro scindex
131&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133.arg 3
134&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135.endarg
136&</indexterm>&
137.endmacro
138
139.macro ecindex
140&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141.endmacro
142
143.macro oindex
144&<indexterm role="option">&
145&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146.arg 2
147&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148.endarg
149&</indexterm>&
150.endmacro
151
152.macro vindex
153&<indexterm role="variable">&
154&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155.arg 2
156&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157.endarg
158&</indexterm>&
159.endmacro
160
161.macro index
162.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163.endmacro
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169. output formats.
170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172.literal xml
173<bookinfo>
174<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176<date>
177.fulldate
178</date>
179<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181<revhistory><revision>
182.versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184</revision></revhistory>
185<copyright><year>
186.copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188</bookinfo>
189.literal off
190
191
192. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199.literal xml
200
201<indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204</indexterm>
205<indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209</indexterm>
210<indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213</indexterm>
214<indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217</indexterm>
218<indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221</indexterm>
222<indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225</indexterm>
226<indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230</indexterm>
231<indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234</indexterm>
235<indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238</indexterm>
239<indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242</indexterm>
243<indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246</indexterm>
247<indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251</indexterm>
252<indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255</indexterm>
256<indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259</indexterm>
260<indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263</indexterm>
264<indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267</indexterm>
268<indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271</indexterm>
272<indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275</indexterm>
276<indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279</indexterm>
280<indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283</indexterm>
284<indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287</indexterm>
288<indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291</indexterm>
292<indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295</indexterm>
296<indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299</indexterm>
300<indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303</indexterm>
304<indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308</indexterm>
309<indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312</indexterm>
313<indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316</indexterm>
317<indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320</indexterm>
321
322.literal off
323
324
325. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327. we can't have the .chapter line here.
328. chapter "Introduction"
329. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368contributors.
369
370
371.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374.new
375.cindex "documentation"
376This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379capable of showing a change indicator.
380.wen
381
382This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389very wide interest.
390
391.cindex "books about Exim"
392An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395(&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404Debian-specific features in the file
405&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407information.
408
409.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411.cindex "change log"
412As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429directory are:
430
431.table2 100pt
432.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439.endtable
440
441The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447.section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448.cindex "web site"
449.cindex "FTP site"
450The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453&%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454&%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457.cindex "wiki"
458.cindex "FAQ"
459As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465.cindex Bugzilla
466An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476.table2 140pt
477.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481.endtable
482
483You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488via this web page:
489.display
490&url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491.endd
492Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493lists.
494
495.section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496.cindex "training courses"
497Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503.cindex "bug reports"
504.cindex "reporting bugs"
505Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513.cindex "FTP site"
514.cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516.display
517&*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518.endd
519This is mirrored by
520.display
521&*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522.endd
523The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531.display
532&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534.endd
535where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540.cindex "distribution" "public key"
541.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544&'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548&_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554&url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561.display
562&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564.endd
565For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573.display
574&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578.endd
579These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584.ilist
585.cindex "limitations of Exim"
586.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592.next
593.cindex "domainless addresses"
594.cindex "address" "without domain"
595Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599arrival.
600.next
601.cindex "transport" "external"
602.cindex "external transports"
603The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609.next
610Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613other means.
614.next
615Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619a number of common scanners are provided.
620.endlist
621
622
623.section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6403, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652.cindex "terminology definitions"
653.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656below) by a blank line.
657
658.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665rise to further bounce messages.
666
667The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670otherwise.
671
672The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675until a later time.
676
677The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681.cindex "envelope, definition of"
682.cindex "sender" "definition of"
683A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691.cindex "header section" "definition of"
692The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696line.
697
698.cindex "local part" "definition of"
699.cindex "domain" "definition of"
700The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711.cindex "return path" "definition of"
712&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713message's envelope.
714
715.cindex "queue" "definition of"
716The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743.cindex "incorporated code"
744.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745.cindex "PCRE"
746.cindex "OpenDMARC"
747A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749.ilist
750Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756.next
757.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762following statements:
763
764.blockquote
765Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770version.
771This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775restrictions applied to it).
776.endblockquote
777.next
778.cindex "SPA authentication"
779.cindex "Samba project"
780.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784under the Gnu GPL.
785.next
786.cindex "Cyrus"
787.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792conditions expressed therein.
793
794.blockquote
795Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799are met:
800
801.olist
802Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804.next
805Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808distribution.
809.next
810The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813details, please contact
814.display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821.endd
822.next
823Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824acknowledgment:
825
826&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836.endlist
837.endblockquote
838
839.next
840.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841.cindex "X-windows"
842.cindex "Athena"
843The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848.blockquote
849Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852All Rights Reserved
853
854Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868SOFTWARE.
869.endblockquote
870
871.next
872.cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877source code.
878
879.next
880Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883.endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897.cindex "design philosophy"
898Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907.cindex "policy control" "overview"
908Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914.ilist
915.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924error code.
925.next
926An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928.next
929When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933.next
934When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939.next
940Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943.next
944After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946runs at the start of every delivery process.
947.endlist
948
949
950
951.section "User filters" "SECID12"
952.cindex "filter" "introduction"
953.cindex "Sieve filter"
954In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959of filtering are available:
960
961.ilist
962Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963by RFC 3028.
964.next
965Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967.endlist
968
969User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975.cindex "format" "of message id"
976.cindex "id of message"
977.cindex "base62"
978.cindex "base36"
979.cindex "Darwin"
980.cindex "Cygwin"
981Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988not always case-sensitive.
989
990.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996somewhat eccentric:
997
998.ilist
999The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002way of representing the date and time of day).
1003.next
1004After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005received the message.
1006.next
1007There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008.olist
1009.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014.next
1015If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017(1/100) of a second.
1018.endlist
1019.endlist
1020
1021After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029.cindex "receiving mail"
1030.cindex "message" "reception"
1031The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034there are several possibilities:
1035
1036.ilist
1037If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040.next
1041If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047.next
1048If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053.next
1054A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058.endlist
1059
1060
1061.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077(either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112affect file system performance.
1113
1114The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136.cindex "message" "life of"
1137.cindex "message" "frozen"
1138A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150to be sent.
1151
1152.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158.cindex "message" "log file for"
1159.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168systems.
1169
1170.cindex "journal file"
1171.cindex "file" "journal"
1172All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191.cindex "router" "definition of"
1192.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207the driver's features in general.
1208
1209A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213to be bounced.
1214
1215A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232configuration.
1233
1234The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242configured to fail the address.
1243
1244The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261.cindex "router" "for verification"
1262.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267&%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282.cindex "router" "running details"
1283.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284.cindex "router" "result of running"
1285As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289the following:
1290
1291.ilist
1292&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294original address ceases,
1295.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300end of routing.
1301
1302Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307.next
1308&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313.next
1314&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319.next
1320&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323.next
1324&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328.next
1329&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331.endlist
1332
1333If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347.cindex "case of local parts"
1348.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365.ilist
1366The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371of any other conditions.
1372.next
1373Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376address.
1377Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382.next
1383If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388.next
1389Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392.next
1393Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395.next
1396If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397of domains that it defines.
1398.next
1399.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408&$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409.next
1410.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412.vindex "&$home$&"
1413If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417remaining preconditions.
1418.next
1419If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423could lead to confusion.
1424.next
1425If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426set of addresses that it defines.
1427.next
1428If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429specified files is tested.
1430.next
1431.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435.endlist
1436
1437
1438Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452.ilist
1453If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458filtering'&.
1459.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468filter.
1469.next
1470Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474processed entirely independently of each other.
1475.next
1476.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485.next
1486When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493addresses to the same domain.
1494.next
1495Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503.next
1504.cindex "queue runner"
1505When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514.next
1515.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521.next
1522If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525messages to other addresses.
1526.next
1527.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530&'deferred'&.
1531.next
1532When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535.endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543.cindex "queue runner"
1544Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551passed its retry time.
1552You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572also apply.
1573
1574If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577deferred,
1578.cindex "hints database"
1579Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602automatically.
1603
1604.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637&_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639.table2 140pt
1640.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648.endtable
1649
1650Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653.table2 140pt
1654.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661.endtable
1662
1663The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674system.
1675.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683.cindex "PCRE library"
1684Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692If your operating system has no
1693PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725possibilities:
1726
1727.olist
1728A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730.next
1731.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735file name is used unmodified.
1736.next
1737.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741.next
1742If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745.next
1746To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17482.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752.next
1753.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755&url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756operates on a single file.
1757.endlist
1758
1759.cindex "USE_DB"
1760.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765.code
1766USE_DB=yes
1767.endd
1768Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780in one of these lines:
1781.code
1782DBMLIB = -ldb
1783DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784.endd
1785Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789this example:
1790.code
1791INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793.endd
1794There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825be logged.
1826
1827.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830facilities, you need to set
1831.code
1832WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833.endd
1834in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857.cindex "RFC 2047"
1858The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863(default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868&url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871.code
1872HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873.endd
1874to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881.cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888line option).
1889
1890If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892implementing SSL.
1893
1894If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895.code
1896SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898.endd
1899in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901.code
1902SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905.endd
1906.cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908.code
1909SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911.endd
1912.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914.code
1915SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918.endd
1919in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920library and include files. For example:
1921.code
1922SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926.endd
1927.cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929.code
1930SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933.endd
1934
1935You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956you might have
1957.code
1958USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961.endd
1962in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964.code
1965exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966.endd
1967in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971&_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973further details.
1974
1975
1976.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982library files.
1983
1984Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1989if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1990this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1991support has not been tested for some time.
1992
1993
1994
1995.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996.cindex "lookup modules"
1997.cindex "dynamic modules"
1998.cindex ".so building"
1999On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2001on demand.
2002This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2004dependencies.
2005Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2006
2007Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2013
2014Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2017on demand:
2018.code
2019LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2020LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2021LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2022.endd
2023
2024
2025.section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026.cindex "build directory"
2027Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2034
2035&*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2036building process fails if it is set.
2037
2038If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2039a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2040&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2041&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2042then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2043number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2044makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2045directory, should this ever be necessary.
2046
2047If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2048&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2049FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2050
2051
2052
2053.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2054The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2055unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2056output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2057appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2058each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2059get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2060.code
2061FULLECHO='' make -e
2062.endd
2063The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2064command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2065given in addition to the short output.
2066
2067
2068
2069.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2070.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2071The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2072consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2073values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2074more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2075convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2076order:
2077.display
2078&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2079&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2080&_Local/Makefile_&
2081&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2082&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2083&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2084&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2085.endd
2086.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2087.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2088.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2089where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2090architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2091process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2092and are often not needed.
2093
2094The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2095called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2096the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2097values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2098Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2099fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2100of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2101that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2102to find out what values are being used on your system.
2103
2104
2105&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2106therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2107needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2108file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2109default values are.
2110
2111
2112.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2113If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2114or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2115need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2116putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2117.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2118when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2119formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2120compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2121called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2122Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2123default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2124containing the lines
2125.code
2126CC=cc
2127CFLAGS=-std1
2128.endd
2129If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2130these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2131
2132Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2133files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2134the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2135
2136
2137.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2138.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2139.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2140.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2141Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2142lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2143not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2144and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2145which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2146case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2147.code
2148LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2149LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2150LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2151.endd
2152and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2153&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2154libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2155.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2156However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2157the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2158files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2159binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2160errors.
2161
2162.cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2163.cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2164Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2165about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2166being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2167makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2168variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2169name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2170&'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2171with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2172syntax. For instance:
2173.code
2174LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2175LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2176AUTH_GSASL=yes
2177AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2178AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2179AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2180.endd
2181
2182.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2183Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2184subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2185.code
2186EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2187.endd
2188must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2189chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2190
2191.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2192The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2193operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2194with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2195monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2196The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2197.code
2198X11=/usr/X11R6
2199XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2200XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2201.endd
2202These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2203example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2204.code
2205X11=/usr/openwin
2206XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2207XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2208.endd
2209If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2210definition of all three of these variables into your
2211&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2212
2213.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2214If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2215variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2216default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2217command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2218
2219.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2220There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2221use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2222EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2223binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2224libraries.
2225
2226.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2227The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2228files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2229necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2230&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2231
2232
2233.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2234.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2235.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2236The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2237&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2238normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2239recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2240are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2241
2242
2243
2244.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2245.cindex "building Eximon"
2246A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2247where the files that are involved are
2248.display
2249&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2250&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2251&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2252&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2253&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2254&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2255.endd
2256.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2257As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2258&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2259&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2260variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2261EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2262LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2263.ecindex IIDbuex
2264
2265
2266.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2267.cindex "installing Exim"
2268.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2269The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2270arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2271whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2272.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2273The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2274going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2275&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2276install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2277some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2278it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2279chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2280
2281.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2282Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2283in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2284exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2285by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2286is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2287alternative files, no default is installed.
2288
2289.cindex "system aliases file"
2290.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2291One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2292default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2293The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2294SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2295If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2296and outputs a comment to the user.
2297
2298The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2299aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2300kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2301&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2302Exim's configuration if necessary.
2303
2304The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2305and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2306running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2307directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2308other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2309over SMTP.
2310
2311It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2312distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2313command such as
2314.code
2315make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2316.endd
2317This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2318paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2319configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2320For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2321but this usage is deprecated.
2322
2323.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2324Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2325&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2326upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2327directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2328INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2329
2330For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2331to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2332installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2333for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2334called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2335of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2336from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2337
2338.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2339If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2340real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2341command:
2342.code
2343make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2344.endd
2345The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2346script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2347the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2348directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2349command:
2350.code
2351(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2352.endd
2353.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2354There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2355
2356.ilist
2357&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2358to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2359.next
2360&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2361installed binary.
2362.endlist
2363
2364INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2365.code
2366make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2367.endd
2368The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2369to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2370without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2371.code
2372make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2373.endd
2374
2375
2376
2377.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2378.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2379Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2380reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2381distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2382&<<SECTavail>>&).
2383
2384If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2385source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2386install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2387
2388
2389
2390.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2391.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2392When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2393exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2394directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2395necessary.
2396
2397
2398
2399
2400.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2401.cindex "testing" "installation"
2402Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2403syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2404Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2405.code
2406exim -bV
2407.endd
2408If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2409Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2410the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2411other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2412Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2413example,
2414.display
2415&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2416.endd
2417should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2418.display
2419&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2420.endd
2421a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2422This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2423user agent. For example:
2424.code
2425exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2426From: user@your.domain.example
2427To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2428Subject: Testing Exim
2429
2430This is a test message.
2431^D
2432.endd
2433The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2434In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2435arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2436
2437.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2438If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2439&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2440of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2441&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2442with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2443.display
2444&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2445.endd
2446You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2447produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2448For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2449relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2450&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2451
2452.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2453.cindex "lock files"
2454One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2455local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2456&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2457writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2458is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2459directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2460that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2461&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2462approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2463&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2464agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2465see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2466
2467One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2468the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2469&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2470port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2471&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2472incoming SMTP mail.
2473
2474Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2475be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2476within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2477that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2478production version.
2479
2480
2481.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2482.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2483Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2484general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2485is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2486operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2487binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2488normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2489or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2490.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2491a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2492privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2493and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2494
2495.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2496.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2497Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2498example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2499&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2500described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2501as follows:
2502.code
2503sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2504send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2505mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2506newaliases /usr/bin/true
2507.endd
2508Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2509your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2510favourite user agent.
2511
2512You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2513have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2514various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2515command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2516use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2517&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2518
2519
2520
2521.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2522.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2523If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2524version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2525call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2526to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2527new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2528version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2529configuration file.
2530
2531
2532
2533
2534.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2535.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2536The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2537.code
2538/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2539.endd
2540If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2541fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2542for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2543(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2544solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2545.code
2546pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2547.endd
2548to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2549
2550Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2551still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2552(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2553
2554
2555
2556
2557. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2558. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2559
2560.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2561.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2562.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2563Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2564each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2565options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2566some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2567combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2568The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2569
2570
2571.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2572.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2573If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2574were present before any other options.
2575The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2576standard output.
2577This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2578that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2579&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2580
2581.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2582If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2583were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2584&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2585format.
2586
2587.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2588If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2589&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2590Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2591
2592.cindex "&'runq'&"
2593.cindex "queue runner"
2594If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2595were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2596option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2597
2598.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2599.cindex "alias file" "building"
2600.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2601If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2602&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2603This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2604the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2605command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2606
2607
2608.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2609Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2610available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2611user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2612EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2613&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2614
2615.ilist
2616.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2617.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2618The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2619&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2620supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2621configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2622
2623.cindex '&"From"& line'
2624.cindex "envelope sender"
2625Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2626&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2627Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2628See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2629users to set envelope senders.
2630
2631.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2632.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2633For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2634header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2635&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2636
2637Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2638protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2639locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2640have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2641users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2642that are available to trusted users.
2643.next
2644.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2645.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2646The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2647Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2648The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2649
2650Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2651operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2652necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2653the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2654
2655By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2656Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2657However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2658option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2659
2660Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2661is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2662false.
2663.endlist
2664
2665
2666&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2667edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2668getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2669&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2670
2671
2672
2673
2674.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2675Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2676of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2677a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2678format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2679on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2680with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2681outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2682
2683. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2684. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2685. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2686. creates a man page for the options.
2687. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2688
2689.literal xml
2690<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2691.literal off
2692
2693
2694.vlist
2695.vitem &%--%&
2696.oindex "--"
2697.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2698This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2699therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2700rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2701
2702.vitem &%--help%&
2703.oindex "&%--help%&"
2704This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2705The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2706no arguments.
2707
2708.vitem &%--version%&
2709.oindex "&%--version%&"
2710This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2711displayed.
2712
2713.vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2714 &%-Am%&
2715.oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2716.oindex "&%-Am%&"
2717These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2718ignored by Exim.
2719
2720.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2721.oindex "&%-B%&"
2722.cindex "8-bit characters"
2723.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2724This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2725clean; it ignores this option.
2726
2727.vitem &%-bd%&
2728.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2729.cindex "daemon"
2730.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2731.cindex "queue runner"
2732This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2733the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2734that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2735
2736The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2737(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2738disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2739stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2740
2741By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2742all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2743ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2744&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2745
2746When a listening daemon
2747.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2748.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2749is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2750configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2751in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2752PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2753running as root.
2754
2755When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2756process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2757used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2758
2759The SIGHUP signal
2760.cindex "SIGHUP"
2761.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2762can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2763whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2764means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2765of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2766referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2767because these are reread each time they are used.
2768
2769.vitem &%-bdf%&
2770.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2771This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2772from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2773
2774.vitem &%-be%&
2775.oindex "&%-be%&"
2776.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2777.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2778Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2779prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2780files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2781of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2782
2783If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2784to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2785used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2786function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2787test data. A line history is supported.
2788
2789Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2790continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2791continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2792string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2793configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2794message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2795is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2796
2797&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2798files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2799the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2800of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2801
2802.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2803.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2804.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2805.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2806This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2807of a file. For example:
2808.code
2809exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2810.endd
2811The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2812message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2813variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2814no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2815recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2816&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2817line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2818&%-be%&).
2819
2820.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2821.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2822.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2823.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2824This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2825tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2826system filters are recognized.
2827
2828.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2829.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2830.cindex "filter" "testing"
2831.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2832.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2833.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2834.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2835This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2836to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2837there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2838supplied.
2839
2840If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2841can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2842filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2843.code
2844exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2845.endd
2846This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2847variables that are used by the user filter.
2848
2849If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2850.code
2851# Exim filter
2852# Sieve filter
2853.endd
2854it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2855that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2856&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2857redirection lists.
2858
2859The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2860detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2861with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2862separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2863
2864When testing a filter file,
2865.cindex "&""From""& line"
2866.cindex "envelope sender"
2867.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2868the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2869or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2870that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2871can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2872options).
2873
2874.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2875.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2876.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2877This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2878tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2879&$qualify_domain$&.
2880
2881.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2882.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2883This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2884tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2885process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2886suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2887actually being delivered.
2888
2889.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2890.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2891This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2892file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2893prefix.
2894
2895.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2896.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2897This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2898file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2899suffix.
2900
2901.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2902.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2903.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2904.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2905.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2906.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2907.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2908.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2909This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2910standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2911after a full stop. For example:
2912.code
2913exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2914exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2915.endd
2916When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2917of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2918conversion to the canonical form is
2919&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2920
2921Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2922include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2923This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2924messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2925test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2926
2927&*Warning 1*&:
2928.cindex "RFC 1413"
2929You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2930information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2931an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2932connection.
2933
2934&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2935are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2936occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2937
2938Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2939written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2940lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2941can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2942and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2943session were authenticated.
2944
2945The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2946output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2947acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2948
2949Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2950plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2951specialized SMTP test program such as
2952&url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2953
2954.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2955.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2956This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2957verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2958updating the callout cache database.
2959
2960.vitem &%-bi%&
2961.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2962.cindex "alias file" "building"
2963.cindex "building alias file"
2964.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2965Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2966Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2967this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2968tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2969recognized.
2970
2971If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2972configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2973the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2974The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2975use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2976if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2977&%-bi%& is a no-op.
2978
2979. // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2980.vitem &%-bI:help%&
2981.oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2982.cindex "querying exim information"
2983We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2984information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2985consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2986synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2987options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2988
2989.vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2990.oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2991.cindex "DSCP" "values"
2992This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2993recognised DSCP names.
2994
2995.vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2996.oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2997.cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2998This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2999Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3000useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3001&`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3002compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3003way to guarantee a correct response.
3004
3005.vitem &%-bm%&
3006.oindex "&%-bm%&"
3007.cindex "local message reception"
3008This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3009locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3010command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3011argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3012default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3013if no other conflicting option is present.
3014
3015If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3016qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3017options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3018suppressing this for special cases.
3019
3020Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3021the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3022
3023.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3024The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3025action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3026
3027The format
3028.cindex "message" "format"
3029.cindex "format" "message"
3030.cindex "&""From""& line"
3031.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3032.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3033of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3034compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3035.code
3036From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3037From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3038.endd
3039(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3040is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3041authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3042matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3043option, which can be changed if necessary.
3044
3045.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3046The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3047&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3048preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3049trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3050
3051.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3052.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3053.cindex "testing", "malware"
3054.cindex "malware scan test"
3055This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3056using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3057this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3058the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3059not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3060will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3061
3062Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3063using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3064user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3065This option requires admin privileges.
3066
3067The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3068there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3069administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3070
3071.vitem &%-bnq%&
3072.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3073.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3074By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3075without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3076is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3077envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3078&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3079defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3080
3081Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3082being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3083content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3084header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3085syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3086
3087The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3088messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3089addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3090unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3091
3092
3093.vitem &%-bP%&
3094.oindex "&%-bP%&"
3095.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3096.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3097If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3098main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3099of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3100arguments, for example:
3101.code
3102exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3103.endd
3104.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3105.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3106.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3107However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3108configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3109users, the output is as in this example:
3110.code
3111mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3112.endd
3113If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3114configuration file is output.
3115If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3116is the name of the file that was actually used.
3117
3118.cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3119If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3120name will not be output.
3121
3122.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3123.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3124If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3125directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3126respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3127sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3128written directly into the spool directory.
3129
3130If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3131.code
3132exim -bP +local_domains
3133.endd
3134it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3135local part) and outputs what it finds.
3136
3137.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3138.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3139.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3140If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3141followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3142that driver are output. For example:
3143.code
3144exim -bP transport local_delivery
3145.endd
3146The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3147options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3148using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3149&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3150settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3151&%authenticators%&.
3152
3153.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3154If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3155are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3156for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3157The output format is one item per line.
3158
3159.vitem &%-bp%&
3160.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3161.cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3162.cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3163This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3164standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3165just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3166admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3167to allow any user to see the queue.
3168
3169Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3170.code
317125m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3172 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3173 <other addresses>
3174.endd
3175.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3176.cindex "size" "of message"
3177The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3178(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3179identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3180envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3181&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3182the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3183before the sender address.
3184
3185.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3186If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3187&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3188
3189The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3190displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3191been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3192expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3193displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3194complete.
3195
3196
3197.vitem &%-bpa%&
3198.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3199This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3200that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3201alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3202of just &"D"&.
3203
3204
3205.vitem &%-bpc%&
3206.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3207.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3208This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3209to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3210&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3211
3212
3213.vitem &%-bpr%&
3214.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3215This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3216chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3217lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3218going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3219
3220.vitem &%-bpra%&
3221.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3222This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3223
3224.vitem &%-bpru%&
3225.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3226This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3227
3228
3229.vitem &%-bpu%&
3230.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3231This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3232addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3233forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3234router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3235
3236
3237.vitem &%-brt%&
3238.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3239.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3240.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3241This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3242arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3243and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3244.code
3245exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3246Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3247.endd
3248See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3249argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3250&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3251contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3252retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3253with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3254rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3255sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3256used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3257.code
3258exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3259Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3260.endd
3261
3262.vitem &%-brw%&
3263.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3264.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3265.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3266This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3267a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3268complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3269would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3270&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3271
3272.vitem &%-bS%&
3273.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3274.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3275.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3276This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3277for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3278submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3279input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3280input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3281&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3282believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3283
3284The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3285dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3286provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3287
3288As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3289messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3290Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3291&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3292
3293Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3294as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3295QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3296
3297.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3298If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3299error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3300was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3301was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3302
3303More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3304&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3305
3306.vitem &%-bs%&
3307.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3308.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3309.cindex "local SMTP input"
3310This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3311on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3312policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3313Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3314messages to the MTA.
3315
3316In
3317.cindex "sender" "source of"
3318this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3319set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3320Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3321the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3322&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3323&%-bnq%& option is used.
3324
3325.cindex "inetd"
3326The
3327&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3328using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3329whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3330&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3331above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3332Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3333the listening daemon.
3334
3335.vitem &%-bt%&
3336.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3337.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3338.cindex "address" "testing"
3339This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3340as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3341written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3342user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3343sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3344
3345If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3346right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3347
3348Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3349&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3350security issues.
3351
3352Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3353(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3354written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3355&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3356genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3357program.
3358
3359.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3360The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3361failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3362code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3363
3364.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3365&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3366addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3367This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3368always shown.
3369
3370&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3371routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3372message,
3373.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3374you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3375&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3376default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3377whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3378those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3379doing such tests.
3380
3381.vitem &%-bV%&
3382.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3383.cindex "version number of Exim"
3384This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3385number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3386It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3387specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3388name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3389
3390As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3391configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3392values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3393detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3394alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3395realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3396dynamic testing facilities.
3397
3398.vitem &%-bv%&
3399.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3400.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3401.cindex "address" "verification"
3402This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3403taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3404not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3405happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3406(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3407including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3408
3409If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3410failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3411usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3412
3413If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3414right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3415
3416Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3417&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3418security issues.
3419
3420Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3421that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3422router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3423verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3424address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3425
3426If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3427address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3428latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3429causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3430addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3431and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3432to succeed.
3433
3434When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3435and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3436considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3437
3438The
3439.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3440return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3441failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3442code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3443
3444If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3445address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3446sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3447calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3448
3449.vitem &%-bvs%&
3450.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3451This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3452than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3453might happen.
3454
3455.vitem &%-bw%&
3456.oindex "&%-bw%&"
3457.cindex "daemon"
3458.cindex "inetd"
3459.cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3460This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3461similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3462and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3463
3464In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3465listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3466inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3467each port only when the first connection is received.
3468
3469If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3470which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3471
3472.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3473.oindex "&%-C%&"
3474.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3475.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3476.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3477This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3478list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3479compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3480name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3481file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3482proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3483
3484When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3485from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3486runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3487However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3488file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3489which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3490listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3491CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3492not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3493
3494Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3495configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3496even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3497running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3498delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3499test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3500on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3501
3502If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3503prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3504must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3505However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3506CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3507usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3508unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3509
3510ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3511to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3512broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3513configuration file.
3514
3515The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3516syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3517caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3518require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3519specified by this option.
3520
3521
3522.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3523.oindex "&%-D%&"
3524.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3525This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3526(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3527unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3528If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3529completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3530
3531If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3532colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3533supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3534not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3535the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3536to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3537regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3538
3539The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3540command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3541string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3542synonymous:
3543.code
3544exim -DABC ...
3545exim -DABC= ...
3546.endd
3547To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3548quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3549example:
3550.code
3551exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3552.endd
3553&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3554
3555
3556.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3557.oindex "&%-d%&"
3558.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3559.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3560This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3561error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3562database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3563filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3564writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3565return code.
3566
3567When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3568standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3569some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3570made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3571of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3572debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3573no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3574are:
3575.display
3576&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3577&`auth `& authenticators
3578&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3579&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3580&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3581&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3582&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3583&`filter `& filter handling
3584&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3585&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3586&`ident `& ident lookup
3587&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3588&`lists `& matching things in lists
3589&`load `& system load checks
3590&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3591 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3592&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3593&`memory `& memory handling
3594&`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3595&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3596&`queue_run `& queue runs
3597&`receive `& general message reception logic
3598&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3599&`retry `& retry handling
3600&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3601&`route `& address routing
3602&`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3603&`tls `& TLS logic
3604&`transport `& transports
3605&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3606&`verify `& address verification logic
3607&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3608.endd
3609The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3610for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3611tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3612is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3613generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3614turn everything off.
3615
3616.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3617.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3618The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3619with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3620unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3621rather than stderr.
3622
3623The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3624&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3625However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3626daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3627automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3628run in parallel.
3629
3630The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3631of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3632in processing.
3633
3634If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3635any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3636
3637.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3638.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3639This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3640starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3641subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3642behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3643
3644.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3645.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3646This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3647handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3648described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3649
3650.vitem &%-E%&
3651.oindex "&%-E%&"
3652.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3653This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3654failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3655and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3656generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3657could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3658follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3659new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3660
3661.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3662.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3663There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3664called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3665example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3666form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3667
3668.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3669.oindex "&%-F%&"
3670.cindex "sender" "name"
3671.cindex "name" "of sender"
3672This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3673message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3674entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3675their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3676between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3677
3678.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3679.oindex "&%-f%&"
3680.cindex "sender" "address"
3681.cindex "address" "sender"
3682.cindex "trusted users"
3683.cindex "envelope sender"
3684.cindex "user" "trusted"
3685This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3686message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3687by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3688users to use it.
3689
3690Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3691trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3692options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3693of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3694domain.
3695
3696There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3697can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3698never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3699string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3700examples of shell commands:
3701.code
3702exim -f '<>' user@domain
3703exim -f "" user@domain
3704.endd
3705In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3706with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3707&%-bv%& options.
3708
3709Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3710it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3711refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3712though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3713
3714White
3715.cindex "&""From""& line"
3716space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3717given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3718locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3719&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3720if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3721
3722.vitem &%-G%&
3723.oindex "&%-G%&"
3724.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3725This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3726.code
3727control = suppress_local_fixups
3728.endd
3729for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3730bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3731in future.
3732
3733As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3734this option.
3735
3736.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3737.oindex "&%-h%&"
3738.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3739This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3740Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3741headers.)
3742
3743.vitem &%-i%&
3744.oindex "&%-i%&"
3745.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3746.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3747This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3748line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3749no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3750command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3751
3752.vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3753.oindex "&%-L%&"
3754.cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3755This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3756file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3757Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3758read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3759effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3760
3761The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3762
3763.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3764.oindex "&%-M%&"
3765.cindex "forcing delivery"
3766.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3767.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3768This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3769any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3770delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3771and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3772
3773Retry
3774.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3775hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3776the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3777to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3778which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3779for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3780
3781The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3782not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3783produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3784use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3785
3786.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3787.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3788.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3789.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3790This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3791message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3792id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3793active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3794can be used only by an admin user.
3795
3796.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3797 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3798.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3799.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3800.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3801.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3802This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3803by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3804an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3805given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3806must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3807
3808.vitem &%-MCA%&
3809.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3810This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3811by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3812connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3813
3814.vitem &%-MCP%&
3815.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3816This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3817by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3818which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3819
3820.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3821.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3822This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3823by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3824started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3825together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3826signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3827messages through the same SMTP connection.
3828
3829.vitem &%-MCS%&
3830.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3831This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3832by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3833SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3834connection.
3835
3836.vitem &%-MCT%&
3837.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3838This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3839by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3840host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3841
3842.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3843.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3844.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3845.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3846This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3847but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3848that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3849provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3850order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3851However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3852respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3853overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3854If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3855&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3856and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3857
3858.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3859.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3860.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3861.cindex "sender" "changing"
3862This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3863given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3864&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3865be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3866is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3867This option can be used only by an admin user.
3868
3869.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3870.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3871.cindex "freezing messages"
3872.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3873This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3874prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3875either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3876However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3877attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3878user.
3879
3880.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3881.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3882.cindex "giving up on messages"
3883.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3884.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3885This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3886including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3887their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3888is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3889Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3890user.
3891
3892.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3893.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3894.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3895This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3896as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3897message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3898altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3899
3900.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3901.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3902.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3903.cindex "recipient" "removing"
3904.cindex "removing recipients"
3905This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3906(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3907the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3908addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3909(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3910can be used only by an admin user.
3911
3912.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3913.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3914.cindex "removing messages"
3915.cindex "abandoning mail"
3916.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3917This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3918bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3919the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3920only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3921placed on the queue.
3922
3923.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3924.oindex "&%-Mset%&
3925.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3926.cindex "expansion" "testing"
3927This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3928string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3929the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3930&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3931available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3932make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3933user. See also &%-bem%&.
3934
3935.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3936.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3937.cindex "thawing messages"
3938.cindex "unfreezing messages"
3939.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3940.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3941This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3942&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3943messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3944by an admin user.
3945
3946.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3947.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3948.cindex "listing" "message body"
3949.cindex "message" "listing body of"
3950This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3951written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3952
3953.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3954.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3955.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3956.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3957This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3958be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3959only by an admin user.
3960
3961.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3962.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3963.cindex "listing" "message headers"
3964.cindex "header lines" "listing"
3965.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3966This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3967written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3968
3969.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3970.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3971.cindex "listing" "message log"
3972.cindex "message" "listing message log"
3973This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3974the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3975
3976.vitem &%-m%&
3977.oindex "&%-m%&"
3978This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3979treats it that way too.
3980
3981.vitem &%-N%&
3982.oindex "&%-N%&"
3983.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3984.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3985This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3986level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3987it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3988had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3989database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3990than &"=>"&.
3991
3992Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3993user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3994words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3995which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3996address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3997routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3998the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3999for that message.
4000
4001.vitem &%-n%&
4002.oindex "&%-n%&"
4003This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4004For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4005When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4006
4007.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4008.oindex "&%-O%&"
4009This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4010Exim.
4011
4012.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4013.oindex "&%-oA%&"
4014.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4015This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4016alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4017description above.
4018
4019.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4020.oindex "&%-oB%&"
4021.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4022.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4023.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4024This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4025be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4026transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4027
4028.vitem &%-odb%&
4029.oindex "&%-odb%&"
4030.cindex "background delivery"
4031.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4032This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4033including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4034messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4035delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4036processes to finish.
4037
4038When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4039leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4040and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4041This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4042
4043If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4044(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4045overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4046setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4047
4048.vitem &%-odf%&
4049.oindex "&%-odf%&"
4050.cindex "foreground delivery"
4051.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4052This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4053accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4054&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4055and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4056
4057The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4058process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4059during deliveries.
4060
4061However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4062false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4063
4064If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4065message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4066process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4067restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4068
4069
4070.vitem &%-odi%&
4071.oindex "&%-odi%&"
4072This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4073Sendmail.
4074
4075.vitem &%-odq%&
4076.oindex "&%-odq%&"
4077.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4078.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4079.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4080This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4081including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4082not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4083are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4084process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4085&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4086conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4087forces queueing.
4088
4089.vitem &%-odqs%&
4090.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4091.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4092This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4093However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4094&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4095configuration file is in effect.
4096
4097When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4098message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4099also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4100in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4101done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4102runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4103messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4104host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4105configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4106&%-qq%& option.
4107
4108.vitem &%-oee%&
4109.oindex "&%-oee%&"
4110.cindex "error" "reporting"
4111If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4112example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4113message.
4114
4115.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4116Provided
4117this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4118exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4119is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4120This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4121
4122.vitem &%-oem%&
4123.oindex "&%-oem%&"
4124.cindex "error" "reporting"
4125.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4126This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4127return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4128This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4129
4130.vitem &%-oep%&
4131.oindex "&%-oep%&"
4132.cindex "error" "reporting"
4133If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4134error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4135.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4136The return code is 1 for all errors.
4137
4138.vitem &%-oeq%&
4139.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4140.cindex "error" "reporting"
4141This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4142effect as &%-oep%&.
4143
4144.vitem &%-oew%&
4145.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4146.cindex "error" "reporting"
4147This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4148effect as &%-oem%&.
4149
4150.vitem &%-oi%&
4151.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4152.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4153This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4154line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4155single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4156lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4157&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4158
4159.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4160.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4161This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4162
4163.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4164.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4165.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4166A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4167with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4168over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4169&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4170other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4171
4172The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4173number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4174.code
4175exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4176.endd
4177An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4178followed by a colon and the port number:
4179.code
4180exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4181.endd
4182The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4183port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4184are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4185whichever one is last.
4186
4187.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4188.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4189.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4190See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4191option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4192name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4193This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4194authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4195
4196.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4197.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4198.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4199See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4200option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4201This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4202where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4203&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4204
4205.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4206.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4207.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4208See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4209option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4210overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4211messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4212default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4213specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4214&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4215
4216.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4217.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4218.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4219See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4220option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4221using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4222&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4223
4224.vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4225.oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4226.cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4227See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4228option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4229delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4230messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4231abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4232running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4233
4234The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4235The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4236is sending the bounce.
4237
4238.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4239.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4240.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4241.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4242See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4243option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4244&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4245or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4246SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4247&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4248one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4249be set by &%-oMr%&.
4250
4251.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4252.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4253.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4254See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4255option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4256present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4257uses the name it is given.
4258
4259.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4260.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4261.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4262See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4263option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4264local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4265used, when there is no default.
4266
4267.vitem &%-om%&
4268.oindex "&%-om%&"
4269.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4270In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4271message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4272expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4273
4274.vitem &%-oo%&
4275.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4276.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4277This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4278whatever that means.
4279
4280.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4281.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4282.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4283.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4284This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4285value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4286written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4287without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4288because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4289
4290.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4291.oindex "&%-or%&"
4292.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4293This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4294set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4295by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4296described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4297
4298.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4299.oindex "&%-os%&"
4300.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4301.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4302This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4303applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4304the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4305for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4306
4307.vitem &%-ov%&
4308.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4309This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4310
4311.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4312.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4313.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4314.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4315.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4316This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4317is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4318of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4319in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4320file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4321
4322.vitem &%-pd%&
4323.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4324.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4325This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4326chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4327option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4328needed.
4329
4330.vitem &%-ps%&
4331.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4332.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4333This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4334chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4335option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4336started.
4337
4338.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4339.oindex "&%-p%&"
4340For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4341.display
4342&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4343.endd
4344It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4345host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4346Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4347to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4348or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4349
4350.vitem &%-q%&
4351.oindex "&%-q%&"
4352.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4353This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4354configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4355relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4356and &%-S%& options).
4357
4358.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4359The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4360waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4361for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4362process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4363have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4364
4365If
4366.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4367.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4368.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4369the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4370passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4371proceeding.
4372
4373When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4374process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4375mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4376this to be repeated periodically.
4377
4378Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4379random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4380If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4381MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4382
4383It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4384order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4385&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4386
4387.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4388The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4389behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4390appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4391
4392.vitem &%-qq...%&
4393.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4394.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4395.cindex "queue" "routing"
4396.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4397An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4398stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4399every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4400transports are run.
4401
4402.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4403The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4404is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4405complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4406place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4407delivered down a single SMTP
4408.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4409.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4410.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4411connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4412This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4413intermittently.
4414
4415.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4416.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4417.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4418If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4419those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4420delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4421&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4422
4423.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4424.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4425.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4426.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4427If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4428message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4429their retry times are tried.
4430
4431.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4432.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4433.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4434If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4435frozen or not.
4436
4437.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4438.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4439.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4440The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4441be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4442for later delivery.
4443
4444.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4445.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4446When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4447lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4448starting message id. For example:
4449.code
4450exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4451.endd
4452Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4453second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4454are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4455.code
4456exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4457.endd
4458just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4459&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4460that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4461mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4462are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4463queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4464
4465.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4466.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4467.cindex "periodic queue running"
4468When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4469starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4470(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4471&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4472single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4473combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4474.code
4475/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4476.endd
4477Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4478process every 30 minutes.
4479
4480When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4481pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4482
4483.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4484.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4485This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4486compatibility.
4487
4488.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4489.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4490This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4491
4492.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4493.oindex "&%-R%&"
4494.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4495.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4496.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4497The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4498is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4499which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4500<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4501
4502This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4503perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4504queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4505address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4506way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4507regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4508
4509If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4510you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4511.code
4512exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4513.endd
4514This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4515every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4516applied to each queue run.
4517
4518Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4519are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4520information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4521means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4522existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4523address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4524will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4525information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4526address will be skipped.
4527
4528.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4529If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4530all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4531&'ff'& is present.
4532
4533The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4534to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4535command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4536effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4537an arbitrary command instead.
4538
4539.vitem &%-r%&
4540.oindex "&%-r%&"
4541This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4542
4543.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4544.oindex "&%-S%&"
4545.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4546.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4547This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4548message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4549conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4550has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4551
4552.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4553.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4554This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4555recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4556&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4557
4558.vitem &%-t%&
4559.oindex "&%-t%&"
4560.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4561.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4562.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4563.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4564When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4565input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4566from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4567from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4568takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4569
4570.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4571If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4572is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4573the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4574and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4575Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4576Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4577argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4578Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4579instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4580&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4581
4582.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4583If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4584recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4585lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4586with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4587&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4588
4589RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4590message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4591added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4592not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4593nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4594In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4595are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4596once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4597&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4598
4599.vitem &%-ti%&
4600.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4601This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4602compatibility with Sendmail.
4603
4604.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4605.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4606.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4607.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4608This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4609incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4610&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4611&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4612
4613
4614.vitem &%-U%&
4615.oindex "&%-U%&"
4616.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4617Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4618documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4619syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4620set. Exim ignores this option.
4621
4622.vitem &%-v%&
4623.oindex "&%-v%&"
4624This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4625describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4626receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4627dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4628the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4629selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4630unconditional.
4631
4632.vitem &%-x%&
4633.oindex "&%-x%&"
4634AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4635National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4636It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4637this option.
4638
4639.vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4640.oindex "&%-X%&"
4641This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4642to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4643.endlist
4644
4645.ecindex IIDclo1
4646.ecindex IIDclo2
4647
4648
4649. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4650. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4651. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4652. creates a man page for the options.
4653. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4654
4655.literal xml
4656<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4657.literal off
4658
4659
4660
4661
4662
4663. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4664. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4665
4666
4667.chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4668 "The runtime configuration file"
4669
4670.cindex "run time configuration"
4671.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4672.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4673.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4674.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4675.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4676Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4677binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4678because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4679control.
4680
4681If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4682writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4683The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4684errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4685not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4686actually alter the string.
4687
4688The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4689reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4690most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4691give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4692existing file in the list.
4693
4694.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4695.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4696.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4697.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4698.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4699.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4700The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4701specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4702configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4703group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4704CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4705
4706&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4707to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4708easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4709CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4710who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4711
4712Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4713be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4714since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4715compromise the Exim user account.
4716
4717A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4718is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4719defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4720configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4721CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4722&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4723configuration.
4724
4725
4726
4727.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4728.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4729A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4730option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4731&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4732unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4733CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4734is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4735is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4736installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4737specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4738
4739Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4740with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4741listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4742testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4743delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4744Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4745the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4746can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4747message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4748&%-M%&).
4749
4750If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4751prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4752start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4753There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4754name can be used with &%-C%&.
4755
4756One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4757option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4758configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4759non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4760If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4761completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4762
4763The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4764to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4765necessarily be discarded.
4766WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4767considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4768values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4769is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4770transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4771values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4772
4773Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4774share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4775If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4776looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4777and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4778file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4779each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4780
4781In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4782different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4783help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4784
4785
4786
4787.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4788.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4789.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4790Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4791option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4792are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4793is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4794optional parts are:
4795
4796.ilist
4797&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4798&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4799.next
4800.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4801&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4802are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4803.next
4804&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4805addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4806&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4807.next
4808&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4809define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4810&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4811.next
4812&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4813If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4814defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4815are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4816&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4817.next
4818&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4819when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4820chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4821.next
4822&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4823want to use this feature, you must set
4824.code
4825LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4826.endd
4827in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4828facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4829.endlist
4830
4831.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4832.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4833.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4834Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4835
4836Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4837leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4838# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4839and does not introduce a comment.
4840
4841Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4842the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4843backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4844lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4845appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4846
4847A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4848default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4849change settings as required.
4850
4851The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4852described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4853respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4854items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4855onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4856described.
4857
4858
4859
4860.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4861.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4862.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4863.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4864.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4865You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4866using this syntax:
4867.display
4868&`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4869&`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4870.endd
4871on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4872the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4873second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4874name is required.
4875
4876Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4877configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4878If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4879because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4880
4881The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4882comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4883for example:
4884.code
4885hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4886 .include /some/file
4887.endd
4888Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4889process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4890inclusion appears.
4891
4892
4893
4894.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4895.cindex "macro" "description of"
4896.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4897If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4898&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4899definition, and must be of the form
4900.display
4901<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4902.endd
4903The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4904in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4905continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4906space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4907a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4908
4909Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4910definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4911ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4912
4913.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4914Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4915files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4916scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4917replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4918for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4919the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4920define
4921.display
4922&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4923&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4924.endd
4925but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4926error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4927before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4928consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4929line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4930comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4931
4932
4933.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4934Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4935(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4936&'='&. For example:
4937.code
4938MAC = initial value
4939...
4940MAC == updated value
4941.endd
4942Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4943subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4944the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4945Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4946.code
4947MAC = initial value
4948...
4949MAC == MAC and something added
4950.endd
4951This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4952from a number of other files.
4953
4954.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4955The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4956&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4957used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4958using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4959file to be ignored.
4960
4961
4962
4963.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4964As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4965up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4966strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4967.code
4968ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4969 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4970.endd
4971This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4972.code
4973data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4974.endd
4975In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4976address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4977section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4978
4979
4980.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4981.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4982.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4983You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4984&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4985portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4986read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4987
4988The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4989be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4990that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4991line. Thus:
4992.code
4993.ifdef AAA
4994message_size_limit = 50M
4995.else
4996message_size_limit = 100M
4997.endif
4998.endd
4999sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
5000otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5001is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5002obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5003
5004Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5005it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5006in this line"& will always be true.
5007
5008Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5009to clarify complicated nestings.
5010
5011
5012
5013.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5014.cindex "common option syntax"
5015.cindex "syntax of common options"
5016.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5017For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5018each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5019lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5020these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5021space) and then the value. For example:
5022.code
5023qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5024.endd
5025.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5026.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5027.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5028Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5029accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5030line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5031word &"hide"&. For example:
5032.code
5033hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5034.endd
5035For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5036.code
5037mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5038.endd
5039If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5040all instances of the same driver.
5041
5042The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5043that are found in option settings.
5044
5045
5046.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5047.cindex "format" "boolean"
5048.cindex "boolean configuration values"
5049.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5050.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5051Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5052different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5053the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5054if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5055boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5056&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5057the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5058.code
5059queue_only
5060queue_only = true
5061.endd
5062The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5063.code
5064no_queue_only
5065queue_only = false
5066.endd
5067You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5068
5069
5070
5071
5072.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5073.cindex "integer configuration values"
5074.cindex "format" "integer"
5075If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5076hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5077number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5078with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5079hexadecimal number.
5080
5081If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5082it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5083of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
50841024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5085and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5086used.
5087
5088
5089.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5090.cindex "integer format"
5091.cindex "format" "octal integer"
5092If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5093interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5094Such options are always output in octal.
5095
5096
5097.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5098.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5099.cindex "format" "fixed point"
5100If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5101integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5102
5103
5104
5105.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5106.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5107.cindex "format" "time interval"
5108A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5109the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5110
5111.table2 30pt
5112.irow &%s%& seconds
5113.irow &%m%& minutes
5114.irow &%h%& hours
5115.irow &%d%& days
5116.irow &%w%& weeks
5117.endtable
5118
5119For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5120intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5121is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5122
5123
5124
5125.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5126.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5127.cindex "format" "string"
5128If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5129or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5130consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5131the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5132removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5133Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5134appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5135therefore equivalent:
5136.code
5137trusted_users = uucp:mail
5138trusted_users = uucp:\
5139 # This comment line is ignored
5140 mail
5141.endd
5142.cindex "string" "quoted"
5143.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5144If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5145double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5146continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5147
5148.table2 100pt
5149.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5150.irow &`\n`& "newline"
5151.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5152.irow &`\t`& "tab"
5153.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5154.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5155 character"
5156.endtable
5157
5158If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5159character, that character replaces the pair.
5160
5161Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5162insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5163trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5164current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5165in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5166and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5167
5168
5169.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5170.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5171Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5172by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5173circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5174is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5175strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5176However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5177backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5178within a quoted configuration string.
5179
5180
5181.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5182.cindex "user name" "format of"
5183.cindex "format" "user name"
5184.cindex "groups" "name format"
5185.cindex "format" "group name"
5186User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5187above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5188either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5189&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5190
5191
5192.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5193.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5194.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5195.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5196The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5197default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5198the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5199&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5200are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5201particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5202&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5203
5204In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5205input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5206&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5207in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5208on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5209start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5210example, the list
5211.code
5212local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5213.endd
5214contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5215
5216&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5217list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5218colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5219be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5220
5221.section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5222.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5223.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5224Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5225introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5226with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5227character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5228above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5229.code
5230local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5231.endd
5232This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5233&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5234confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5235
5236.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5237.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5238It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5239code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5240must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5241are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5242sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5243interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5244generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5245.code
5246domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5247.endd
5248This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5249to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5250expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5251the value in quotes. For example:
5252.code
5253local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5254.endd
5255Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5256doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5257set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5258enclosing an empty list item.
5259
5260
5261
5262.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5263.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5264An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5265separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5266.code
5267senders = user@domain :
5268.endd
5269contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5270in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5271items, the second of which is empty:
5272.code
5273senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5274.endd
5275&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5276are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5277would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5278just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5279.code
5280senders = :
5281.endd
5282In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5283is at the end of the list.
5284
5285
5286
5287
5288.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5289.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5290There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5291and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5292instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5293a sequence of lines like this:
5294.display
5295<&'instance name'&>:
5296 <&'option'&>
5297 ...
5298 <&'option'&>
5299.endd
5300In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5301followed by three options settings:
5302.code
5303localuser:
5304 driver = accept
5305 check_local_user
5306 transport = local_delivery
5307.endd
5308For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5309setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5310settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5311deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5312a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5313described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5314
5315You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5316the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5317
5318The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5319passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5320transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5321authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5322them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5323server.
5324
5325.cindex "generic options"
5326.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5327Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5328and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5329same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5330&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5331.cindex "private options"
5332The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5333they all have default values.
5334
5335The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5336precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5337this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5338
5339Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5340elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5341with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5342a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5343instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5344confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5345configuration lines:
5346.code
5347remote_smtp:
5348 driver = smtp
5349.endd
5350create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5351&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5352different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5353instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5354thus:
5355.code
5356special_smtp:
5357 driver = smtp
5358 port = 1234
5359 command_timeout = 10s
5360.endd
5361The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5362these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5363lines.
5364
5365Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5366list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5367defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5368option.
5369
5370
5371
5372
5373
5374
5375. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5376. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5377
5378.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5379.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5380.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5381The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5382is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5383the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5384configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5385of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5386itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5387initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5388mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5389
5390
5391
5392.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5393The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5394file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5395the line
5396.code
5397# primary_hostname =
5398.endd
5399This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5400to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5401can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5402it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5403
5404The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5405.code
5406domainlist local_domains = @
5407domainlist relay_to_domains =
5408hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5409.endd
5410These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5411domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5412domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5413configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5414
5415The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5416later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5417on the local host.
5418
5419.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5420There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5421of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5422called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5423be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5424the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5425
5426The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5427list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5428controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5429domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5430domain is permitted.
5431
5432The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5433used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5434that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5435loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5436submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5437hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5438
5439Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5440we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5441and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5442
5443The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5444.code
5445acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5446acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5447.endd
5448These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5449during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5450command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5451respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5452&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5453section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5454accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5455to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5456contents of a message to be checked.
5457
5458Two commented-out option settings are next:
5459.code
5460# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5461# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5462.endd
5463These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5464content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5465scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5466details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5467
5468Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5469.code
5470# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5471# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5472# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5473.endd
5474These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5475support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5476first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5477connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5478other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5479key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5480More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5481
5482Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5483.code
5484# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5485# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5486.endd
5487.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5488.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5489.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5490.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5491.cindex "smtps protocol"
5492.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5493.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5494These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5495server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5496TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5497more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5498on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5499port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5500configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5501non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5502&<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5503
5504Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5505.code
5506# qualify_domain =
5507# qualify_recipient =
5508.endd
5509The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5510complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5511receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5512the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5513you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5514addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5515
5516.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5517The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5518addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5519(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5520.code
5521# allow_domain_literals
5522.endd
5523The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5524Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5525quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5526try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5527people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5528&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5529
5530The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5531.code
5532never_users = root
5533.endd
5534It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5535convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5536setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5537The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5538list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5539FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5540contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5541FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5542
5543When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5544Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5545line,
5546.code
5547host_lookup = *
5548.endd
5549specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5550in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5551information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5552or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5553Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5554because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5555unreachable.
5556
5557The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
55581413 (hence their names):
5559.code
5560rfc1413_hosts = *
5561rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5562.endd
5563These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5564Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5565terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5566of an incoming SMTP connection.
5567If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5568information, you can change this.
5569
5570This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negociated by clients
5571and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5572.code
5573prdr_enable = true
5574.endd
5575
5576When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5577be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5578if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5579find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5580.code
5581# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5582# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5583.endd
5584show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5585and recipient addresses, respectively.
5586
5587The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5588.code
5589# percent_hack_domains =
5590.endd
5591It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5592This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5593anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5594
5595The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5596concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5597message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5598occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5599address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5600bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5601are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5602always bounce messages.
5603.code
5604ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5605timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5606.endd
5607The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5608discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5609message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5610after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5611bounce message ever lasts a week.
5612
5613
5614
5615.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5616.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5617.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5618In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5619It starts with the line
5620.code
5621begin acl
5622.endd
5623and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5624&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5625and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5626
5627.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5628The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5629RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5630are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5631rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5632result of the ACL processing.
5633.code
5634acl_check_rcpt:
5635.endd
5636This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5637ACL, and names it.
5638.code
5639accept hosts = :
5640.endd
5641This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5642But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5643names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5644list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5645host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5646important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5647
5648What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5649messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5650input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5651manner.
5652.code
5653deny message = Restricted characters in address
5654 domains = +local_domains
5655 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5656
5657deny message = Restricted characters in address
5658 domains = !+local_domains
5659 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5660.endd
5661These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5662characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5663Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5664&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5665in Internet mail addresses.
5666
5667The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5668addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5669option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5670in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5671programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5672at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5673characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5674policy of being as safe as possible.
5675
5676The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5677to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5678first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5679&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5680reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5681&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5682
5683The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5684block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5685or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5686have to modify this rule.
5687
5688Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5689allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5690common convention of local parts constructed as
5691&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5692the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5693with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5694file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5695that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5696is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5697
5698The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5699allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5700and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5701with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5702local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5703and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5704(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5705.code
5706accept local_parts = postmaster
5707 domains = +local_domains
5708.endd
5709This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5710local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5711&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5712reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5713&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5714
5715The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5716by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5717in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5718.code
5719require verify = sender
5720.endd
5721This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5722ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5723address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5724see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5725addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5726used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5727discusses the details of address verification.
5728.code
5729accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5730 control = submission
5731.endd
5732This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5733hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5734verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5735that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5736second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5737is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5738messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5739&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5740probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5741.code
5742accept authenticated = *
5743 control = submission
5744.endd
5745This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5746Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5747likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5748authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5749examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5750fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5751.code
5752require message = relay not permitted
5753 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5754.endd
5755This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5756one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5757.code
5758require verify = recipient
5759.endd
5760This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5761fails, the address is rejected.
5762.code
5763# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5764# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5765# $dnslist_text
5766# dnslists = black.list.example
5767#
5768# warn dnslists = black.list.example
5769# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5770# a black list at $dnslist_domain
5771# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5772.endd
5773These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5774sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5775from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5776line.
5777.code
5778# require verify = csa
5779.endd
5780This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5781authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5782records.
5783.code
5784accept
5785.endd
5786The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5787address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5788.code
5789acl_check_data:
5790.endd
5791This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5792of this ACL are commented out:
5793.code
5794# deny malware = *
5795# message = This message contains a virus \
5796# ($malware_name).
5797.endd
5798These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5799viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5800suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5801virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5802.code
5803# warn spam = nobody
5804# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5805# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5806# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5807# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5808.endd
5809These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5810SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5811and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5812&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5813series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5814whatever the spam score.
5815.code
5816accept
5817.endd
5818This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5819
5820
5821.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5822.cindex "default" "routers"
5823.cindex "routers" "default"
5824The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5825by the line
5826.code
5827begin routers
5828.endd
5829Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5830messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5831accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5832matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5833manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5834.code
5835# domain_literal:
5836# driver = ipliteral
5837# domains = !+local_domains
5838# transport = remote_smtp
5839.endd
5840.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5841This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5842support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5843you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5844&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5845.code
5846dnslookup:
5847 driver = dnslookup
5848 domains = ! +local_domains
5849 transport = remote_smtp
5850 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5851 no_more
5852.endd
5853The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5854domains. This is specified by the line
5855.code
5856domains = ! +local_domains
5857.endd
5858The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5859exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5860that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5861the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5862indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5863passed on to the following routers.
5864
5865The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5866and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5867the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5868instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5869one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5870
5871The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5872DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5873router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5874specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5875in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5876the address fails and is bounced.
5877
5878The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5879be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5880encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5881whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5882Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5883email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5884continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5885out.
5886.code
5887system_aliases:
5888 driver = redirect
5889 allow_fail
5890 allow_defer
5891 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5892# user = exim
5893 file_transport = address_file
5894 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5895.endd
5896Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5897domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5898alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5899data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5900the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5901the next router.
5902
5903&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5904often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5905file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5906&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5907.code
5908userforward:
5909 driver = redirect
5910 check_local_user
5911# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5912# local_part_suffix_optional
5913 file = $home/.forward
5914# allow_filter
5915 no_verify
5916 no_expn
5917 check_ancestor
5918 file_transport = address_file
5919 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5920 reply_transport = address_reply
5921.endd
5922This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5923redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5924individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5925local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5926router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5927namely:
5928.code
5929# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5930# local_part_suffix_optional
5931.endd
5932.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5933show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5934is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5935by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5936variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5937presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5938the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5939
5940When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5941home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5942declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5943redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5944
5945.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5946Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5947files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5948is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5949of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5950filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5951separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5952
5953The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5954verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5955There are two reasons for doing this:
5956
5957.olist
5958Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5959checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5960unnecessary work.
5961.next
5962More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5963command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5964The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5965It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5966this time.
5967.endlist
5968
5969The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5970address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5971works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5972forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5973
5974The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5975forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5976auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5977.code
5978a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5979.endd
5980the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5981transport.
5982.code
5983localuser:
5984 driver = accept
5985 check_local_user
5986# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5987# local_part_suffix_optional
5988 transport = local_delivery
5989.endd
5990The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5991part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5992the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5993routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5994same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5995
5996
5997.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5998.cindex "default" "transports"
5999.cindex "transports" "default"
6000Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6001only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6002not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6003.code
6004begin transports
6005.endd
6006One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6007.code
6008remote_smtp:
6009 driver = smtp
6010 hosts_try_prdr = *
6011.endd
6012This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6013The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6014The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6015It is negotiated between client and server
6016and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6017All other options are defaulted.
6018.code
6019local_delivery:
6020 driver = appendfile
6021 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6022 delivery_date_add
6023 envelope_to_add
6024 return_path_add
6025# group = mail
6026# mode = 0660
6027.endd
6028This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6029traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6030local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6031directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6032under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6033show how this can be done.
6034
6035Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6036&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6037similarly-named options above.
6038.code
6039address_pipe:
6040 driver = pipe
6041 return_output
6042.endd
6043This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6044redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6045option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6046sender.
6047.code
6048address_file:
6049 driver = appendfile
6050 delivery_date_add
6051 envelope_to_add
6052 return_path_add
6053.endd
6054This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6055redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6056&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6057.code
6058address_reply:
6059 driver = autoreply
6060.endd
6061This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6062filter files.
6063
6064
6065
6066.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6067.cindex "retry" "default rule"
6068.cindex "default" "retry rule"
6069The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6070Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6071introduced by the line
6072.code
6073begin retry
6074.endd
6075In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6076errors:
6077.code
6078* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6079.endd
6080This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
60812 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
60821.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6083is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6084
6085If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6086if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6087temporary errors into permanent errors.
6088
6089
6090.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6091The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6092.code
6093begin rewrite
6094.endd
6095contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6096rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6097
6098
6099
6100.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6101.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6102The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6103.code
6104begin authenticators
6105.endd
6106defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6107configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6108which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6109standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6110mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6111to support most MUA software.
6112
6113The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6114.code
6115#PLAIN:
6116# driver = plaintext
6117# server_set_id = $auth2
6118# server_prompts = :
6119# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6120# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6121.endd
6122And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6123.code
6124#LOGIN:
6125# driver = plaintext
6126# server_set_id = $auth1
6127# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6128# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6129# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6130.endd
6131
6132The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6133in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6134&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6135that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6136i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6137when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6138when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6139need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6140
6141The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6142password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6143To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6144expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6145
6146Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6147usercode and password are in different positions.
6148Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6149
6150.ecindex IIDconfiwal
6151
6152
6153
6154. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6155. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6156
6157.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6158
6159.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6160.cindex "PCRE"
6161Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6162uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6163matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6164regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6165Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6166O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6167
6168The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6169are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6170description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6171the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6172the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6173case-insensitive.
6174
6175In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6176it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6177or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6178second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6179.code
6180domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6181.endd
6182The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6183precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6184of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6185regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6186backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6187normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6188matched.
6189
6190There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6191recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6192string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6193these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6194it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6195match anywhere in the subject string.
6196
6197In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6198you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6199.code
6200domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6201.endd
6202matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6203You need to use:
6204.code
6205domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6206.endd
6207if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6208$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6209
6210
6211
6212. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6213. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6214
6215.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6216.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6217.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6218.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6219Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6220messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6221
6222.olist
6223A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6224cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6225lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6226can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6227&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6228.next
6229Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6230way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6231returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6232succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6233chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6234.endlist
6235
6236String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6237that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6238involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6239if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6240time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6241chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6242
6243.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6244It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6245lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6246processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6247Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6248.code
6249domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6250domains = lsearch;/some/file
6251.endd
6252The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6253No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6254defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6255The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6256file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6257.code
6258192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6259192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6260.endd
6261When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6262possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6263
6264In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6265Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6266in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6267.code
6268domain1:
6269domain2:
6270.endd
6271Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6272matches the list item.
6273
6274It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6275Consider a file containing lines like this:
6276.code
6277192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6278.endd
6279If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6280first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6281causes a second lookup to occur.
6282
6283The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6284available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6285lookup is permitted.
6286
6287
6288.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6289.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6290.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6291Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6292
6293.ilist
6294The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6295and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6296lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6297.next
6298.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6299The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6300key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6301Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6302.endlist
6303
6304The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6305the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6306default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6307.code
6308LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6309LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6310.endd
6311which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6312For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6313libraries and header files before building Exim.
6314
6315
6316
6317
6318.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6319.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6320.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6321The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6322
6323.ilist
6324.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6325.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6326.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6327&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6328string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6329indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6330re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6331aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6332be found in several places:
6333.display
6334&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6335&url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6336&url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6337.endd
6338A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6339because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6340However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6341you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6342.next
6343.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6344.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6345.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6346&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6347DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6348zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6349&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6350
6351.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6352For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6353when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6354using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6355the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6356that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6357other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6358.next
6359.cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6360.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6361.cindex "sasldb2"
6362.cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6363&(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6364interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6365ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6366authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6367&_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6368&(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6369.next
6370.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6371.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6372.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6373.cindex "Courier"
6374.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6375.cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6376&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6377is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6378if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6379other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6380use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6381calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6382utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6383by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6384.next
6385.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6386.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6387&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6388whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6389contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6390the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6391symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6392lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6393&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6394.next
6395.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6396.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6397&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6398terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6399file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6400IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6401being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6402.code
64031.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6404192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6405"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6406"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6407.endd
6408The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6409file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6410key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6411&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6412&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6413
6414&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6415&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6416lookup types support only literal keys.
6417
6418&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6419the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6420&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6421.next
6422.cindex "linear search"
6423.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6424.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6425.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6426&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6427line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6428end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6429letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6430in the file is used.
6431
6432White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6433line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6434continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6435space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6436junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6437colon, for example:
6438.code
6439baduser: :fail:
6440.endd
6441Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6442middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6443that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6444wildcarding of any kind.
6445
6446.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6447.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6448In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6449characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6450If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6451matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6452contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6453quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6454quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6455
6456.next
6457.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6458.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6459.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6460&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6461the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6462&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6463reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6464aliases; the full map names must be used.
6465
6466.next
6467.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6468.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6469.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6470.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6471&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6472&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6473the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6474that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6475used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6476
6477.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6478Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6479file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6480&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6481
6482. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6483. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6484
6485.olist
6486The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6487.code
6488 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6489 *fish data for anythingfish
6490.endd
6491.next
6492The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6493example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6494.code
6495 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6496.endd
6497Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6498expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6499string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6500.code
6501 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6502.endd
6503The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6504expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6505For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6506.code
6507 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6508.endd
6509
6510If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6511either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6512ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6513colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6514escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6515
6516&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6517match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6518is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6519takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6520&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6521
6522.next
6523Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6524is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6525lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6526example:
6527.code
6528 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6529.endd
6530The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6531.endlist olist
6532
6533Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6534continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6535be followed by optional colons.
6536
6537&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6538&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6539lookup types support only literal keys.
6540.endlist ilist
6541
6542
6543.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6544.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6545.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6546The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6547many of them are given in later sections.
6548
6549.ilist
6550.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6551.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6552&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6553are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6554records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6555.next
6556.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6557.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6558&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6559.next
6560.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6561.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6562&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6563returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6564that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6565called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6566any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6567.next
6568.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6569.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6570&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6571MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6572.next
6573.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6574.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6575&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6576the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6577.next
6578.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6579.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6580&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6581Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6582.next
6583.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6584.cindex "passwd lookup type"
6585.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6586&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6587lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6588success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6589lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6590password value. For example:
6591.code
6592*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6593.endd
6594.next
6595.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6596.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6597&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6598PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6599
6600.next
6601.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6602.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6603&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6604that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6605
6606.next
6607&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6608not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6609.next
6610.cindex "whoson lookup type"
6611.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6612&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6613allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6614address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6615obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6616at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6617superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6618&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6619.code
6620require condition = \
6621 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6622.endd
6623The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6624the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6625this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6626one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6627.endlist
6628
6629
6630
6631.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6632.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6633Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6634completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6635reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6636options such as a list of local domains.
6637
6638When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6639of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6640temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6641or may give up altogether.
6642
6643
6644
6645.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6646.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6647.cindex "lookup" "default values"
6648.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6649.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6650.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6651In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6652that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6653
6654&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6655lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6656specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6657
6658If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6659and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6660provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6661
6662.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6663.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6664.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6665Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6666&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6667character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6668by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6669that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6670take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6671For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6672.code
6673data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6674.endd
6675Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6676looks up these keys, in this order:
6677.code
6678jane@eyre.example
6679*@eyre.example
6680*
6681.endd
6682The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6683&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6684complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6685Exim move on to try the next key.
6686
6687
6688
6689.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6690.cindex "partial matching"
6691.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6692.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6693.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6694.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6695The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6696match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6697being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6698information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6699domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6700a key in a DBM file is
6701.code
6702*.dates.fict.example
6703.endd
6704then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6705&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6706by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6707file.
6708
6709&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6710also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6711&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6712
6713Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6714keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6715be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6716partial matching keys
6717beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6718Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6719unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6720
6721Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6722the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6723is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6724is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6725fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6726start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6727remains.
6728
6729A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6730by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6731&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6732modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6733subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6734up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6735.code
67362250.dates.fict.example
6737*.2250.dates.fict.example
6738*.dates.fict.example
6739*.fict.example
6740.endd
6741As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6742finishes.
6743
6744.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6745.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6746The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6747changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6748formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6749parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6750.code
6751domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6752.endd
6753In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6754&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6755components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6756other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6757.code
6758domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6759.endd
6760For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6761&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6762
6763If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6764just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6765down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6766
6767.ilist
6768If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6769.next
6770If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6771example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6772.next
6773Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6774remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6775for &"*"& on its own.
6776.next
6777Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6778.endlist
6779
6780
6781If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6782&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6783this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6784specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6785prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6786lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6787&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6788
6789The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6790in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6791dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6792in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6793subject key is always followed by a dot.
6794
6795
6796
6797
6798.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6799.cindex "lookup" "caching"
6800.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6801Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6802lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6803of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6804single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6805
6806For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6807another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6808many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6809the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6810closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6811own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6812
6813The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6814strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6815complete.
6816
6817
6818
6819
6820.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6821.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6822.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6823When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6824is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6825the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6826.code
6827[name=$local_part]
6828.endd
6829will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6830For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6831.code
6832[name="$local_part"]
6833.endd
6834but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6835NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6836rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6837of the following form is provided:
6838.code
6839${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6840.endd
6841For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6842.code
6843[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6844.endd
6845See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6846operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6847lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6848
6849
6850
6851
6852.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6853.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6854.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6855.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6856The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6857of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6858an expansion string could contain:
6859.code
6860${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6861.endd
6862If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6863is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6864&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6865&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6866
6867The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SPF, SRV, TLSA and TXT,
6868and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6869configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6870the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6871&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6872.code
6873${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6874.endd
6875If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6876altered and nothing is added.
6877
6878For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6879single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6880concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6881depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6882between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6883by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6884.code
6885${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6886.endd
6887It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6888white space is ignored.
6889
6890.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6891.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6892For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6893each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6894port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6895.new
6896An alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6897separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6898.wen
6899
6900.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6901.cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6902For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6903unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6904character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6905items without a separator, use a semicolon instead. For SPF records the
6906default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6907.code
6908${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6909${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6910${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6911.endd
6912It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6913white space is ignored.
6914
6915.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6916.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6917By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6918each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6919the pseudo-type MXH:
6920.code
6921${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6922.endd
6923In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6924returned.
6925
6926.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6927Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6928records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6929component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6930records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6931error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6932but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6933top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6934.code
6935${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6936${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6937.endd
6938Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6939the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6940the name servers for &%edu%&.
6941
6942You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6943top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6944sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6945given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6946for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6947such a list.
6948
6949.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6950A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6951records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6952&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6953not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6954result of a successful lookup such as:
6955.code
6956${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6957.endd
6958has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6959The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6960authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6961
6962.cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6963The pseudo-type A+ performs an A6 lookup (if configured) followed by an AAAA
6964and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
6965(see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
6966.code
6967${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
6968.endd
6969
6970
6971.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6972In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6973However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6974&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6975the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6976.code
6977${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6978${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6979${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6980.endd
6981In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6982the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6983to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6984case, it does not treat it as a list.
6985
6986The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6987in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6988different separator can be specified, as described above.
6989
6990Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are givien by optional keywords,
6991each followed by a comma,
6992that may appear before the record type.
6993
6994The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6995temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6996a defer-option modifier.
6997The possible keywords are
6998&"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6999With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7000whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7001ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7002With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7003error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7004succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7005.code
7006${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7007${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7008.endd
7009Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7010yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7011
7012.cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7013Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7014The possible keywords are
7015&"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7016With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7017with the lookup.
7018With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7019is not labelled as authenticated data
7020is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7021The default is &"never"&.
7022
7023See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7024
7025
7026
7027
7028.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7029.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7030.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7031.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7032The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7033become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7034implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7035contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7036the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7037it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7038indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7039your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7040.code
7041LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7042LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7043LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7044LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7045LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7046.endd
7047If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7048same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7049
7050There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7051the way they handle the results of a query:
7052
7053.ilist
7054&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7055gives an error.
7056.next
7057&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7058Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7059.next
7060&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7061from all of them are returned.
7062.endlist
7063
7064
7065For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7066Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7067the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7068First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7069
7070
7071.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7072.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7073An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7074the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7075.code
7076data = ${lookup ldap \
7077 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7078 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7079.endd
7080.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7081The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7082secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7083encrypted TLS connection is used.
7084
7085With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7086LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7087See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7088
7089Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7090controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7091&_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7092your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7093&_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7094certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7095running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7096methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7097&_exim.conf_&.
7098
7099
7100.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7101.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7102Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7103and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7104within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7105reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7106
7107The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7108filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7109the string:
7110.code
7111* => \2A
7112( => \28
7113) => \29
7114\ => \5C
7115.endd
7116in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7117to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7118.code
7119! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7120.endd
7121are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7122.code
7123${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7124.endd
7125yields
7126.code
7127%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7128.endd
7129Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7130.code
7131a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7132.endd
7133The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7134base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7135by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7136.code
7137, + " \ < > ;
7138.endd
7139It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7140before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7141is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7142.code
7143${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7144.endd
7145yields
7146.code
7147%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7148.endd
7149Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7150.code
7151\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7152.endd
7153There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7154authentication below.
7155
7156
7157.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7158.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7159The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7160is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7161an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7162by starting it with
7163.code
7164ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7165.endd
7166If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7167used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7168taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7169colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7170handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7171returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7172are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7173Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7174failures, and timeouts.
7175
7176For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7177of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7178&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7179doubled. For example
7180.code
7181ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7182.endd
7183If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7184to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7185the local host) is used.
7186
7187If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7188a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7189&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7190to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7191not available.
7192
7193For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7194for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7195can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7196the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7197.code
7198ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7199.endd
7200When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7201&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7202.code
7203${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7204.endd
7205When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7206a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7207specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7208socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7209&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7210or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7211the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7212backup host.
7213
7214If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7215specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7216&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7217
7218.ilist
7219Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7220interface.
7221.next
7222Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7223.endlist
7224
7225
7226Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7227&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7228
7229
7230
7231.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7232.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7233The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7234information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7235be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7236spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7237when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7238them. The following names are recognized:
7239.display
7240&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7241&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7242&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7243&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7244&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7245&`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7246&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7247&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7248.endd
7249The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7250&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7251must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7252library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7253
7254The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7255backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7256enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7257network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7258&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7259LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7260if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7261SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7262Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7263
7264The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7265set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7266
7267The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7268to use for an individual lookup. The global ldap_servers option provides a
7269default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7270server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7271different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7272different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7273alternate list (colon-separated).
7274
7275Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7276values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7277.code
7278${lookup ldap
7279 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7280 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7281 {$value}fail}
7282.endd
7283The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7284any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7285which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7286non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7287
7288The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7289connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7290on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7291
7292When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7293removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7294some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7295quoting has two advantages:
7296
7297.ilist
7298It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7299DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7300.next
7301It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7302.endlist
7303
7304For example, a setting such as
7305.code
7306USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7307.endd
7308should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7309
7310Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7311expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7312field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7313does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7314.code
7315PASS=${quote:$3}
7316.endd
7317The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7318SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7319&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7320
7321
7322
7323.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7324.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7325The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7326as a sequence of values, for example
7327.code
7328cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7329.endd
7330The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7331search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7332the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7333values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7334you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7335directory.
7336
7337In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7338result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7339has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7340
7341If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7342strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7343quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7344backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7345.new
7346Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7347(permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7348.wen
7349Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7350output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7351same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7352
7353.new
7354Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7355LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7356&%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7357&%attr2%& has only one value:
7358.code
7359ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7360value1.1,value1,,2
7361
7362ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7363value two
7364
7365ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7366attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7367
7368ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7369objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7370.endd
7371.wen
7372You can
7373make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7374results of LDAP lookups.
7375The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7376individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7377.new
7378The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7379of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7380The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7381comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7382.wen
7383
7384
7385
7386
7387.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7388.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7389.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7390NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7391and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7392contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7393of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7394values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7395.code
7396[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7397.endd
7398might return the string
7399.code
7400name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7401home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7402.endd
7403(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7404.code
7405[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7406.endd
7407would just return
7408.code
7409Martin Guerre
7410.endd
7411with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7412for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7413operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7414
7415
7416
7417.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7418.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7419.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7420.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7421.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7422.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7423.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7424.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7425.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7426.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7427Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7428databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7429might be
7430.code
7431${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7432 {$value}fail}
7433.endd
7434If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7435field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7436.code
7437${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7438 {$value}}
7439.endd
7440might be
7441.code
7442home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7443.endd
7444Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7445quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7446field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7447.code
7448Mister X
7449.endd
7450If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7451with a newline between the data for each row.
7452
7453
7454.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7455.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7456.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7457.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7458.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7459.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7460.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7461.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7462.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7463If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7464&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7465option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7466information.
7467(For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7468queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7469&<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7470items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7471Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7472name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7473.code
7474hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7475.endd
7476Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7477&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7478option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7479.code
7480hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7481 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7482.endd
7483For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7484because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7485query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7486a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7487found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7488servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7489
7490The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7491convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7492respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7493itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7494addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7495for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7496characters are not special.
7497
7498.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7499For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7500it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7501done by starting the query with
7502.display
7503&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7504.endd
7505Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7506.olist
7507If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7508global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7509of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7510taken from there.
7511.next
7512If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7513.endlist
7514The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7515Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7516successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7517
7518This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7519are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7520master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7521like this:
7522.code
7523mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7524 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7525 master/db/name/pw
7526.endd
7527In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7528.code
7529${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7530.endd
7531That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7532the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7533option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7534.code
7535${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7536.endd
7537
7538
7539.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7540For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7541causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7542socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7543each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7544.display
7545<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7546 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7547.endd
7548Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7549the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7550
7551No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7552the queries.
7553
7554If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7555or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7556
7557&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7558anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7559is zero because no rows are affected.
7560
7561
7562.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7563PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7564This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7565However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7566database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7567looks like this:
7568.code
7569hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7570.endd
7571In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7572given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7573visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7574
7575If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7576update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7577affected.
7578
7579.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7580.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7581.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7582SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7583addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7584daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7585of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7586separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7587contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7588.code
7589${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7590 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7591.endd
7592In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7593.code
7594domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7595 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7596.endd
7597The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7598quote, which it doubles.
7599
7600The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7601internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7602update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7603are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7604waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7605to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7606option.
7607.ecindex IIDfidalo1
7608.ecindex IIDfidalo2
7609
7610
7611. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7612. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7613
7614.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7615 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7616 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7617.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7618A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7619email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7620contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7621are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7622arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7623
7624Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7625host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7626different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7627general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7628
7629
7630
7631.section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7632.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7633Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7634expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7635into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7636but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7637&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7638discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7639
7640
7641If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7642testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7643expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7644
7645If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7646other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7647misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7648the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7649expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7650.code
7651deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7652 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7653.endd
7654The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7655&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7656senders based on the receiving domain.
7657
7658
7659
7660
7661.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7662.cindex "list" "negation"
7663.cindex "negation" "in lists"
7664Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7665leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7666defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7667it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7668(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7669
7670The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7671subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7672subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7673subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7674was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7675.code
7676domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7677.endd
7678matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7679neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7680list is positive. However, if the setting were
7681.code
7682domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7683.endd
7684then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7685list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7686as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7687
7688Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7689the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7690item.
7691
7692
7693
7694.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7695.cindex "list" "file name in"
7696If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7697name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7698processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7699file names are not allowed,
7700and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7701Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7702lines:
7703
7704.ilist
7705For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7706file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7707.next
7708Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7709address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7710white space or the start of the line. For example:
7711.code
7712not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7713.endd
7714.endlist
7715
7716Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7717file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7718is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7719so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7720
7721If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7722within the file is inverted. For example, if
7723.code
7724hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7725.endd
7726and the file contains the lines
7727.code
7728!a.b.c
7729*.b.c
7730.endd
7731then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7732any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7733
7734
7735
7736.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7737As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7738to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7739confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7740an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7741sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7742non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7743always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7744
7745If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7746list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7747in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7748&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7749
7750
7751
7752
7753.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7754.cindex "named lists"
7755.cindex "list" "named"
7756A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7757which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7758particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7759places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7760the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7761a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7762locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7763.code
7764domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7765.endd
7766Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7767for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7768configured with the line
7769.code
7770domains = +local_domains
7771.endd
7772The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7773except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7774.code
7775dnslookup:
7776 driver = dnslookup
7777 domains = ! +local_domains
7778 transport = remote_smtp
7779 no_more
7780.endd
7781The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7782the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7783respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7784equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7785.code
7786hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7787addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7788.endd
7789A named list may refer to other named lists:
7790.code
7791domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7792domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7793domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7794.endd
7795&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7796effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7797out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7798.code
7799domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7800domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7801.endd
7802The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7803list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7804means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7805.code
7806domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7807.endd
7808where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7809referenced lists if you can.
7810
7811Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7812address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7813lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7814.code
7815domains = +local_domains
7816.endd
7817on several of your routers
7818or in several ACL statements,
7819the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7820if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7821references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7822the same each time they are referenced.
7823
7824By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7825extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7826is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7827hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7828
7829
7830
7831.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7832.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7833.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7834At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7835configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7836write
7837.code
7838ALIST = host1 : host2
7839auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7840.endd
7841it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7842.code
7843auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7844.endd
7845Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7846list, and write
7847.code
7848hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7849auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7850.endd
7851the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7852.code
7853auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7854.endd
7855
7856
7857.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7858.cindex "list" "caching of named"
7859.cindex "caching" "named lists"
7860While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7861it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7862the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7863that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7864an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7865message. For example:
7866.code
7867domainlist special_domains = \
7868 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7869.endd
7870This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7871address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7872in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7873cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7874same list each time.
7875
7876By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7877cache the result anyway. For example:
7878.code
7879domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7880.endd
7881If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7882the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7883
7884
7885
7886.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7887.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7888.cindex "list" "domain list"
7889Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7890The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7891
7892.ilist
7893.cindex "primary host name"
7894.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7895.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7896.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7897.cindex "@ in a domain list"
7898If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7899as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7900possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7901differ only in their names.
7902.next
7903.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7904.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7905.cindex "domain literal"
7906If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7907in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7908only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7909&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7910control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7911In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7912.next
7913.cindex "@mx_any"
7914.cindex "@mx_primary"
7915.cindex "@mx_secondary"
7916.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7917If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7918has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7919.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7920&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7921are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7922local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7923but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7924preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7925
7926The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7927performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7928example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7929resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7930options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7931
7932Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7933patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7934list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7935ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7936on a router). For example:
7937.code
7938domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7939.endd
7940This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7941the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7942
7943The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7944host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7945contain negative items.
7946
7947Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7948be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7949list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7950.code
7951domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7952 an.other.domain : ...
7953.endd
7954so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7955involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7956.code
7957domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7958 an.other.domain ? ...
7959.endd
7960.next
7961.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7962.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7963.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7964If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7965are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7966domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7967list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7968matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7969list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7970&'cipher.key.ex'&.
7971
7972.next
7973.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7974.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7975If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7976expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7977function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7978Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7979default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7980with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7981are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7982
7983&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7984must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7985use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7986it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7987expression by expansion, of course).
7988.next
7989.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7990.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7991If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7992semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7993must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7994&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7995.code
7996domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7997.endd
7998The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7999key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8000only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8001is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8002or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8003&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8004other statements in the same ACL.
8005
8006.next
8007Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8008&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8009.code
8010domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8011.endd
8012This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8013works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8014
8015.next
8016.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8017Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8018a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8019original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8020select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8021value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8022expansion variable.
8023.next
8024If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8025semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8026pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8027chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8028.code
8029hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8030 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8031.endd
8032In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8033example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8034whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8035&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8036variable and can be referred to in other options.
8037.next
8038.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8039If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8040between the pattern and the domain.
8041.endlist
8042
8043Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8044.code
8045domainlist funny_domains = \
8046 @ : \
8047 lib.unseen.edu : \
8048 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8049 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8050 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8051 nis;domains.byname : \
8052 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8053.endd
8054There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8055an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8056explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8057but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8058patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8059patterns earlier.
8060
8061
8062
8063.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8064.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8065.cindex "list" "host list"
8066Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8067example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8068may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8069two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8070pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8071You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8072involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8073
8074
8075.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8076.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8077.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8078If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8079involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8080process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8081not used.
8082
8083.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8084The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8085the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8086
8087
8088
8089.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8090.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8091If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8092the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8093&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8094list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8095systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8096concerns.)
8097
8098The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8099inspecting its IP address:
8100
8101.ilist
8102If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8103with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8104to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8105&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8106This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8107with the IP address of the subject host.
8108
8109If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8110lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8111ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8112temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8113what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8114
8115.next
8116.cindex "@ in a host list"
8117If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8118domain name, as just described.
8119
8120.next
8121If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8122subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8123IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8124be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8125separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8126without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8127IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8128that can never match a client host.
8129
8130.next
8131.cindex "@[] in a host list"
8132If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8133the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8134interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8135.code
8136accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8137accept hosts = @[]
8138.endd
8139.next
8140.cindex "CIDR notation"
8141If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8142example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8143host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8144included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8145specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8146significant end of the address.
8147
8148&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8149of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8150address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8151addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8152.code
8153192.168.23.236/31
8154.endd
8155matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
815632 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8157matches.
8158
8159Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8160.code
8161recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8162 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8163.endd
8164The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8165appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8166For example:
8167.code
8168recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8169.endd
8170could make use of a file containing
8171.code
8172172.16.0.0/12
81733ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8174.endd
8175to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8176addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8177changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8178.code
8179recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8180 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8181.endd
8182The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8183list.
8184.endlist
8185
8186
8187
8188.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8189 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8190.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8191When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8192address, the pattern takes this form:
8193.display
8194&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8195.endd
8196For example:
8197.code
8198hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8199.endd
8200The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8201IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8202letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8203&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8204quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8205returned by the lookup is not used.
8206
8207.cindex "IP address" "masking"
8208.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8209Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8210patterns of this form:
8211.display
8212&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8213.endd
8214For example:
8215.code
8216net24-dbm;/networks.db
8217.endd
8218The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8219length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8220mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8221is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8222&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8223
8224When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8225of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8226terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8227to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8228recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8229(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8230For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8231converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8232addresses are always used.
8233
8234Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8235colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8236However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8237configurations.
8238
8239&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8240IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8241the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8242case the IP address is used on its own.
8243
8244
8245
8246.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8247.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8248.cindex "unknown host name"
8249.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8250There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8251remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8252complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8253address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8254above.)
8255
8256If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8257patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8258Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8259DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8260Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8261effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8262Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8263
8264Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8265against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8266
8267By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8268if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8269&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8270are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8271security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8272for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8273Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8274discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8275found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8276
8277There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8278found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8279
8280.cindex "host" "alias for"
8281.cindex "alias for host"
8282As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8283of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8284
8285.ilist
8286.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8287If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8288the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8289&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8290requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8291expression.
8292.next
8293.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8294.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8295If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8296matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8297expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8298case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8299syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8300example,
8301.code
8302^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8303.endd
8304is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8305&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8306that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8307string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8308part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8309.code
8310sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8311.endd
8312&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8313&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8314example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8315required.
8316.endlist
8317
8318
8319
8320
8321.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8322.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8323While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8324name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8325from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8326behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8327
8328&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8329apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8330
8331.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8332.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8333Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8334lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8335Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8336does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8337To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8338&`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8339not recognized in an indirected file).
8340
8341.ilist
8342If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8343cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8344.code
8345host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8346.endd
8347rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8348any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8349
8350.next
8351If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8352be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8353example:
8354.code
8355accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8356 192.168.4.5
8357.endd
8358accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8359whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8360name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8361.endlist
8362
8363Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8364list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8365list.
8366
8367.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8368 "SECTmixwilhos"
8369.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8370
8371This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8372as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8373wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8374
8375.ilist
8376If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8377IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8378addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8379.code
8380accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8381.endd
8382The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8383left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8384without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8385a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8386pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8387&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8388if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8389
8390.next
8391If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8392address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8393.code
8394accept hosts = *.friend.example
8395accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8396.endd
8397If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8398&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8399&`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8400this section.
8401.endlist
8402
8403
8404.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8405 "SECTtemdnserr"
8406.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8407.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8408.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8409A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8410&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8411host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8412&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8413section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8414host lists such as whitelists.
8415
8416
8417
8418.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8419 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8420.cindex "unknown host name"
8421.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8422If a pattern is of the form
8423.display
8424<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8425.endd
8426for example
8427.code
8428dbm;/host/accept/list
8429.endd
8430a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8431lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8432is not used.
8433
8434&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8435keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8436addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8437&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8438two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8439lookup, both using the same file.
8440
8441
8442
8443.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8444If a pattern is of the form
8445.display
8446<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8447.endd
8448the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8449data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8450&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8451.code
8452hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8453 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8454.endd
8455The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8456can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8457use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8458operator.
8459
8460If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8461looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8462&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8463
8464Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8465host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8466&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8467still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8468effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8469See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8470
8471
8472
8473
8474
8475.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8476.cindex "list" "address list"
8477.cindex "address list" "empty item"
8478.cindex "address list" "patterns"
8479Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8480is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8481always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8482list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8483using this option setting:
8484.code
8485senders = :
8486.endd
8487The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8488data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8489detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8490and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8491
8492Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8493example:
8494.code
8495senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8496.endd
8497A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8498character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8499semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8500subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8501with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8502the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8503wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8504.code
8505deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8506 *@+hostile_domains:\
8507 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8508 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8509.endd
8510.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8511.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8512If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8513specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8514treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8515
8516If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8517contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8518address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8519domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8520is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8521.code
8522deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8523.endd
8524
8525The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8526address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8527senders:
8528
8529.ilist
8530.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8531.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8532If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8533done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8534You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8535as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8536to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8537.code
8538deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8539 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8540.endd
8541The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8542start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8543
8544.next
8545.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8546Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8547lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8548example:
8549.code
8550deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8551 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8552 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8553.endd
8554Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8555lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8556not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8557always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8558
8559Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8560cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8561panic log.
8562.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8563However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8564&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8565default. For example, with this lookup:
8566.code
8567accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8568.endd
8569the file could contains lines like this:
8570.code
8571user1@domain1.example
8572*@domain2.example
8573.endd
8574and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8575that are tried is:
8576.code
8577nimrod@jaeger.example
8578*@jaeger.example
8579*
8580.endd
8581&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8582would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8583
8584&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8585.code
8586deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8587deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8588.endd
8589The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8590because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8591domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8592.endlist
8593
8594
8595The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8596If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8597always fails.
8598
8599
8600.ilist
8601.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8602.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8603.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8604If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8605(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8606split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8607it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8608from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8609of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8610
8611.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8612The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8613keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8614patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8615even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8616with
8617.code
8618deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8619.endd
8620the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8621.code
8622baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8623.endd
8624to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8625
8626.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8627If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8628has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8629may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8630but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8631surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8632.code
8633aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8634 spammer3 : spammer4
8635.endd
8636As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8637doubling.
8638
8639If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8640of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8641list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8642might have entries like
8643.code
8644aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8645xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8646*: ^\d{8}$
8647.endd
8648in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8649local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8650each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8651chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8652
8653.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8654It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8655them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8656
8657.next
8658The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8659lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8660can only return a single list of local parts.
8661.endlist
8662
8663&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8664in these two examples:
8665.code
8666senders = +my_list
8667senders = *@+my_list
8668.endd
8669In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8670example it is a named domain list.
8671
8672
8673
8674
8675.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8676.cindex "case of local parts"
8677.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8678.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8679Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8680case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8681Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8682Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8683blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8684lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8685default.
8686
8687The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8688address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8689comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8690the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8691that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8692keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8693works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8694case-independent.
8695
8696.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8697To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8698an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8699part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8700longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8701lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8702performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8703become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8704
8705
8706
8707.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8708.cindex "list" "local part list"
8709.cindex "local part" "list"
8710Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8711lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8712setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8713set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8714case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8715matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8716&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8717option is case-sensitive from the start.
8718
8719If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8720comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8721only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8722Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8723that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8724&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8725Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8726types.
8727.ecindex IIDdohoadli
8728
8729
8730
8731
8732. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8733. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8734
8735.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8736.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8737Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8738them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8739
8740When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8741when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8742start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8743below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8744escape character, as described in the following section.
8745
8746Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8747dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8748options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8749the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8750conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8751reasons.
8752
8753
8754
8755.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8756.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8757An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8758backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8759character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8760If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8761required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8762the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8763
8764.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8765A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8766two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8767expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8768.code
8769deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8770.endd
8771On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8772without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8773string.
8774
8775
8776
8777.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8778.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8779A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8780expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8781carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8782octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8783backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8784encoding.
8785
8786These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8787in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8788and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8789
8790
8791.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8792.cindex "expansion" "testing"
8793.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8794.oindex "&%-be%&"
8795Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8796takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8797arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8798to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8799since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8800value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8801database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8802and &%nhash%&.
8803
8804Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8805instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8806using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8807
8808.oindex "&%-bem%&"
8809If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8810from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8811option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8812read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8813.code
8814exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8815.endd
8816The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8817Exim message identifier. For example:
8818.code
8819exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8820.endd
8821This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8822is therefore restricted to admin users.
8823
8824
8825.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8826.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8827A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8828alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8829(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8830used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8831instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8832the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8833that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8834its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8835from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8836taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8837being expanded.
8838
8839
8840
8841
8842.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8843The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8844between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8845outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8846white space is significant.
8847
8848.vlist
8849.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8850.cindex "expansion" "variables"
8851Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8852.code
8853$local_part
8854${domain}
8855.endd
8856The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8857characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8858&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8859section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8860given, the expansion fails.
8861
8862.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8863.cindex "expansion" "operators"
8864The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8865<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8866.code
8867${lc:$local_part}
8868.endd
8869The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8870leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8871below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8872one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8873string easier to understand.
8874
8875.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8876This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8877expansion item below.
8878
8879
8880.vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8881.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8882.cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8883The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8884arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8885Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8886arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8887and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8888are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8889a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8890the result of the expansion.
8891If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8892the expansion result is an empty string.
8893If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8894
8895
8896.vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
8897 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8898.cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
8899.cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
8900.cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
8901The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
8902The field name is expanded and used to retrive the relevant field from
8903the certificate. Supported fields are:
8904.display
8905&`version `&
8906&`serial_number `&
8907&`subject `& RFC4514 DN
8908&`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
8909&`notbefore `& time
8910&`notafter `& time
8911&`sig_algorithm `&
8912&`signature `&
8913&`subj_altname `& tagged list
8914&`ocsp_uri `& list
8915&`crl_uri `& list
8916.endd
8917If the field is found,
8918<&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8919otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8920variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8921is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8922
8923If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8924key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8925extracted is used.
8926
8927Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
8928
8929The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
8930output a Distinguished Name string which is
8931not quite
8932parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
8933(the exceptions being elements containin commas).
8934RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
8935a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
8936result is a list (newline-separated by default).
8937The separator may be changed by another modifer of
8938a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8939Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
8940
8941The field selectors marked as "time" above
8942take an optional modifier of "int"
8943for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
8944Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
8945in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
8946
8947The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
8948newline-separated by default,
8949(embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
8950The separator may be changed by a modifier of
8951a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8952
8953The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
8954prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
8955Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
8956which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
8957if so the elenment tags are omitted.
8958
8959If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
8960
8961.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8962 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8963.cindex &%dlfunc%&
8964This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8965This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8966.code
8967EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
8968.endd
8969set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8970object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8971(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8972
8973There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8974a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8975included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8976are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8977must have the following type:
8978.code
8979int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8980.endd
8981Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8982function should return one of the following values:
8983
8984&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8985into the expanded string that is being built.
8986
8987&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8988from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8989
8990&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8991taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8992
8993&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8994
8995When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8996you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8997configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8998
8999.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9000 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9001.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9002.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9003The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9004white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9005must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9006form:
9007.display
9008<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9009.endd
9010.vindex "&$value$&"
9011where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9012values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9013values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9014described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9015for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9016the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9017otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9018variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9019is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9020
9021If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9022key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9023extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9024yield &"2001"&:
9025.code
9026${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9027${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9028.endd
9029Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9030appear, for example:
9031.code
9032${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9033.endd
9034This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9035{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9036
9037
9038.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9039 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9040.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9041.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9042The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9043apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9044This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9045behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9046extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9047argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9048<&'string3'&> as before.
9049
9050The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9051separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9052The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9053counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9054number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9055number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9056expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9057provided. For example:
9058.code
9059${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9060.endd
9061yields &"42"&, and
9062.code
9063${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9064.endd
9065yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9066empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9067
9068
9069.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9070.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9071.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9072.vindex "&$item$&"
9073After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9074default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9075in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9076evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9077item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9078separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9079input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9080.code
9081${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9082.endd
9083yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9084to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9085
9086
9087.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9088.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9089.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9090This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9091early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9092(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9093
9094The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9095<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9096<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9097use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9098.code
9099${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9100.endd
9101The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9102or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9103Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9104function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9105first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9106.code
9107abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9108.endd
9109If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9110letters appear. For example:
9111.display
9112&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9113&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9114&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9115.endd
9116
9117.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9118 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9119 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9120 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9121 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9122 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9123.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9124.vindex "&$header_$&"
9125.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9126.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9127.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9128.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9129.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9130Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9131.code
9132$header_reply-to:
9133.endd
9134The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9135internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9136lines) may be present.
9137
9138The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9139the data in the header line is interpreted.
9140
9141.ilist
9142.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9143&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9144processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9145
9146.next
9147.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9148&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9149or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9150character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9151&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9152.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9153produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9154what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9155
9156.next
9157&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9158standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9159be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9160returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9161&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9162a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9163.endlist ilist
9164
9165In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9166command of the following form:
9167.code
9168headers charset "UTF-8"
9169.endd
9170This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9171subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9172character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9173option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9174value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9175ISO-8859-1.
9176
9177Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9178any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9179&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9180if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9181
9182Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9183this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9184message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9185filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9186router or transport are not accessible.
9187
9188For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9189before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9190message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9191are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9192point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9193by earlier ACLs are visible.
9194
9195Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9196following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9197this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9198white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
9199If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9200replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9201&<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9202
9203If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9204to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9205&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9206each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9207newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9208newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9209those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9210junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9211
9212
9213.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9214.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9215.cindex &%hmac%&
9216This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9217shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9218RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9219&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9220cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9221or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9222present. For example:
9223.code
9224${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9225.endd
9226For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9227produces:
9228.code
9229dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9230.endd
9231As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9232an Exim configuration:
9233.code
9234SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9235.endd
9236In a router or a transport you could then have:
9237.code
9238headers_add = \
9239 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9240 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9241 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9242.endd
9243Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9244&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9245this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9246host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9247using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9248&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9249
9250
9251.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9252.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9253.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9254If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9255item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9256in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9257.code
9258${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9259.endd
9260The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9261true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9262be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9263case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9264&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9265
9266If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9267is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9268cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9269.code
9270condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9271.endd
9272you can use
9273.code
9274condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9275.endd
9276
9277.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9278.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9279.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9280The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9281strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9282you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9283change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9284some of the braces:
9285.code
9286${length_<n>:<string>}
9287.endd
9288The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9289of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9290&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9291
9292
9293.vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9294 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9295.cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9296.cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9297.cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9298The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9299apart from an optional leading minus,
9300and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9301
9302After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9303default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9304
9305The first field of the list is numbered one.
9306If the number is negative, the fields are
9307counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9308The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9309then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9310
9311If the modulus of the
9312number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9313the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9314
9315For example:
9316.code
9317${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9318.endd
9319yields &"42"&, and
9320.code
9321${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9322.endd
9323yields &"result: 99"&.
9324
9325If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9326If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9327extracted is used.
9328You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9329
9330
9331.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9332 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9333This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9334described in the next item.
9335
9336.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9337 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9338.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9339.cindex "file" "lookups"
9340.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9341The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9342discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9343lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9344<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9345
9346If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9347a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9348other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9349in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9350out by the system administrator.
9351
9352.vindex "&$value$&"
9353If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9354During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9355lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9356level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9357the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9358string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9359lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9360original lookup fails.
9361
9362If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9363data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9364expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9365the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9366appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9367to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9368{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9369successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9370
9371For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9372search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9373type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9374&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9375
9376.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9377If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9378and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9379They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9380
9381This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9382.code
9383${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9384.endd
9385This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9386the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9387.code
9388${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9389 {$value}fail}
9390.endd
9391
9392
9393.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9394.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9395.vindex "&$item$&"
9396After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9397default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9398in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9399expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9400for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9401setting is not included in the output. For example:
9402.code
9403${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9404.endd
9405expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9406value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9407and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9408
9409.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9410.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9411.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9412The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9413<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9414if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9415can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9416.code
9417${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9418.endd
9419The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9420the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9421processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9422slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9423example,
9424.code
9425${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9426.endd
9427returns the string &"6/33"&.
9428
9429
9430
9431.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9432.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9433.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9434This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9435interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9436expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9437additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9438name of the subroutine, is nine.
9439
9440The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9441the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9442way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9443Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9444return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9445not its contents.
9446
9447If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9448with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9449Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9450
9451The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9452out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9453
9454
9455.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9456.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9457The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9458keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9459it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9460to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9461as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9462and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9463
9464.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9465 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9466.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9467This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9468checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9469yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9470empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9471prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9472version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9473variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9474
9475These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9476retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9477against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9478which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9479
9480The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9481string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9482result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9483whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9484is the expansion of the third argument.
9485
9486All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9487However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9488For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9489
9490.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9491.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9492.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9493.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9494The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9495then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9496the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9497newlines are left in the string.
9498String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9499you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9500the string expansion fails.
9501
9502The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9503locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9504
9505
9506
9507.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9508 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9509.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9510.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9511.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9512This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9513string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9514examples:
9515.code
9516${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9517${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9518.endd
9519For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9520For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9521a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9522number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9523optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9524example:
9525.code
9526${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9527.endd
9528Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9529one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9530both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9531(unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9532is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9533extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9534.code
9535${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9536.endd
9537A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9538that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9539turns them into spaces:
9540.code
9541${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9542.endd
9543As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9544happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9545addition, the following errors can occur:
9546
9547.ilist
9548Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9549.next
9550Failure to connect the socket;
9551.next
9552Failure to write the request string;
9553.next
9554Timeout on reading from the socket.
9555.endlist
9556
9557By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9558you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9559errors occurs. For example:
9560.code
9561${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9562 {socket failure}}
9563.endd
9564You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9565expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9566and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9567if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9568non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9569
9570The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9571locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9572
9573
9574.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9575.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9576.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9577.vindex "&$value$&"
9578.vindex "&$item$&"
9579This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9580<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9581separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9582assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9583list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9584them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9585iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9586added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9587number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9588.code
9589${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9590.endd
9591The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9592can be found:
9593.code
9594${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9595.endd
9596At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9597restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9598expansion items.
9599
9600.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9601This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9602expansion item above.
9603
9604.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9605 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9606.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9607.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9608The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9609split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9610in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9611executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9612a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9613
9614Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9615which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9616simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9617script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9618variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9619quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9620in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9621around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9622variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9623character.
9624
9625The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9626and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9627.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9628.vindex "&$value$&"
9629If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9630and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9631from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9632<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9633expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9634&$value$&.
9635
9636If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9637can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9638command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9639of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9640
9641.vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9642The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9643In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9644troubleshoot:
9645.code
9646warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9647 log_message = Output of id: $value
9648.endd
9649If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9650shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9651.code
9652${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9653.endd
9654
9655.vindex "&$runrc$&"
9656The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9657remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9658.code
9659if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9660 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9661 ...
9662endif
9663.endd
9664If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9665the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9666commands.
9667
9668&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9669option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9670testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9671by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9672
9673The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9674out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9675
9676
9677.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9678.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9679.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9680This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9681option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9682modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9683into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9684a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9685.code
9686${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9687.endd
9688yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9689if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9690substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9691.code
9692${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9693.endd
9694yields &"defabc"&, and
9695.code
9696${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9697.endd
9698yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9699the regular expression from string expansion.
9700
9701
9702
9703.new
9704.vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9705.cindex sorting a list
9706.cindex list sorting
9707After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9708default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9709The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9710of a two-argument expansion condition.
9711The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9712The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9713if the first value should sort before the second value.
9714The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9715the element being placed in &$item$&,
9716to give values for comparison.
9717
9718The item result is a sorted list,
9719with the original list separator,
9720of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9721
9722Examples:
9723.code
9724${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9725.endd
9726sorts a list of numbers, and
9727.code
9728${sort {$lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9729.endd
9730will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9731.wen
9732
9733
9734.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9735.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9736.cindex "substring extraction"
9737.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9738The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9739<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9740if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9741can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9742.code
9743${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9744.endd
9745The second number is optional (in both notations).
9746If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9747omitted.
9748
9749The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9750&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9751length required. For example
9752.code
9753${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9754.endd
9755If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9756null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9757length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9758given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9759
9760The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9761from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9762second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9763.code
9764${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9765.endd
9766yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9767length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9768the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9769.code
9770${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9771.endd
9772yields an empty string, but
9773.code
9774${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9775.endd
9776yields &"1"&.
9777
9778When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9779is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9780string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9781no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9782.code
9783${substr_-1:abcde}
9784${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9785.endd
9786yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9787
9788
9789
9790.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9791 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9792.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9793.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9794This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9795argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9796matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9797replacement list. For example
9798.code
9799${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9800.endd
9801yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9802last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9803last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9804place.
9805.endlist
9806
9807
9808
9809.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9810.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9811For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9812the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9813The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9814following operations can be performed:
9815
9816.vlist
9817.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9818.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9819.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9820The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9821header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9822not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9823
9824
9825.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9826.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9827.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9828The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
98292822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9830operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9831result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9832doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9833Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9834
9835It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9836separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9837character. For example:
9838.code
9839${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9840.endd
9841expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9842expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9843address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9844processing lists.
9845
9846To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9847a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9848unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9849email address seperator. For the example header line:
9850.code
9851From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9852.endd
9853The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9854properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9855It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9856example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9857de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9858The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9859quoted.
9860.code
9861# exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9862=?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9863user@example.com
9864# exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9865Last:user@example.com
9866# exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9867user@example.com
9868.endd
9869
9870.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9871.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9872.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9873The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9874base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9875the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9876its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9877names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9878be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9879
9880.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9881.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9882.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9883The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9884environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9885identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9886string.
9887
9888
9889.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9890.cindex "domain" "extraction"
9891.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9892The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9893from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9894
9895
9896.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9897.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9898.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9899If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9900escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9901significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9902is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9903
9904
9905.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9906.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9907.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9908.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9909These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9910expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9911arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9912logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9913integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9914C programming language):
9915.table2 70pt 300pt
9916.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9917.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9918.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9919.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9920.irow "" "and (&&)"
9921.irow "" "xor (^)"
9922.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9923.endtable
9924Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9925space is permitted before or after operators.
9926
9927For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9928hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9929decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9930permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9931times, which often do have leading zeros.
9932
9933A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
9934or 1024*1024*1024,
9935respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9936a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
9937
9938.display
9939&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9940&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9941&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9942&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9943&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
9944&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9945&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9946&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9947&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9948&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
9949&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9950.endd
9951
9952As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9953.code
9954deny message = Too many bad recipients
9955 condition = \
9956 ${if and { \
9957 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9958 { \
9959 < \
9960 {$recipients_count} \
9961 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9962 } \
9963 }{yes}{no}}
9964.endd
9965The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9966fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9967
9968
9969.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9970.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9971The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9972example,
9973.code
9974${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9975.endd
9976first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9977and then re-expands what it has found.
9978
9979
9980.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9981.cindex "Unicode"
9982.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9983.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9984.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9985The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9986email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9987to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9988UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9989converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9990the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9991
9992Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9993ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9994For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9995way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9996characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9997single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9998translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9999
10000
10001.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10002.cindex "hash function" "textual"
10003.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10004The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10005be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10006change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10007.code
10008${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10009.endd
10010See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10011abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10012
10013
10014
10015.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10016.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10017.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10018.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10019This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10020be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10021
10022
10023
10024.vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10025.cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10026.cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10027This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10028escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10029as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10030byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10031
10032
10033.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10034.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10035.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10036.cindex "lower casing"
10037.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10038.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10039This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10040.code
10041${lc:$local_part}
10042.endd
10043
10044.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10045.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10046.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10047The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10048can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10049changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10050.code
10051${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10052.endd
10053See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10054&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10055when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10056
10057
10058.vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10059.cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10060.cindex "list" "item count"
10061.cindex "list" "count of items"
10062.cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10063The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10064
10065
10066.vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10067.cindex "expansion" "named list"
10068.cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10069The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10070expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10071If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10072and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10073Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10074matching list is returned.
10075
10076
10077.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10078.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10079.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10080The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10081extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10082empty.
10083
10084
10085.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10086.cindex "masked IP address"
10087.cindex "IP address" "masking"
10088.cindex "CIDR notation"
10089.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10090.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10091If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10092slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10093expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10094masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10095the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10096.code
10097${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10098.endd
10099returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10100be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10101address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10102terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10103.code
10104${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10105.endd
10106returns the string
10107.code
101083ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10109.endd
10110Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10111
10112
10113.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10114.cindex "MD5 hash"
10115.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10116.cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10117.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10118The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10119as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10120
10121
10122.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10123.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10124.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10125The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10126that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10127strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10128.code
10129${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10130.endd
10131See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10132
10133
10134.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10135.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10136.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10137.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10138The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10139is an empty string or
10140contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10141Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10142Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10143respectively For example,
10144.code
10145${quote:ab"*"cd}
10146.endd
10147becomes
10148.code
10149"ab\"*\"cd"
10150.endd
10151The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10152variable or a message header.
10153
10154.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10155.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10156This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10157required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10158example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10159If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10160(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10161
10162
10163.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10164.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10165This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10166query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10167the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10168.code
10169${quote_ldap:two * two}
10170.endd
10171returns
10172.code
10173two%20%5C2A%20two
10174.endd
10175For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10176yields an unchanged string.
10177
10178
10179.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10180.cindex "random number"
10181This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10182supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10183on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10184If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10185If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10186for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10187Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10188srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10189random().
10190
10191
10192.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10193.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10194This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10195dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
10196dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10197for DNS. For example,
10198.code
10199${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10200${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10201.endd
10202returns
10203.code
102044.2.0.192
10205f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10206.endd
10207
10208
10209.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10210.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10211.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10212.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10213This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10214encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10215assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10216&%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10217contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10218characters
10219.code
10220? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10221.endd
10222it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10223string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10224characters.
10225
10226
10227.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10228.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10229.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10230.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10231This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10232bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10233character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10234not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10235
10236&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10237access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10238to use this operator as well.
10239
10240
10241
10242.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10243.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10244.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10245.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10246The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10247characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10248variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10249
10250
10251.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10252.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10253.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10254.cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10255.cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10256The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10257it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10258
10259
10260.vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10261.cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10262.cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10263.cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10264.cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10265The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10266certificate,
10267and returns
10268it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10269Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10270
10271
10272.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10273.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10274.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10275.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10276The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10277function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10278expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10279series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10280except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10281a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
1028210-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10283&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10284can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10285
10286The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10287the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10288systems for files larger than 2GB.
10289
10290.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10291.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10292.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10293.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10294This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10295
10296
10297
10298.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10299.cindex "expansion" "string length"
10300.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10301.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10302The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10303decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10304
10305
10306.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10307.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10308.cindex "substring extraction"
10309.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10310The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10311can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10312that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10313.code
10314${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10315.endd
10316See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10317abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10318
10319.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10320.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10321.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10322This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10323seconds.
10324
10325.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10326.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10327.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10328The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10329represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10330number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10331&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10332
10333.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10334.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10335.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10336.cindex "upper casing"
10337.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10338.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10339This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10340
10341.vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10342.cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10343.cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10344.cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10345.cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10346.cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10347This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10348.endlist
10349
10350
10351
10352
10353
10354
10355.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10356.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10357The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10358while expanding strings:
10359
10360.vlist
10361.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10362.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10363.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10364Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10365condition.
10366
10367.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10368.cindex "numeric comparison"
10369.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10370There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10371are:
10372.display
10373&`= `& equal
10374&`== `& equal
10375&`> `& greater
10376&`>= `& greater or equal
10377&`< `& less
10378&`<= `& less or equal
10379.endd
10380For example:
10381.code
10382${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10383.endd
10384Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10385two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10386optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10387lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10388As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10389zero.
10390
10391In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10392<&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
1039310M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10394
10395
10396.vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10397 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10398.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10399.cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10400The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10401arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10402Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10403arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10404and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10405are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10406a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10407the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10408If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10409If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10410
10411.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10412.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10413.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10414This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10415a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10416(case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10417false if zero.
10418An empty string is treated as false.
10419Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10420thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10421All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10422
10423When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10424make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10425For example:
10426.code
10427${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10428.endd
10429
10430
10431.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10432.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10433.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10434Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10435where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10436loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10437and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10438true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10439
10440Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10441
10442.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10443.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10444.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10445.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10446This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10447authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10448necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10449included in the binary.
10450
10451The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10452compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10453be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10454encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10455does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10456&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10457Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10458string in LDAP form is:
10459.code
10460{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10461.endd
10462If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10463be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10464.code
10465${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10466.endd
10467The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10468supported:
10469
10470.ilist
10471.cindex "MD5 hash"
10472.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10473&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10474printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10475length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10476(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10477hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10478comparison fails.
10479
10480.next
10481.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10482&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10483printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10484length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10485If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10486SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10487
10488.next
10489.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10490&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10491only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10492systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10493whatever its length.
10494
10495.next
10496.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10497&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10498use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10499modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10500.endlist
10501Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10502&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10503HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10504operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10505the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10506support &[crypt16()]&.
10507
10508Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10509it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10510turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10511&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10512algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10513
10514However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10515functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10516Exim is seen as very low priority.
10517
10518If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10519comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10520determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10521default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10522function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10523
10524.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10525.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10526.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10527The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10528variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10529variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10530.code
10531${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10532.endd
10533Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10534variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10535
10536.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10537 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10538.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10539This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10540exists in the message. For example,
10541.code
10542${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10543.endd
10544&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10545the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10546
10547.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10548 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10549.cindex "string" "comparison"
10550.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10551.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10552.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10553The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10554resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10555letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10556
10557.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10558.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10559.cindex "file" "existence test"
10560.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10561The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10562condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10563is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10564users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10565
10566.vitem &*first_delivery*&
10567.cindex "delivery" "first"
10568.cindex "first delivery"
10569.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10570.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10571This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10572attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10573
10574
10575.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10576 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10577.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10578.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10579.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10580.vindex "&$item$&"
10581These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10582the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10583the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10584be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10585condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10586.ilist
10587For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10588the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10589items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10590.next
10591For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10592and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10593all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10594.endlist
10595Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10596items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10597that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10598list separator is changed to a comma:
10599.code
10600${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10601.endd
10602The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10603being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10604
10605To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10606
10607
10608.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10609 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10610.cindex "string" "comparison"
10611.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10612.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10613.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10614The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10615string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10616comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10617case-independent.
10618
10619.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10620 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10621.cindex "string" "comparison"
10622.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10623.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10624.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10625The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10626string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10627includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10628case-independent.
10629
10630.vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10631 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10632.cindex "string" "comparison"
10633.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10634Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10635strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10636is true.
10637
10638These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10639Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10640.code
10641${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10642 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10643${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10644 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10645.endd
10646
10647.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10648 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10649 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10650.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10651.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10652.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10653.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10654.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10655The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10656an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10657&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10658
10659For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10660which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10661colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10662hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10663component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10664
10665&*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10666values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10667check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10668host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10669.code
10670${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10671.endd
10672to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10673
10674.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10675.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10676.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10677.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10678This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10679&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10680queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10681query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10682password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10683server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10684with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10685will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10686of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10687this can be used.
10688
10689
10690.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10691 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10692.cindex "string" "comparison"
10693.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10694.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10695.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10696The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10697string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10698comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10699case-independent.
10700
10701.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10702 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10703.cindex "string" "comparison"
10704.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10705.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10706.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10707The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10708string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10709includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10710case-independent.
10711
10712
10713.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10714.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10715.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10716.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10717The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10718expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10719regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10720escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10721(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10722premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10723&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10724For example,
10725.code
10726${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10727.endd
10728If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10729backslashes is also required.
10730
10731The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10732The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10733metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10734and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10735the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10736metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10737
10738.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10739At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10740substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10741succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10742will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10743of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10744combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10745variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10746
10747.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10748.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10749See &*match_local_part*&.
10750
10751.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10752.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10753See &*match_local_part*&.
10754
10755.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10756.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10757This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10758be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10759address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10760list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10761.code
10762${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10763.endd
10764The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10765
10766.ilist
10767An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10768.next
10769A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10770.next
10771An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10772useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10773in a single test such as
10774. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10775. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10776. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10777. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10778.code
10779 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10780.endd
10781where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10782.next
10783The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10784.next
10785Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10786even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10787address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10788&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10789masks. For example:
10790.code
10791 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10792.endd
10793It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10794do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10795address mask, for example:
10796.code
10797 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10798.endd
10799However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10800just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10801.code
10802 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10803.endd
10804.endlist ilist
10805
10806Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10807Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10808
10809Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10810
10811.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10812.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10813.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10814.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10815.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10816This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10817possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10818condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10819example is:
10820.code
10821${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10822.endd
10823In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10824list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10825expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10826Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10827.code
10828${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10829.endd
10830.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10831For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10832item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10833have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10834caselessly.
10835
10836Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10837Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10838
10839&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10840hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10841how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10842matched using &%match_ip%&.
10843
10844.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10845.cindex "PAM authentication"
10846.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10847.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10848.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10849.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10850&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10851(&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10852available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10853distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10854the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10855.code
10856SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10857.endd
10858in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10859in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10860
10861The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10862colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10863The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10864taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10865The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10866from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10867request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10868
10869There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10870characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10871separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10872item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10873of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10874.code
10875server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10876.endd
10877For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10878.code
10879server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10880.endd
10881In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10882running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10883messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10884A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10885Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10886The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10887to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10888group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10889
10890
10891.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10892.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10893.cindex "Cyrus"
10894.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10895.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10896This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10897This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10898that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10899deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10900
10901The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10902the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10903building Exim. For example:
10904.code
10905CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10906.endd
10907You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10908the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10909from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10910access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10911
10912The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10913password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10914configuration, you might have this:
10915.code
10916server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10917.endd
10918Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10919.code
10920server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10921.endd
10922.vitem &*queue_running*&
10923.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10924.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10925.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10926This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10927initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10928
10929
10930.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10931.cindex "Radius"
10932.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10933.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10934Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10935set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10936the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10937support.
10938
10939With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10940library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10941this library, you need to set
10942.code
10943RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10944.endd
10945in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10946&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10947.code
10948RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10949.endd
10950in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10951You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10952Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10953
10954The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10955Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10956the authentication is successful. For example:
10957.code
10958server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10959.endd
10960
10961
10962.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10963 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10964.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10965.cindex "Cyrus"
10966.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10967.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10968This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10969daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10970Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10971by a process that is not running as root.
10972
10973The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10974the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10975building Exim. For example:
10976.code
10977CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10978.endd
10979You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10980the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10981from the Cyrus SASL library.
10982
10983Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10984two are mandatory. For example:
10985.code
10986server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10987.endd
10988The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10989in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10990realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10991.endlist vlist
10992
10993
10994
10995.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10996.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10997Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10998and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10999conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11000sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11001the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11002
11003
11004.vlist
11005.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11006.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11007.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11008The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11009any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11010For example,
11011.code
11012${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11013.endd
11014When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11015evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11016numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11017
11018.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11019.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11020.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11021The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11022all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11023sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11024the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11025parsed but not evaluated.
11026.endlist
11027.ecindex IIDexpcond
11028
11029
11030
11031
11032.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11033.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11034This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11035of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11036support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11037
11038.vlist
11039.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11040.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11041When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11042captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11043processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11044However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11045values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11046variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11047precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11048Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11049matching condition.
11050
11051.vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11052Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11053any arguments are copied to these variables,
11054any unused variables being made empty.
11055
11056.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11057Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11058can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11059long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11060example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11061variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11062used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11063same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11064with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11065during subsequent delivery.
11066
11067.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11068These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11069are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11070received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11071message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11072also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11073message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11074and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11075delivery.
11076
11077.vitem &$acl_narg$&
11078Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11079this variable has the number of arguments.
11080
11081.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11082.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11083After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11084message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11085be preserved by coding like this:
11086.code
11087warn !verify = sender
11088 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11089.endd
11090You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11091&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11092failure.
11093
11094.vitem &$address_data$&
11095.vindex "&$address_data$&"
11096This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11097value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11098and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11099the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11100for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11101user filter files.
11102
11103If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11104a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11105conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11106to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11107of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11108from the child's routing.
11109
11110If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11111sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11112&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11113address.
11114
11115In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11116after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11117these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11118
11119.vitem &$address_file$&
11120.vindex "&$address_file$&"
11121When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11122to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11123is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11124default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11125.code
11126/home/r2d2/savemail
11127.endd
11128then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11129contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11130.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11131For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11132then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11133to the relevant file.
11134
11135.vitem &$address_pipe$&
11136.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11137When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11138this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11139
11140.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11141.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11142These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11143&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11144
11145.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11146.cindex "authentication" "id"
11147.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11148When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11149preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11150&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11151user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11152in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11153&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11154When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11155the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11156process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11157command line option.
11158
11159.vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11160.cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11161.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11162When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11163will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11164id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11165available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11166A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11167authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11168the ACL's as well.
11169
11170
11171.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11172.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11173.cindex "authentication" "sender"
11174.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11175.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11176When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11177SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11178described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11179&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11180available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11181sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11182
11183.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11184When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11185value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11186name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11187can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11188
11189
11190.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11191.cindex "authentication" "failure"
11192.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11193This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11194command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11195possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11196(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11197&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11198is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11199negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11200an undefined mechanism.
11201
11202.vitem &$av_failed$&
11203.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11204This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11205extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11206problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11207the ACL malware condition.
11208
11209.vitem &$body_linecount$&
11210.cindex "message body" "line count"
11211.cindex "body of message" "line count"
11212.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11213When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11214number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11215
11216.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11217.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11218.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11219.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11220.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11221When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11222number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11223
11224.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11225.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11226This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11227it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11228chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11229
11230.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11231.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11232This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11233up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11234file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11235
11236.vitem &$caller_gid$&
11237.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11238.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11239The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11240not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11241&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11242incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11243
11244.vitem &$caller_uid$&
11245.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11246.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11247The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11248not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11249&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11250incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11251
11252.vitem &$compile_date$&
11253.vindex "&$compile_date$&"
11254The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
11255
11256.vitem &$compile_number$&
11257.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11258The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11259of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11260compilations of the same version of the program.
11261
11262.vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11263.vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11264This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11265the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11266details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11267
11268.vitem &$demime_reason$&
11269.vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11270This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11271content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11272see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11273
11274.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11275 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11276 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11277 &$dnslist_value$&
11278.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11279.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11280.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11281.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11282.cindex "black list (DNS)"
11283When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11284the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11285looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11286main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11287
11288.vitem &$domain$&
11289.vindex "&$domain$&"
11290When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11291contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11292case for &$domain$&.
11293
11294Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11295&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11296is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11297message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11298
11299When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11300RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11301have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11302at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11303the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11304which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11305
11306.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11307At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11308set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11309
11310The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11311
11312.ilist
11313When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11314the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11315&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11316normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11317is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11318&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11319the &(smtp)& transport.
11320
11321.next
11322When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11323&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11324it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11325rewrite domains by file lookup.
11326
11327.next
11328With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11329&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11330a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11331is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11332that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11333recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11334
11335.next
11336.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11337.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11338When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11339the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11340.endlist
11341
11342
11343.vitem &$domain_data$&
11344.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11345When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11346means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11347of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11348address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11349transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11350used.
11351
11352&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11353domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11354the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11355to nothing.
11356
11357.vitem &$exim_gid$&
11358.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11359This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11360
11361.vitem &$exim_path$&
11362.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11363This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11364
11365.vitem &$exim_uid$&
11366.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11367This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11368
11369.vitem &$found_extension$&
11370.vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11371This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11372content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11373see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11374
11375.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11376This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11377inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11378be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11379characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11380
11381.vitem &$headers_added$&
11382.vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11383Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11384the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11385The headers are a newline-separated list.
11386
11387.vitem &$home$&
11388.vindex "&$home$&"
11389When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11390directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11391means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11392explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11393by a setting on the transport itself.
11394
11395When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11396of the environment variable HOME.
11397
11398.vitem &$host$&
11399.vindex "&$host$&"
11400If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11401list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11402to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11403to local and remote transports.
11404
11405.cindex "transport" "filter"
11406.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11407For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11408&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11409particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11410using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11411&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11412is connected.
11413
11414When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11415&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11416client is connected.
11417
11418
11419.vitem &$host_address$&
11420.vindex "&$host_address$&"
11421This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11422for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11423when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11424
11425.vitem &$host_data$&
11426.vindex "&$host_data$&"
11427If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11428result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11429allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11430.code
11431deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11432message = $host_data
11433.endd
11434.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11435.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11436.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11437This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11438message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11439name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11440variables is set to &"1"&.
11441
11442.ilist
11443If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11444succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11445
11446.next
11447If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11448tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11449lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11450.endlist ilist
11451
11452Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11453single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11454names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11455is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11456&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11457IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11458sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11459lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11460the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11461&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11462
11463.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11464.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11465See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11466
11467.vitem &$host_port$&
11468.vindex "&$host_port$&"
11469This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11470for an outbound connection.
11471
11472
11473.vitem &$inode$&
11474.vindex "&$inode$&"
11475The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11476option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11477of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11478a unique name for the file.
11479
11480.vitem &$interface_address$&
11481.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11482This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11483
11484.vitem &$interface_port$&
11485.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11486This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11487
11488.vitem &$item$&
11489.vindex "&$item$&"
11490This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11491conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11492&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11493empty.
11494
11495.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11496.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11497This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11498contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11499lookup.
11500
11501.vitem &$load_average$&
11502.vindex "&$load_average$&"
11503This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11504is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11505variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11506
11507.vitem &$local_part$&
11508.vindex "&$local_part$&"
11509When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11510variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11511delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11512session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11513
11514Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11515&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11516&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11517because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11518once.
11519
11520.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11521.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11522If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11523value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11524any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11525&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11526
11527When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11528result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11529the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11530&$address_pipe$&).
11531
11532When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11533local part of the recipient address.
11534
11535When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11536&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11537it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11538
11539In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11540the addresses
11541.code
11542"abc:xyz"@test.example
11543abc\:xyz@test.example
11544.endd
11545the value of &$local_part$& is
11546.code
11547abc:xyz
11548.endd
11549If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11550inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11551have:
11552.code
11553data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11554.endd
11555&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11556to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11557&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11558
11559.vitem &$local_part_data$&
11560.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11561When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11562lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11563router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11564to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11565handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11566
11567&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11568matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11569available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11570variable expands to nothing.
11571
11572.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11573.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11574When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11575specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11576variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11577
11578.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11579.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11580When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11581specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11582variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11583
11584.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11585.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11586This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11587a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11588
11589.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11590.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11591See &$local_user_uid$&.
11592
11593.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11594.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11595This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11596&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11597are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11598and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11599router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11600are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11601
11602.vitem &$localhost_number$&
11603.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11604This contains the expanded value of the
11605&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11606been read.
11607
11608.vitem &$log_inodes$&
11609.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11610The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11611log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11612referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11613the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11614
11615.vitem &$log_space$&
11616.vindex "&$log_space$&"
11617The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11618partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11619whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11620ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11621the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11622
11623
11624.vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11625.vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11626This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11627a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11628It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11629&"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11630and &"yes"& if it was.
11631
11632.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11633.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11634This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11635&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11636&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11637contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11638without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11639variable is empty.
11640
11641.vitem &$malware_name$&
11642.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11643This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11644content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11645when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11646
11647.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11648.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11649.cindex "maximum" "line length"
11650.cindex "line length" "maximum"
11651This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11652received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11653character(s).
11654
11655.vitem &$message_age$&
11656.cindex "message" "age of"
11657.vindex "&$message_age$&"
11658This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11659of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11660delivery attempt.
11661
11662.vitem &$message_body$&
11663.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11664.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11665.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11666.vindex "&$message_body$&"
11667.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11668This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11669being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11670number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11671&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11672
11673.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11674By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11675easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11676this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11677zeros are always converted into spaces.
11678
11679.vitem &$message_body_end$&
11680.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11681.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11682.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11683This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11684body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11685&$message_body$&.
11686
11687.vitem &$message_body_size$&
11688.cindex "body of message" "size"
11689.cindex "message body" "size"
11690.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11691When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11692in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11693separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11694also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11695
11696.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11697.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11698When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11699unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11700An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11701received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11702line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11703&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11704
11705.vitem &$message_headers$&
11706.vindex &$message_headers$&
11707This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11708is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11709lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11710same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11711
11712.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11713.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11714This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11715contents of header lines is done.
11716
11717.vitem &$message_id$&
11718This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11719
11720.vitem &$message_linecount$&
11721.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11722This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11723message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11724During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11725number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11726routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11727&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11728lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11729from the body is not counted.
11730
11731As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11732appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11733&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11734file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11735header and the body).
11736
11737Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11738.code
11739deny message = Too many lines in message header
11740 condition = \
11741 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11742.endd
11743In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11744message has not yet been received.
11745
11746.vitem &$message_size$&
11747.cindex "size" "of message"
11748.cindex "message" "size"
11749.vindex "&$message_size$&"
11750When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11751most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11752message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11753deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11754expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11755doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11756precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11757&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11758
11759.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11760While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11761contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11762value may not, of course, be truthful.
11763
11764.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11765A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11766available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11767details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11768
11769.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11770These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11771of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11772
11773.vitem &$original_domain$&
11774.vindex "&$domain$&"
11775.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11776When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11777same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11778generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11779variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11780differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11781aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11782single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11783
11784If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11785filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11786part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11787
11788.vitem &$original_local_part$&
11789.vindex "&$local_part$&"
11790.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11791When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11792same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11793local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11794part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11795filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11796the original address.
11797
11798If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11799case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11800This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11801one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11802delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11803
11804If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11805filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11806part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11807
11808.vitem &$originator_gid$&
11809.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11810.cindex "sender" "gid"
11811.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11812.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11813This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11814message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11815gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11816normally the gid of the Exim user.
11817
11818.vitem &$originator_uid$&
11819.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11820.cindex "sender" "uid"
11821.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11822.vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11823The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11824messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11825For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11826user.
11827
11828.vitem &$parent_domain$&
11829.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11830This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11831above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11832
11833.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11834.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11835This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11836(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11837
11838.vitem &$pid$&
11839.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11840.vindex "&$pid$&"
11841This variable contains the current process id.
11842
11843.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11844.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11845.cindex "transport" "filter"
11846.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11847This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11848&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11849&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11850(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11851It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11852variable"& error if encountered.
11853
11854.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11855.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11856This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11857configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11858a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11859&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11860qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11861
11862
11863.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11864This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11865which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11866&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11867
11868.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11869This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11870which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11871&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11872
11873.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11874This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11875which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11876&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11877
11878.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11879.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11880The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11881
11882.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11883.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11884The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11885or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11886
11887.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11888.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11889When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11890RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11891RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11892
11893.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11894.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11895.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11896When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11897RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11898temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11899
11900.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11901.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11902When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11903RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11904permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11905
11906.vitem &$received_count$&
11907.vindex "&$received_count$&"
11908This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11909including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11910is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11911delivering.
11912
11913.vitem &$received_for$&
11914.vindex "&$received_for$&"
11915If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11916variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11917built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11918the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11919
11920.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11921.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11922As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11923variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11924is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11925&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11926the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11927option.
11928
11929As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11930could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11931on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11932values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11933messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11934time.
11935For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
11936
11937.vitem &$received_port$&
11938.vindex "&$received_port$&"
11939See &$received_ip_address$&.
11940
11941.vitem &$received_protocol$&
11942.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11943When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11944protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11945by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11946&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11947(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11948is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11949connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11950
11951Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11952automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11953&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11954encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11955where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11956STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11957
11958The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11959messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11960identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11961
11962.vitem &$received_time$&
11963.vindex "&$received_time$&"
11964This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11965as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11966
11967.vitem &$recipient_data$&
11968.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11969This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11970condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11971until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11972.display
11973&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11974&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11975.endd
11976&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11977method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11978The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11979expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11980
11981.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11982.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11983In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11984information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11985
11986.ilist
11987&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11988was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11989
11990.next
11991&"route"&: Routing failed.
11992
11993.next
11994&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11995or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11996MAIL).
11997
11998.next
11999&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12000.next
12001
12002&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12003.endlist
12004
12005The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12006rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12007
12008.vitem &$recipients$&
12009.vindex "&$recipients$&"
12010This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12011a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12012is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12013unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12014cases:
12015
12016.olist
12017In a system filter file.
12018.next
12019In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12020is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12021&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12022&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12023.next
12024From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12025.endlist
12026
12027
12028.vitem &$recipients_count$&
12029.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12030When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12031envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12032from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12033increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12034
12035
12036.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12037.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12038This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12039&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12040
12041
12042.vitem &$reply_address$&
12043.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12044When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12045&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12046contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12047white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12048decoding or character code translation takes place.
12049
12050.vitem &$return_path$&
12051.vindex "&$return_path$&"
12052When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12053the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12054in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12055same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12056mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12057for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12058address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12059that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12060the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12061envelope sender.
12062
12063.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12064.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12065This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12066
12067.vitem &$router_name$&
12068.cindex "router" "name"
12069.cindex "name" "of router"
12070.vindex "&$router_name$&"
12071During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12072
12073.vitem &$runrc$&
12074.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12075.vindex "&$runrc$&"
12076This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12077&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12078assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12079preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12080reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12081another.
12082
12083.vitem &$self_hostname$&
12084.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12085.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12086When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12087local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12088One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12089happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12090original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12091
12092.vitem &$sender_address$&
12093.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12094When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12095that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12096is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12097value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12098
12099.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12100.vindex "&$address_data$&"
12101.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12102If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12103sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12104distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12105after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12106longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12107
12108.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12109.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12110The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12111
12112.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12113.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12114The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12115
12116.vitem &$sender_data$&
12117.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12118This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12119in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12120value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12121this:
12122.display
12123&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12124&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12125.endd
12126&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12127method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12128The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12129expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12130
12131.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12132.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12133When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12134name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12135brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12136enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12137issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12138looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12139&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12140start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12141verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12142the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12143the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12144
12145.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12146.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12147When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12148command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12149set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12150the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12151
12152.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12153.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12154When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12155this variable contains that
12156host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12157
12158.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12159.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12160This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12161driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12162received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12163&$authenticated_id$&.
12164
12165.vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12166.vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12167If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12168(by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12169otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12170resolver library states that the reverse DNS was authenticated data. At all
12171other times, this variable is false.
12172
12173It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12174library, by setting:
12175.code
12176dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12177.endd
12178
12179Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12180validating resolver (eg, unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12181
12182Exim does not (currently) check to see if the forward DNS was also secured
12183with DNSSEC, only the reverse DNS.
12184
12185If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12186mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12187
12188
12189.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12190.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12191When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12192host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12193other means, this variable is empty.
12194
12195.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12196If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12197&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12198A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12199via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12200any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12201&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12202
12203.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12204However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12205DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12206&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12207
12208Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12209host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12210in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12211is set to &"1"&.
12212
12213Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12214maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12215these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12216following are true:
12217
12218.ilist
12219A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12220.next
12221The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12222configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12223to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12224.next
12225Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12226that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12227&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12228.next
12229The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12230In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12231EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12232.next
12233The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12234domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12235. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12236. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12237.code
12238 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12239.endd
12240which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12241IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12242.endlist
12243
12244
12245.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12246.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12247When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12248number that was used on the remote host.
12249
12250.vitem &$sender_ident$&
12251.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12252When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12253identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12254been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12255called Exim.
12256
12257.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12258A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12259&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12260&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12261
12262.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12263.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12264.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12265.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12266This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12267either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12268there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12269there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12270the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12271followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12272first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12273the parentheses.
12274
12275There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12276was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12277address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12278all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12279into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12280
12281.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12282.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12283In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12284about the failure. The details are the same as for
12285&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12286
12287.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12288.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12289This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12290been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12291used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12292on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12293connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12294
12295.vitem &$sending_port$&
12296.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12297This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12298been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12299connections, see &$received_port$&.
12300
12301.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12302.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12303During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12304host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12305&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12306value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12307
12308.vitem &$smtp_command$&
12309.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12310During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12311entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12312the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12313.code
12314MAIL FROM:<>
12315MAIL FROM: <>
12316.endd
12317For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12318command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12319rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12320the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12321
12322.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12323.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12324.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12325While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12326argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12327space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12328somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12329
12330.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12331.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12332This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12333daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12334in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12335connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12336the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12337never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12338there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12339single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12340daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12341
12342.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12343These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12344that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12345filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12346example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12347message is junk mail.
12348
12349.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12350A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12351is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12352&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12353
12354
12355.vitem &$spool_directory$&
12356.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12357The name of Exim's spool directory.
12358
12359.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12360.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12361The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12362being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12363If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12364is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12365
12366.vitem &$spool_space$&
12367.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12368The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12369Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12370variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12371find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12372value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12373megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12374.code
12375condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12376.endd
12377See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12378
12379
12380.vitem &$thisaddress$&
12381.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12382This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12383command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12384command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12385interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12386
12387.vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12388.vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12389Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12390on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12391this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12392If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12393The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12394when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12395
12396The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12397except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12398the outbound.
12399
12400.vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12401.vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12402Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12403on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12404this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12405If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12406
12407.vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12408.vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12409This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12410inbound connection when the message was received.
12411It is only useful as the argument of a
12412.new
12413&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12414.wen
12415or a &%def%& condition.
12416
12417.vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12418.vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12419This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12420inbound connection when the message was received.
12421It is only useful as the argument of a
12422.new
12423&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12424.wen
12425or a &%def%& condition.
12426
12427.vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12428.vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12429This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12430outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12431.new
12432&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12433.wen
12434or a &%def%& condition.
12435
12436.vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12437.vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12438This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12439outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12440.new
12441&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12442.wen
12443or a &%def%& condition.
12444
12445.vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12446.vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12447This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12448message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12449
12450The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verfied$& variable refers to the inbound side
12451except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12452the outbound.
12453
12454.vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12455.vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12456This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12457outbound SMTP connection was made,
12458and &"0"& otherwise.
12459
12460.vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12461.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12462.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12463When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12464connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12465example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12466received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12467&$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12468non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12469
12470The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12471but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12472becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12473
12474.vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12475.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12476This variable is
12477cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12478and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12479&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12480details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12481
12482.vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12483.vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12484When a message is received from a remote client connection
12485the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12486.code
124870 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
124881 No response to request
124892 Response not verified
124903 Verification failed
124914 Verification succeeded
12492.endd
12493
12494.vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12495.vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12496When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12497the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12498See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12499
12500.vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12501.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12502.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12503When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12504connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12505the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12506&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12507
12508The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12509except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12510the outbound.
12511
12512.vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12513.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12514When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12515connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12516the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12517&$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12518
12519.vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12520.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12521.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12522.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12523When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12524Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12525If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12526some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12527will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12528a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12529used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12530
12531The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12532except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12533the outbound.
12534
12535.vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12536.vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12537.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12538During outbound
12539SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12540the transport.
12541
12542.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12543.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12544The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12545files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12546
12547.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12548.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12549The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12550
12551.vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12552.vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12553The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12554
12555.vitem &$tod_full$&
12556.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12557A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12558+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12559positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12560values for those that are behind (west).
12561
12562.vitem &$tod_log$&
12563.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12564The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
125651995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12566
12567.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12568.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12569This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12570is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12571flag.
12572
12573.vitem &$tod_zone$&
12574.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12575This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12576-0500.
12577
12578.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12579.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12580This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12581by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12582
12583.vitem &$transport_name$&
12584.cindex "transport" "name"
12585.cindex "name" "of transport"
12586.vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12587During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12588
12589.vitem &$value$&
12590.vindex "&$value$&"
12591This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12592or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12593&*reduce*& expansion.
12594
12595.vitem &$verify_mode$&
12596.vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12597While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12598or for cutthrough delivery,
12599contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12600Otherwise, empty.
12601
12602.vitem &$version_number$&
12603.vindex "&$version_number$&"
12604The version number of Exim.
12605
12606.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12607.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12608This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12609delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12610
12611.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12612.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12613This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12614delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12615.endlist
12616.ecindex IIDstrexp
12617
12618
12619
12620. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12621. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12622
12623.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12624.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12625Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12626Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12627use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12628your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12629the line
12630.code
12631EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12632.endd
12633in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12634
12635
12636.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12637.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12638Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12639&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12640no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12641interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12642the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12643option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12644a newly created Perl interpreter.
12645
12646The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12647need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12648should usually be something like
12649.code
12650perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12651.endd
12652where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12653use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12654soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12655the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12656its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12657fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12658necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12659the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12660two ways:
12661
12662.ilist
12663.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12664Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12665a startup when Exim is entered.
12666.next
12667The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12668overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12669.endlist
12670
12671There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12672initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12673
12674
12675.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12676When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12677of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12678by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12679forms:
12680.code
12681${perl{foo}}
12682${perl{foo}{argument}}
12683${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12684.endd
12685which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12686arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12687with an error message of the form
12688.code
12689Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12690.endd
12691The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12692it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12693return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12694an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12695by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12696that was passed to &%die%&.
12697
12698
12699.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12700Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12701is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12702the Perl code
12703.code
12704my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12705.endd
12706makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12707Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12708&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12709
12710If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12711&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12712expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12713an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12714
12715.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12716.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12717Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12718&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12719debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12720&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12721timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12722
12723
12724.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12725.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12726You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12727Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12728before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12729SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12730is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12731error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12732avoided, but the output is lost.
12733
12734.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12735The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12736Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12737you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12738output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12739change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12740For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12741.code
12742$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12743.endd
12744Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12745example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12746include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12747as the first subroutine argument.
12748.ecindex IIDperl
12749
12750
12751. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12752. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12753
12754.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12755 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12756 "Starting the daemon"
12757.cindex "daemon" "starting"
12758.cindex "interface" "listening"
12759.cindex "network interface"
12760.cindex "interface" "network"
12761.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12762.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12763.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12764.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12765A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12766hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12767or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12768works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12769In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12770IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12771knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12772
12773.olist
12774When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12775and ports to listen on.
12776.next
12777When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12778are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12779processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12780same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12781when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12782local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12783option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12784as an error situation.
12785.next
12786When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12787for the outgoing connection.
12788.endlist
12789
12790
12791Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12792of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12793addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12794standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12795rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12796
12797In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12798interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12799options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12800chapter describes how they operate.
12801
12802When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12803actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12804
12805
12806
12807.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12808When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12809option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12810following options:
12811
12812.ilist
12813&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
12814or service names.
12815(For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12816.next
12817&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12818listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12819.endlist
12820
12821The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12822described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12823it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12824colons. For example:
12825.code
12826local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12827 192.168.23.65 ; \
12828 ::1 ; \
12829 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12830.endd
12831There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12832in &%local_interfaces%&:
12833
12834.olist
12835The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12836on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12837.code
12838local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12839 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12840.endd
12841.next
12842The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12843with a colon separator, for example:
12844.code
12845local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12846 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12847.endd
12848.endlist
12849
12850When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12851default setting contains just one port:
12852.code
12853daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12854.endd
12855If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12856specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12857&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12858&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12859IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12860
12861
12862
12863.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12864The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12865as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12866case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12867instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12868default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12869.code
12870local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12871.endd
12872when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12873.code
12874local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12875.endd
12876Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12877
12878
12879
12880.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12881The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12882&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12883instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12884option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12885the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12886exim.
12887
12888The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12889changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12890contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12891&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12892items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12893replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12894.code
12895-oX 1225
12896.endd
12897overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12898whereas
12899.code
12900-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12901.endd
12902overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12903(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12904value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12905
12906
12907
12908.section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12909.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12910.cindex "smtps protocol"
12911.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12912.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12913Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12914before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12915still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12916list of port numbers or service names,
12917connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12918common use of this option is expected to be
12919.code
12920tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12921.endd
12922because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12923a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12924this way when a daemon is started.
12925
12926&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12927daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12928&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12929because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12930connections via the daemon.)
12931
12932
12933
12934
12935.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12936.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12937IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12938can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12939interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12940address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12941percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12942adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12943.code
12944fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12945.endd
12946To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12947allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12948to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12949percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12950address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12951&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12952.code
12953IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12954.endd
12955is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12956Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12957instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12958function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12959&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12960
12961.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12962.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12963Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12964run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12965using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12966connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12967.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12968&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12969activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12970that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12971etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12972to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12973
12974On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12975disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12976option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12977and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12978IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12979
12980
12981
12982.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12983The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12984.code
12985daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12986local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12987.endd
12988This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12989Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12990the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12991read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12992
12993To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12994.code
12995daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12996.endd
12997(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12998.code
12999local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13000 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13001.endd
13002To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13003IPv4 loopback address only:
13004.code
13005local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13006.endd
13007To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13008.code
13009local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13010.endd
13011&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13012
13013
13014
13015.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13016The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13017whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13018addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13019treated as local.
13020
13021For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13022the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13023available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13024(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13025
13026Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13027many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13028email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13029interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13030&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13031&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13032used for listening. Consider this example:
13033.code
13034local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13035 192.168.53.235 ; \
13036 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13037
13038extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13039.endd
13040The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13041address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13042Exim is routing.
13043
13044In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13045address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13046desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13047these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13048This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13049during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13050host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13051addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13052
13053
13054
13055.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13056Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13057allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13058there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13059&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13060description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13061details.
13062
13063
13064
13065
13066. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13067. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13068
13069.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13070.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13071.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13072The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13073
13074.ilist
13075Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13076&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13077.next
13078Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13079&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13080section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13081.next
13082Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13083(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13084&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13085only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13086settings.
13087.endlist
13088
13089This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13090types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13091in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13092are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13093an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13094listed in more than one group.
13095
13096.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13097.table2
13098.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13099.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13100.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13101.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13102.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13103.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13104.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13105.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13106.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13107.endtable
13108
13109
13110.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13111.table2
13112.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13113.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13114.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13115.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13116.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13117.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13118.endtable
13119
13120
13121
13122.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13123.table2
13124.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13125.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13126.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13127.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13128.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13129.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13130.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13131.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13132.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13133.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13134.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13135.endtable
13136
13137
13138
13139.section "Logging" "SECID99"
13140.table2
13141.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13142.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13143.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13144.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13145.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13146.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13147.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13148.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13149.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13150.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13151.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13152.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13153.endtable
13154
13155
13156
13157.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13158.table2
13159.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13160.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13161.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13162.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13163.endtable
13164
13165
13166
13167.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13168.table2
13169.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13170.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13171.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13172.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13173.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13174.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13175.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13176.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13177.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13178.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13179.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13180.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13181.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13182.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13183.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13184.endtable
13185
13186
13187
13188.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13189.table2
13190.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13191.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13192.endtable
13193
13194
13195
13196.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13197.table2
13198.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13199.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13200.endtable
13201
13202
13203
13204.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13205.table2
13206.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13207.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13208.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13209.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13210.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13211.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13212.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13213.endtable
13214
13215
13216
13217.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13218.table2
13219.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13220.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13221.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13222.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13223.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13224.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13225.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13226.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13227.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13228.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13229.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13230.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13231.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13232.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13233.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13234.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13235 connection"
13236.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13237.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13238.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13239.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13240.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13241.endtable
13242
13243
13244
13245.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13246.table2
13247.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13248.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13249.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13250.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13251.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13252.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13253.row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13254.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13255.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13256.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13257.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13258.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13259.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13260.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13261.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13262.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13263.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13264.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13265.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13266.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13267.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13268 words""&"
13269.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13270.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13271.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13272.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13273.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13274.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13275.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13276.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13277.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13278.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13279.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13280.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13281.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13282.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13283.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13284.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13285.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13286.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13287.endtable
13288
13289
13290
13291.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13292.table2
13293.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13294 item"
13295.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13296 item"
13297.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13298.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13299.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13300.endtable
13301
13302
13303
13304.section "TLS" "SECID108"
13305.table2
13306.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13307.row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13308.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13309.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13310.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13311.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13312.row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13313.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13314.row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13315.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13316.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13317.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13318.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13319.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13320.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13321.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13322.endtable
13323
13324
13325
13326.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13327.table2
13328.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13329.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13330.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13331.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13332.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13333.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13334.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13335.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13336.endtable
13337
13338
13339
13340.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13341.table2
13342.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13343.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13344.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13345.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13346.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13347.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13348.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13349.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13350.endtable
13351
13352
13353
13354
13355.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13356.table2
13357.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13358.endtable
13359
13360
13361
13362
13363
13364.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13365See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13366
13367.table2
13368.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13369.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13370.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13371.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13372.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13373.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13374.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13375.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13376.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13377.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13378.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13379.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13380.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13381.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13382 connection"
13383.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13384.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13385.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13386.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13387.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13388.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13389.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13390.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13391.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13392.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13393.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13394.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13395.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13396.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13397.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13398.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13399.endtable
13400
13401
13402
13403.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13404.table2
13405.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13406.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13407.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13408.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13409.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13410.row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13411.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13412.endtable
13413
13414
13415
13416.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13417.table2
13418.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13419.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13420.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13421.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13422 words""&"
13423.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13424.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13425.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13426.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13427.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13428.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13429.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13430.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13431.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13432.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13433.endtable
13434
13435
13436
13437.section "System filter" "SECID115"
13438.table2
13439.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13440.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13441 directory"
13442.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13443.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13444.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13445.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13446.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13447.endtable
13448
13449
13450
13451.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13452.table2
13453.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13454.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13455.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13456.row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13457.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13458.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13459.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13460.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13461.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13462.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13463.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13464.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13465.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13466.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13467.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13468.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13469.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13470.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13471.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13472.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13473.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13474.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13475.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13476.endtable
13477
13478
13479
13480.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13481.table2
13482.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13483.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13484.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13485.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13486.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13487.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13488.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13489.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13490.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13491.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13492.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13493.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13494.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13495.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13496.endtable
13497
13498
13499
13500.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13501Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13502&dagger;.
13503
13504.option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13505.cindex "8BITMIME"
13506.cindex "8-bit characters"
13507.cindex "log" "selectors"
13508.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13509This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13510EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13511However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13512takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13513
13514Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13515feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13516It now defaults to true.
13517A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13518.display
13519&url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13520.endd
13521
13522To log received 8BITMIME status use
13523.code
13524log_selector = +8bitmime
13525.endd
13526
13527.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13528.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13529.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13530This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13531read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13532further details.
13533
13534.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13535This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13536messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13537SMTP messages.
13538
13539.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13540.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13541.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13542This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13543non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13544
13545.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13546.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13547.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13548This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13549received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13550
13551.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13552.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13553This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13554See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13555
13556.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13557.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13558This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13559processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13560acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13561
13562.option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! unset
13563.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13564.cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13565.cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13566This option defines the ACL that,
13567if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13568is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13569processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13570acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13571
13572.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13573.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13574This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13575received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13576
13577.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13578.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13579This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13580received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13581
13582.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13583.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13584.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13585This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13586command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13587
13588
13589.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13590.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13591This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13592received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13593
13594.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13595.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13596This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13597a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13598&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13599
13600.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13601.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13602This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13603extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13604section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13605
13606.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13607This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13608received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13609further details.
13610
13611.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13612.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13613This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13614received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13615
13616.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13617.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13618This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13619received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13620
13621.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13622.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13623This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13624received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13625
13626.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13627.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13628This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13629received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13630
13631.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13632.cindex "admin user"
13633This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13634current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13635colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13636programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13637admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13638not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13639To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13640
13641.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13642.cindex "domain literal"
13643If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13644email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13645format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13646has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13647
13648Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13649format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13650addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13651&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13652domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13653configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13654the local host's IP addresses.
13655
13656
13657.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13658.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13659It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13660and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13661MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13662that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13663practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13664&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13665recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13666
13667.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13668.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13669.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13670Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13671camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13672that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13673experiment if they wish.
13674
13675If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13676UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13677letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13678enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13679adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13680suitable setting is:
13681.code
13682dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13683 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13684.endd
13685Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13686.code
13687dns_check_names_pattern =
13688.endd
13689That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13690
13691
13692.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13693.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13694.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13695If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13696response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13697Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13698Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13699advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13700authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13701&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13702authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13703
13704Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13705and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13706not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13707authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13708to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13709which Exim advertises AUTH.
13710
13711.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13712If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13713is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13714option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13715.code
13716auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13717.endd
13718.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13719If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13720the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13721expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13722
13723
13724.option auto_thaw main time 0s
13725.cindex "thawing messages"
13726.cindex "unfreezing messages"
13727If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13728new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13729this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13730being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13731saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13732
13733&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13734&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13735thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13736
13737
13738.option av_scanner main string "see below"
13739This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13740It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13741.code
13742sophie:/var/run/sophie
13743.endd
13744If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13745before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13746
13747
13748.option bi_command main string unset
13749.oindex "&%-bi%&"
13750This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13751the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13752just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13753required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13754
13755
13756.option bounce_message_file main string unset
13757.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13758.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13759This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13760for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13761chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13762
13763
13764.option bounce_message_text main string unset
13765When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13766message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13767delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13768
13769.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13770.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13771This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13772bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13773causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13774value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13775message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13776error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13777point at which the error was detected are returned.
13778.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13779
13780.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13781If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13782bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13783&%bounce_return_body%&.
13784
13785
13786.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13787.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13788.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13789.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13790This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13791senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13792limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13793any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13794that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13795
13796When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13797greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13798added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13799to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13800size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13801messages.
13802
13803.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13804.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13805.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13806.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13807This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13808bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13809connection. A typical setting might be:
13810.code
13811bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13812.endd
13813which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13814.code
13815MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13816.endd
13817The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13818address.
13819
13820.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13821.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13822.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13823This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13824domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13825section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13826
13827
13828.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13829This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13830domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13831section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13832
13833
13834.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13835This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13836address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13837section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13838
13839
13840.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13841This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13842address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13843section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13844
13845
13846.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13847This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13848callout verification. The default value is
13849.code
13850$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13851.endd
13852See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13853
13854
13855.option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13856See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13857
13858
13859.option check_log_space main integer 0
13860See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13861
13862.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13863.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13864.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13865RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13866system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13867word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13868multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13869exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13870of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13871set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13872
13873
13874.option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13875See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13876
13877
13878.option check_spool_space main integer 0
13879.cindex "checking disk space"
13880.cindex "disk space, checking"
13881.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13882The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13883message is accepted.
13884
13885.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13886.vindex "&$log_space$&"
13887.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13888.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13889When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13890want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13891testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13892&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13893
13894
13895&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13896either value is greater than zero, for example:
13897.code
13898check_spool_space = 10M
13899check_spool_inodes = 100
13900.endd
13901The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13902SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13903transit.
13904
13905&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13906files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13907&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13908
13909If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13910incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13911error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13912SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13913&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13914&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13915
13916The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13917number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13918
13919For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13920failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13921it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13922
13923.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13924.cindex "port" "for daemon"
13925.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13926This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13927listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13928backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13929
13930.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13931.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13932This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13933the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13934(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13935defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13936&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13937
13938.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13939See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13940
13941.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13942.cindex "warning of delay"
13943.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13944When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13945intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13946after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13947string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13948message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13949between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13950with
13951.code
13952delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13953.endd
13954the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13955the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13956because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13957just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13958.code
13959delay_warning = 6h
13960.endd
13961messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13962a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13963.code
13964delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13965.endd
13966Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
13967which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
13968Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
13969
13970.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13971.vindex "&$domain$&"
13972The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13973deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13974expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13975forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13976&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13977not sent. The default is:
13978.code
13979delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13980 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13981 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13982 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13983 } {no}{yes}}
13984.endd
13985This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13986&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13987&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13988&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13989
13990.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13991.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13992.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13993If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13994delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13995the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13996of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13997chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13998
13999.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14000.cindex "load average"
14001.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14002When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14003becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14004ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14005See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14006
14007
14008.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14009.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14010Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14011message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14012handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14013should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14014removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14015occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14016
14017.option disable_fsync main boolean false
14018.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14019This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14020ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14021a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14022build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14023really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14024distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14025
14026When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14027updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14028such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14029Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14030
14031
14032.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14033.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14034If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14035activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14036that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14037etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14038to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14039
14040
14041.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14042.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14043DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14044&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14045keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14046incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14047may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14048anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14049This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14050by a setting such as this:
14051.code
14052dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14053.endd
14054This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14055&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14056since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14057&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14058when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14059options are applied after this global option.
14060
14061.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14062.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14063When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14064names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14065the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14066contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14067a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14068done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14069value of this option. The default pattern is
14070.code
14071dns_check_names_pattern = \
14072 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14073.endd
14074which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14075they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14076permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14077accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14078&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14079empty string.
14080
14081.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14082This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14083DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14084
14085.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14086This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14087reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14088section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14089
14090
14091.option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14092.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14093.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14094If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14095DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14096default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14097
14098If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14099
14100
14101.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14102.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14103.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14104When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14105looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14106(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14107domain matches this list.
14108
14109This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14110not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14111servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14112
14113
14114.option dns_retrans main time 0s
14115.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14116The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14117retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14118defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14119time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14120totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14121take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14122parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14123but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14124to set in them.
14125
14126
14127.option dns_retry main integer 0
14128See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14129
14130
14131.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14132.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14133.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14134If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14135DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14136the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14137on.
14138
14139If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14140
14141
14142.option drop_cr main boolean false
14143This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14144handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14145described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14146
14147.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14148.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14149.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14150This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14151bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14152Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14153.code
14154dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14155.endd
14156The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14157panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14158
14159.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14160.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14161Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14162message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14163handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14164messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14165be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14166the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14167delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14168
14169
14170.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14171.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14172.cindex "copy of bounce message"
14173Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14174generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14175coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14176items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14177a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14178must be enclosed in double quotes.
14179
14180Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14181(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14182the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14183items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14184are examined. For example:
14185.code
14186errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14187 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14188 postmaster@mydomain.example
14189.endd
14190.vindex "&$domain$&"
14191.vindex "&$local_part$&"
14192The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14193and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14194there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14195.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14196variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14197
14198
14199.option errors_reply_to main string unset
14200.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14201By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14202.display
14203&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14204.endd
14205.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14206where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14207A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14208&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14209overrides the default.
14210
14211Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14212&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14213and warning messages. For example:
14214.code
14215errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14216.endd
14217The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14218address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14219&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14220own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14221not used.
14222
14223
14224.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14225.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14226.cindex "Exim group"
14227This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14228privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14229option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14230of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14231configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14232security issues.
14233
14234
14235.option exim_path main string "see below"
14236.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14237This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14238needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14239the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14240is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14241other place.
14242&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14243you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14244where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14245settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14246
14247
14248.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14249.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14250.cindex "Exim user"
14251This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14252privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14253time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14254options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14255
14256Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14257&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14258not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14259used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14260
14261
14262.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14263This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14264routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14265&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14266
14267
14268. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14269. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14270
14271.option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
14272 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14273.oindex "&%-t%&"
14274.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14275.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14276According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14277are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14278envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14279line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14280behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14281command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14282&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14283argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14284addresses.
14285
14286
14287.option finduser_retries main integer 0
14288.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14289On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14290distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14291related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14292Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14293errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14294many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14295retries.
14296
14297.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14298You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14299a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14300search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14301
14302
14303
14304.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14305.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14306On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14307ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14308delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14309&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14310feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14311warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14312freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14313is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14314supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14315message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14316freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14317log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14318logging that you require.
14319
14320
14321.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14322.cindex "HP-UX"
14323.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14324Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14325password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14326looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14327headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14328of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14329it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14330upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14331
14332When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14333expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14334login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14335user's name.
14336
14337.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14338Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14339pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14340name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14341.code
14342gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14343gecos_name = $1
14344.endd
14345
14346.option gecos_pattern main string unset
14347See &%gecos_name%& above.
14348
14349
14350.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14351This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14352server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14353implementations of TLS.
14354
14355
14356option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14357This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14358the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14359
14360See
14361&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14362for documentation.
14363
14364
14365
14366.option headers_charset main string "see below"
14367This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14368&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14369default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14370ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14371insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14372
14373
14374
14375.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14376.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14377.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14378This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14379section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14380&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14381sections are rejected.
14382
14383
14384.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14385.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14386.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14387This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14388all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14389header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14390zero means &"no limit"&.
14391
14392
14393
14394
14395.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14396.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14397.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14398Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14399mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14400some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14401this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14402if you want to do semantic checking.
14403See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14404set.
14405
14406
14407.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14408.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14409.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14410.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14411This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14412all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14413hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14414.code
14415helo_allow_chars = _
14416.endd
14417Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14418
14419
14420.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14421.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14422.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14423If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14424list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14425default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14426its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14427do.
14428
14429
14430.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14431.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14432.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14433By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14434&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14435to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14436condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14437Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14438to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14439necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14440encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14441Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14442
14443When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14444&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14445EHLO command either:
14446
14447.ilist
14448is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14449.next
14450.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14451.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14452matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14453calling host address, or
14454.next
14455when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
14456available) yields the calling host address.
14457.endlist
14458
14459However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14460fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14461be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14462
14463.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14464.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14465.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14466Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14467backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14468name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14469&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14470rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14471If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14472error.
14473
14474.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14475.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14476.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14477This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14478manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14479&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14480verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14481item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14482it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14483
14484This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14485delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14486configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14487domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14488&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14489
14490A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14491messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14492time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14493retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14494
14495
14496.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14497.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14498Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14499is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14500&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14501option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14502default configuration file contains
14503.code
14504host_lookup = *
14505.endd
14506which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14507is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14508
14509After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14510has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14511this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14512
14513.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14514.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14515After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14516unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14517&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14518&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14519
14520
14521.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14522This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14523to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14524first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14525if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14526if you want.
14527
14528&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14529multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14530&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14531case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14532
14533
14534
14535.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14536.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14537If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14538as soon as the connection is made.
14539This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14540nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14541connections immediately.
14542
14543The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14544ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14545sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14546incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14547chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14548
14549
14550.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14551.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14552This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14553happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14554you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14555127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14556the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14557list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14558local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14559.code
14560hosts_connection_nolog = :
14561.endd
14562If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14563
14564
14565
14566.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14567.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14568.cindex "host" "treated as local"
14569If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14570if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14571records
14572or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14573host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14574
14575This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14576&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14577section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14578&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14579that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14580chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14581interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14582
14583
14584.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14585.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14586This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14587to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14588The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14589
14590
14591
14592.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14593.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14594.cindex "discarding bounce message"
14595This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14596that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14597suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14598
14599After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14600because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14601message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14602the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14603again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14604bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14605for frozen messages. For example,
14606.code
14607ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14608.endd
14609retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14610failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14611failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14612value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14613dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14614&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14615
14616
14617.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14618.cindex "&""From""& line"
14619.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14620Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14621the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14622message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14623such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14624match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14625process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14626&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14627
14628
14629.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14630See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14631
14632
14633.option keep_malformed main time 4d
14634This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14635have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14636next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14637logged.
14638
14639
14640.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14641.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14642This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14643a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14644While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14645Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14646and constrained to be a directory.
14647
14648
14649.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14650.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14651This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14652a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14653While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14654Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14655and constrained to be a file.
14656
14657
14658.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14659.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14660This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14661Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14662Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14663
14664
14665.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14666.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14667This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14668to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14669Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14670identity to be proven.
14671
14672
14673.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14674.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14675This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14676the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14677cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14678
14679
14680.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14681.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14682This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14683LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14684details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14685with LDAP support.
14686
14687
14688.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14689.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14690This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14691A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14692See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14693Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14694to hard/demand.
14695
14696
14697.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14698.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14699If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14700connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14701"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14702of SSL-on-connect.
14703In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14704by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14705
14706
14707.option ldap_version main integer unset
14708.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14709This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14710LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14711-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14712the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14713has been built with LDAP support.
14714
14715
14716
14717.option local_from_check main boolean true
14718.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14719.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14720When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14721an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14722checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14723the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14724
14725&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14726locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14727&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14728
14729You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14730on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14731&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14732and the default qualify domain.
14733
14734If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14735and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14736&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14737&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14738
14739.cindex "envelope sender"
14740These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14741is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14742&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14743
14744For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14745request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14746has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14747
14748
14749
14750
14751.option local_from_prefix main string unset
14752When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14753matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14754ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14755done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14756appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14757&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14758example, if
14759.code
14760local_from_prefix = *-
14761.endd
14762is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14763.code
14764From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14765.endd
14766will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14767matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14768qualify domain.
14769
14770
14771.option local_from_suffix main string unset
14772See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14773
14774
14775.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14776This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14777listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14778&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14779options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14780&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14781&%local_interfaces%& is
14782.code
14783local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14784.endd
14785when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14786.code
14787local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14788.endd
14789
14790.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14791.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14792.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14793This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14794&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14795the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14796message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14797non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14798
14799
14800
14801.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14802.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14803When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14804an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14805do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14806also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14807See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14808&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14809
14810
14811
14812
14813.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14814.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14815.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14816.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14817Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14818uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14819value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14820after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14821host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14822range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14823systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14824&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14825characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14826time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14827section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14828
14829
14830
14831.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14832.cindex "log" "file path for"
14833This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14834files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14835when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14836name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14837are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14838Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14839section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14840used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14841variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14842configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14843&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14844early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14845
14846
14847.option log_selector main string unset
14848.cindex "log" "selectors"
14849This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14850writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14851minus characters. For example:
14852.code
14853log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14854.endd
14855A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14856logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14857
14858
14859.option log_timezone main boolean false
14860.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14861.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14862.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14863By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14864timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14865in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14866avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14867&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14868timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14869of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14870&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14871another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14872
14873
14874.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14875.cindex "too many open files"
14876.cindex "open files, too many"
14877.cindex "file" "too many open"
14878.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14879.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14880This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14881lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14882Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14883file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14884recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14885actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14886as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14887open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14888&%lookup_open_max%&.
14889
14890
14891.option max_username_length main integer 0
14892.cindex "length of login name"
14893.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14894.cindex "limit" "user name length"
14895Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14896&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14897this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14898an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14899
14900
14901.option message_body_newlines main bool false
14902.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14903.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14904.vindex "&$message_body$&"
14905.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14906By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14907the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14908option is set true, this no longer happens.
14909
14910
14911.option message_body_visible main integer 500
14912.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14913.cindex "message body" "visible size"
14914.vindex "&$message_body$&"
14915.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14916This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14917&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14918
14919
14920.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14921.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14922If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14923(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14924locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14925means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14926Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14927Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14928replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14929empty string, the option is ignored.
14930
14931
14932.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14933If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14934the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14935message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14936take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14937the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14938it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14939yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14940before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14941that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14942means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14943colons will become hyphens.
14944
14945
14946.option message_logs main boolean true
14947.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14948.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14949If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14950&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14951Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14952minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14953per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14954which is not affected by this option.
14955
14956
14957.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
14958.cindex "message" "size limit"
14959.cindex "limit" "message size"
14960.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
14961This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
14962value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
14963to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14964TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14965optionally followed by K or M.
14966
14967&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14968other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14969the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14970error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14971&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14972
14973Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14974exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14975failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14976an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14977the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14978message that an individual transport can process.
14979
14980If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14981maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14982failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14983virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14984probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14985default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14986some problems may result.
14987
14988A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
14989SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
14990SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
14991
14992
14993.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14994.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14995This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14996.code
14997SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14998.endd
14999in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15000moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15001and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15002standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15003lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15004
15005
15006.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15007Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15008it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15009contains a full description of this facility.
15010
15011
15012
15013.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15014.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15015This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15016be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15017option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15018
15019
15020.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15021This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15022message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15023recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15024It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15025safety precaution.
15026
15027When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15028list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15029the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15030contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15031can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15032
15033If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15034&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15035example is
15036.code
15037never_users = root:daemon:bin
15038.endd
15039Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15040harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15041transport driver.
15042
15043
15044.option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
15045.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15046This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15047by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15048each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15049
15050This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15051available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15052The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15053the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15054list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15055&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15056names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15057
15058Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15059SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15060yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15061adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15062invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15063
15064The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15065
15066Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15067"+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15068with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15069some now infamous attacks.
15070
15071Examples:
15072.code
15073# Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15074openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15075 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15076
15077# Disable older protocol versions:
15078openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15079.endd
15080
15081Possible options may include:
15082.ilist
15083&`all`&
15084.next
15085&`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15086.next
15087&`cipher_server_preference`&
15088.next
15089&`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15090.next
15091&`ephemeral_rsa`&
15092.next
15093&`legacy_server_connect`&
15094.next
15095&`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15096.next
15097&`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15098.next
15099&`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15100.next
15101&`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15102.next
15103&`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15104.next
15105&`no_compression`&
15106.next
15107&`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15108.next
15109&`no_sslv2`&
15110.next
15111&`no_sslv3`&
15112.next
15113&`no_ticket`&
15114.next
15115&`no_tlsv1`&
15116.next
15117&`no_tlsv1_1`&
15118.next
15119&`no_tlsv1_2`&
15120.next
15121&`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15122.next
15123&`single_dh_use`&
15124.next
15125&`single_ecdh_use`&
15126.next
15127&`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15128.next
15129&`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15130.next
15131&`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15132.next
15133&`tls_d5_bug`&
15134.next
15135&`tls_rollback_bug`&
15136.endlist
15137
15138As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15139all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15140to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15141to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15142release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15143where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15144
15145
15146.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15147.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15148This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15149to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15150The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15151
15152
15153.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15154.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15155.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15156.cindex "address" "source-routed"
15157The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15158percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15159replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15160also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15161option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15162but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15163an ACL.
15164
15165&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15166trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15167if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15168implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15169routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15170a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15171local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15172
15173
15174.option perl_at_start main boolean false
15175This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15176interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15177
15178
15179.option perl_startup main string unset
15180This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15181interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15182
15183
15184.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15185.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15186This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15187data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15188&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15189PostgreSQL support.
15190
15191
15192.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15193.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15194.cindex "pid file, path for"
15195This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15196process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15197to the host name:
15198.code
15199pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15200.endd
15201If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15202spool directory.
15203The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15204option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15205of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15206
15207
15208.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15209.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15210This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15211PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15212control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15213&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15214for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15215that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15216not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15217
15218
15219.option prdr_enable main boolean false
15220.cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15221This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15222to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15223If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15224If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15225an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15226is recieved. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15227
15228.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15229.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15230If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15231completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15232called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15233purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15234volume of mail. Use with care!
15235
15236
15237.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15238.cindex "name" "of local host"
15239.cindex "host" "name of local"
15240.cindex "local host" "name of"
15241.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15242This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15243HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15244option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15245The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15246server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15247
15248If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15249name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15250contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15251&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15252version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15253explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15254
15255
15256.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15257.cindex "printing characters"
15258.cindex "8-bit characters"
15259By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1526032&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15261when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15262sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15263is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15264characters.
15265
15266This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15267&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15268the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15269described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15270Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15271standards.
15272
15273
15274.option process_log_path main string unset
15275.cindex "process log path"
15276.cindex "log" "process log"
15277.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15278This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15279&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15280utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15281in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15282can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15283different spool directories.
15284
15285
15286.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15287.oindex "&%-M%&"
15288.oindex "&%-R%&"
15289.oindex "&%-q%&"
15290The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15291admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15292&%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15293
15294
15295.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15296.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15297.cindex "address" "qualification"
15298This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15299addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15300recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15301are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15302also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15303locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15304
15305Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15306unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15307&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15308addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15309necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15310addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15311&%primary_hostname%& value.
15312
15313
15314.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15315This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15316addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15317
15318
15319
15320.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15321.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15322.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15323.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15324This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15325A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15326domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15327next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15328
15329
15330.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15331.oindex "&%-bp%&"
15332The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15333queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15334&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15335
15336
15337.option queue_only main boolean false
15338.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15339.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15340If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15341whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15342next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15343delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15344
15345The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15346and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15347&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15348&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15349
15350
15351.option queue_only_file main string unset
15352.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15353.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15354This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15355one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15356it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15357each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15358For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15359&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15360.code
15361queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15362.endd
15363causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15364&_/some/file_& exists.
15365
15366
15367.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15368.cindex "load average"
15369.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15370.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15371If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15372all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15373happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15374the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15375the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15376false.
15377
15378Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15379option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15380determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15381&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15382
15383
15384.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15385.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15386When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15387because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15388all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15389This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15390threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15391connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15392circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15393where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15394should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15395re-evaluated for each message.
15396
15397
15398.option queue_only_override main boolean true
15399.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15400When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15401setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15402&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15403to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15404
15405
15406.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15407.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15408If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15409in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15410must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15411single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15412and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15413single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15414the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15415avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15416&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15417when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15418large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15419
15420
15421
15422.option queue_run_max main integer 5
15423.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15424This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15425can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15426but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15427start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15428very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15429however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15430started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15431
15432Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15433the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15434run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15435the daemon's command line.
15436
15437.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15438.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15439.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15440When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15441received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15442However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15443&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15444message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15445has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15446when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15447over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15448SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15449&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15450&%queue_domains%&.
15451
15452
15453.option receive_timeout main time 0s
15454.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15455This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15456maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15457the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15458&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15459controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15460
15461.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15462.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15463.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15464This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15465added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15466on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15467used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15468added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15469&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15470header lines. The default setting is:
15471
15472.code
15473received_header_text = Received: \
15474 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15475 {${if def:sender_ident \
15476 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15477 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15478 by $primary_hostname \
15479 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15480 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15481 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15482 ${if def:sender_address \
15483 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15484 id $message_exim_id\
15485 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15486.endd
15487
15488The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15489support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15490locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15491header lines such as the following:
15492.code
15493Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15494by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15495(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15496id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15497for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15498Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15499id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15500.endd
15501Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15502the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15503checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15504message was accepted.
15505
15506
15507.option received_headers_max main integer 30
15508.cindex "loop" "prevention"
15509.cindex "mail loop prevention"
15510.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15511When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15512counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15513have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15514This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15515
15516
15517.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15518.cindex "unqualified addresses"
15519.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15520This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15521recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15522qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15523affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15524addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15525host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15526or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15527option was not set.
15528
15529
15530.option recipients_max main integer 0
15531.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15532.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15533If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15534original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15535by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15536all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15537Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15538done.
15539
15540.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15541&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15542RCPT commands in a single message.
15543
15544
15545.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15546If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15547recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15548error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15549error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15550initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15551for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15552
15553
15554.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15555.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15556This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15557hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15558does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15559message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15560have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15561deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15562deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15563each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15564same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15565&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15566with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15567tagged with its process id.
15568
15569This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15570message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15571manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15572deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15573is received.
15574
15575.cindex "number of deliveries"
15576.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15577If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15578need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15579are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15580daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15581fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15582runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15583delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15584then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15585&%remote_max_parallel%&.
15586
15587If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15588&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15589doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15590host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15591
15592
15593.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15594.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15595.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15596When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15597domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15598.code
15599remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15600.endd
15601would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15602then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15603
15604
15605.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15606.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15607This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15608database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15609host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15610past failures.
15611
15612
15613.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15614.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15615.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15616Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15617intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15618straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15619retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15620the default value.
15621
15622
15623.option return_path_remove main boolean true
15624.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15625RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15626&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15627The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15628MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15629in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15630&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15631received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15632the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15633
15634
15635.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15636This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15637
15638
15639.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15640.cindex "RFC 1413"
15641.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15642RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
15643in the list.
15644
15645.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
15646.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15647.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15648This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15649no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15650
15651
15652.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15653.cindex "unqualified addresses"
15654.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15655This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15656sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15657&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15658not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15659it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15660&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15661using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15662
15663
15664.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15665.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15666This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15667TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15668connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15669other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15670still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15671this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15672connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15673tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15674hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15675
15676
15677
15678.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15679.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15680.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15681.cindex "inetd"
15682This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15683that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15684control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15685value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15686non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15687set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15688
15689A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15690has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15691that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15692and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15693
15694
15695.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15696.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15697.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15698Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15699the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15700check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15701client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15702client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15703
15704When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15705allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15706but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15707or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15708starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15709counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15710following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15711MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15712
15713
15714.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15715You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15716check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15717changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15718live with.
15719
15720
15721. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15722. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15723. We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15724. non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15725. zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15726. html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15727. inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15728. searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15729. the option name to split.
15730
15731.option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15732 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15733.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15734.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15735The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15736prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15737results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15738response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15739precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15740seen).
15741
15742
15743.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15744.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15745.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15746This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15747host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15748expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15749reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15750connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15751is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15752of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15753required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15754
15755&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15756constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15757happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15758without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15759could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15760doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15761
15762
15763
15764.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15765.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15766.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15767.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15768If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15769listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15770on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15771fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15772subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15773to all messages received in the same connection.
15774
15775A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15776if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15777also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15778various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15779
15780
15781. See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15782
15783.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
15784 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15785.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15786.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15787This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15788automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15789the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15790and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15791number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15792are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15793restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15794systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15795dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15796
15797
15798.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15799.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15800.cindex "host" "reserved"
15801When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15802number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15803that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15804&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15805restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15806of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15807of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15808the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15809individual host.
15810
15811For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15812set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
15813connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
15814provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
15815
15816
15817.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
15818.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
15819.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
15820.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15821This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
15822several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
15823is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
15824responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
15825incoming HELO or EHLO command.
15826
15827.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
15828The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
15829is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
15830in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
15831
15832If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
15833expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
15834used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
15835panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
15836value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
15837For example:
15838.code
15839smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
15840 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
15841.endd
15842
15843Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
15844messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
15845verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
15846&%helo_data%& value.
15847
15848.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
15849.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
15850.cindex "banner for SMTP"
15851.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
15852.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
15853This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
15854positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
15855.code
15856smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
15857 $version_number $tod_full
15858.endd
15859Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
15860multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
15861appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
15862in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
15863multiline response).
15864
15865
15866.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
15867.cindex "checking disk space"
15868.cindex "disk space, checking"
15869.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15870When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
15871option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
15872spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
15873leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
15874is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
15875
15876
15877.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
15878.cindex "connection backlog"
15879.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
15880.cindex "backlog of connections"
15881This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
15882this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
15883of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
15884attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
15885say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
15886out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
15887value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
15888attacks by SYN flooding.
15889
15890
15891.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
15892.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
15893.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
15894The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
15895the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
15896synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
15897fewer, but they still exist.
15898
15899Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
15900for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
15901client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
15902SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15903for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15904input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15905does detect many instances.
15906
15907The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15908If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15909hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15910(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15911
15912
15913
15914.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15915.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15916.vindex "&$domain$&"
15917If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15918command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15919chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15920are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15921argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15922example:
15923.code
15924smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15925 $sender_host_address
15926.endd
15927A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15928complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15929run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15930a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15931receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15932the command.
15933
15934
15935.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15936.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15937When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15938one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15939section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15940
15941
15942.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15943.cindex "load average"
15944If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15945accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15946If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15947the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15948systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15949&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15950
15951
15952
15953.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
15954.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
15955.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
15956Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
15957particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
15958.code
15959RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
15960.endd
15961causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
15962(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
15963example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
15964too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
15965dropped. The limit is set by this option.
15966
15967.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
15968When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
15969&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
15970Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
15971&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
15972not count towards the limit.
15973
15974
15975
15976.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
15977.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
15978.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
15979If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
15980Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
15981that subvert web
15982clients
15983into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
15984non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
15985
15986
15987
15988.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15989.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
15990.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
15991.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
15992Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
15993can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
15994recipients.
15995
15996Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
15997facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
15998&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
15999&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16000
16001When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16002&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16003rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16004respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16005values:
16006
16007.ilist
16008A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16009.next
16010An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16011fractional parts are allowed here.
16012.next
16013A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16014.next
16015A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16016because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16017.endlist
16018
16019For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16020first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16021.code
16022smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16023smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16024.endd
16025The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16026two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16027seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16028delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16029
16030
16031.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16032See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16033
16034
16035.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16036See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16037
16038
16039.option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
16040.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16041.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16042This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16043input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16044data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16045the message is abandoned.
16046A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16047.code
16048SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16049SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16050.endd
16051The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16052means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16053
16054
16055.oindex "&%-os%&"
16056The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16057&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16058this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16059of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16060timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16061
16062
16063.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16064This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16065&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16066
16067
16068.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16069.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16070.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16071In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16072&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16073reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16074to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16075policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16076&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16077example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16078.code
16079550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16080550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16081.endd
16082
16083.option spamd_address main string "see below"
16084This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16085extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16086The default value is
16087.code
16088127.0.0.1 783
16089.endd
16090See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16091
16092
16093
16094.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16095.cindex "multiple spool directories"
16096.cindex "spool directory" "split"
16097.cindex "directories, multiple"
16098If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16099subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16100sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16101subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16102arrival of the message.
16103
16104Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16105where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16106directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16107directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16108are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16109
16110It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16111changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16112&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16113after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16114automatically deleted.
16115
16116When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16117changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16118trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16119sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16120sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16121spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16122particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16123if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16124entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16125
16126
16127.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16128.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16129This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16130it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16131configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16132string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16133&$primary_hostname$&.
16134
16135If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16136that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16137log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16138Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16139as failures in the configuration file.
16140
16141By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16142tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16143
16144.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16145.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16146This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16147access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16148
16149.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16150.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16151This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16152variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16153is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16154&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16155
16156.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16157.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16158If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16159items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16160treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16161passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16162option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16163
16164
16165.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16166.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16167.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16168If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16169ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16170MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16171domain causes a syntax error.
16172However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16173syntax checking.
16174
16175
16176.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16177.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16178When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16179separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16180be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16181separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16182nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16183particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16184both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16185containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16186Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16187the LOG_ALERT priority.
16188
16189
16190.option syslog_facility main string unset
16191.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16192This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16193syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16194&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16195If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16196details of Exim's logging.
16197
16198
16199
16200.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16201.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16202This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16203syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16204&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16205
16206
16207
16208.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16209.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16210If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16211omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16212details of Exim's logging.
16213
16214
16215.option system_filter main string&!! unset
16216.cindex "filter" "system filter"
16217.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16218.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16219This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16220the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16221must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16222generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16223appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16224which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16225&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16226
16227
16228.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16229.vindex "&$address_file$&"
16230This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16231&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16232implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16233During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16234
16235
16236.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16237.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16238This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16239command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16240the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16241
16242.option system_filter_group main string unset
16243.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16244This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16245gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16246with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16247
16248.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16249.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16250.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16251This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16252is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16253contains the pipe command.
16254
16255
16256.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16257.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16258This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16259is used in a system filter.
16260
16261
16262.option system_filter_user main string unset
16263.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16264If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16265delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16266process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16267Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16268is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16269configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16270specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16271&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16272
16273If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16274under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16275transport option overrides.
16276
16277
16278.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16279.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16280.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16281.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16282If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16283TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16284turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16285performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16286should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16287However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16288this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16289daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16290TCP_NODELAY.
16291
16292
16293.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16294.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16295.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16296If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16297message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16298is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16299bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16300sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16301If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16302frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16303
16304&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16305frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16306messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16307
16308
16309.option timezone main string unset
16310.cindex "timezone, setting"
16311The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16312running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16313created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16314to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16315.code
16316timezone = UTC
16317.endd
16318The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16319or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16320is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16321time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16322runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16323unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16324
16325
16326.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16327.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16328.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16329.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16330When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16331of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16332response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16333chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16334
16335
16336.option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16337.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16338.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16339The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16340file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16341assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16342&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16343
16344&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16345receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16346use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16347option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16348
16349If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16350if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16351Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16352&<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16353
16354.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16355.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16356.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16357This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16358be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16359
16360See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16361
16362
16363.option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16364.cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16365The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16366the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16367interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16368suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16369
16370The value must be at least 1024.
16371
16372The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16373hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16374by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16375
16376If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16377number.
16378
16379Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16380little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16381larger prime than requested.
16382
16383
16384.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16385.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16386The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16387to be used by Exim.
16388
16389If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16390parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16391PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16392OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16393fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16394loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16395and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16396
16397If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16398loaded by Exim.
16399
16400If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16401Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16402does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16403See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16404
16405If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16406a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
164072.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16408in IKE is assigned number 23.
16409
16410Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16411of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16412"ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16413"ike23".
16414
16415The available primes are:
16416&`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16417&`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16418&`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16419
16420Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16421Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16422
16423The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16424to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16425whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16426tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16427need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16428userbase.
16429
16430Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16431is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16432applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16433used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16434mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16435prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16436acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16437
16438
16439.option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16440This option
16441must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16442status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16443Certificate Authority.
16444
16445
16446.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16447This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16448operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16449set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16450further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16451
16452
16453
16454.option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16455.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16456The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16457file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16458the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16459key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16460&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16461
16462See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16463
16464
16465.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16466.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16467.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16468If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16469&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16470support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16471TLS session.
16472
16473
16474.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16475.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16476.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16477This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16478The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16479connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16480different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16481permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16482in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16483preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16484&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16485
16486
16487.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16488.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16489.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16490See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16491
16492
16493.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
16494.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16495.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16496The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
16497a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
16498match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
16499are using either GnuTLS version 3.3.6 (or later) or OpenSSL,
16500you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
16501directory containing certificate files.
16502For earlier versions of GnuTLS
16503the option must be set to the name of a single file.
16504
16505With OpenSSL the certificates specified
16506explicitly
16507either by file or directory
16508are added to those given by the system default location.
16509
16510These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16511than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16512the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16513connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16514Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16515use the explicit directory version.
16516
16517See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16518
16519A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16520being unset.
16521
16522
16523.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16524.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16525.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16526This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16527certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16528&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16529either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16530&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16531
16532Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16533&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16534present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16535aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16536the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16537connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16538ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16539
16540A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16541matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16542certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16543abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16544state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16545such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16546but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16547certificate"&.
16548
16549Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16550certificates.
16551
16552
16553.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16554.cindex "trusted groups"
16555.cindex "groups" "trusted"
16556This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16557option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16558which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16559specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16560details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16561&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16562are trusted.
16563
16564.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16565.cindex "trusted users"
16566.cindex "user" "trusted"
16567This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16568option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16569trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16570&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16571If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16572Exim user are trusted.
16573
16574.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16575.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16576.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16577This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16578the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16579gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16580used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16581can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16582is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16583&%-F%& option.
16584
16585.option unknown_username main string unset
16586See &%unknown_login%&.
16587
16588.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16589.cindex "trusted users"
16590.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16591.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16592.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16593.cindex "envelope sender"
16594When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16595normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16596default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16597senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16598is used) is ignored.
16599
16600However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16601to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16602.code
16603exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16604.endd
16605.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16606The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16607other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16608users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16609patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16610identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16611users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16612followed by a hyphen
16613by a setting like this:
16614.code
16615untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16616.endd
16617If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16618restriction, you can use
16619.code
16620untrusted_set_sender = *
16621.endd
16622The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16623only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16624to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16625parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16626&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16627necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16628overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16629described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16630
16631The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16632&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16633&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16634envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16635sender address.
16636
16637
16638.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16639.cindex "&""From""& line"
16640.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16641Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16642an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16643particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16644of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16645matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16646&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16647default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16648.code
16649From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16650From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16651.endd
16652The pattern can be seen by running
16653.code
16654exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16655.endd
16656It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16657year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16658regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16659&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16660(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16661&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16662
16663
16664.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16665See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16666
16667
16668.option warn_message_file main string unset
16669.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16670.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16671This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16672for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16673been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16674&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16675&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16676
16677
16678.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16679.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16680If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16681See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16682.ecindex IIDconfima
16683.ecindex IIDmaiconf
16684
16685
16686
16687
16688. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16689. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16690
16691.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16692.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16693.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16694This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16695Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16696
16697For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16698&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16699which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16700provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16701&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16702
16703
16704
16705.option address_data routers string&!! unset
16706.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16707The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16708precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16709router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16710&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16711delivery of the address to be deferred.
16712
16713.vindex "&$address_data$&"
16714When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16715accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16716routers, and the eventual transport.
16717
16718&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16719that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16720in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16721either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16722put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16723
16724Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16725with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16726on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16727&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16728&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16729
16730The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16731for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16732you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16733.code
16734uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16735.endd
16736In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16737.code
16738file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16739.endd
16740This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16741lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16742
16743.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16744.vindex "&$address_data$&"
16745The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16746from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16747&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16748ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16749verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16750
16751
16752
16753.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16754.oindex "&%-bt%&"
16755.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16756If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16757by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16758your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16759having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16760routing.
16761
16762
16763
16764.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16765.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16766.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16767This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
16768routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
16769&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
16770&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
16771value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
16772includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16773well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16774you could put:
16775.code
16776cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16777.endd
16778on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16779and
16780.code
16781cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
16782.endd
16783on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
16784this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
16785explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
16786logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
16787
16788
16789.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
16790.cindex "case of local parts"
16791.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
16792By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
16793manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
16794If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
16795this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
16796part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
16797turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
16798more details.
16799
16800.vindex "&$local_part$&"
16801.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
16802.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
16803The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
16804router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
16805an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
16806is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
16807addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
16808and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
16809
16810This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
16811recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
16812modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
16813(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
16814
16815
16816
16817.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
16818.cindex "local user, checking in router"
16819.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
16820.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
16821.vindex "&$home$&"
16822When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
16823address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
16824local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
16825than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
16826holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
16827user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
16828preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
16829given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
16830overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
16831the router is skipped.
16832
16833If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
16834or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
16835setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
16836two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
16837setting to achieve this. For example:
16838.code
16839local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
16840.endd
16841Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
16842up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
16843&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
16844
16845
16846
16847.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
16848.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
16849This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
16850router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
16851evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
16852result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
16853&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
16854router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
16855
16856If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
16857precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
16858
16859This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
16860All &%condition%& options must succeed.
16861
16862The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
16863running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
16864the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
16865.code
16866condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16867.endd
16868Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
16869.code
16870condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
16871.endd
16872
16873A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
16874.code
16875condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16876condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
16877condition = foobar
16878.endd
16879
16880If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
16881of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
16882be specified using &%condition%&.
16883
16884.new
16885Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
16886are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
16887they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
16888parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
16889ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
16890Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
16891Router rules processing behavior.
16892
16893This is best illustrated in an example:
16894.code
16895# If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
16896# in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
16897
16898$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
16899true {yes} {no}}
16900
16901$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
16902 {yes} {no}}
16903.endd
16904In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
16905&"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
16906default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
16907(which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
16908string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
16909with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
16910resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
16911&" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
16912
16913In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
16914&%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
16915mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
16916conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
16917string characters.
16918
16919Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
16920true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
16921match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
16922contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
16923expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
16924.wen
16925
16926
16927.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
16928.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
16929If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
16930option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
16931the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
16932If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
16933output, and Exim carries on processing.
16934This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16935so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
16936option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
16937variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
16938&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
16939are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
16940The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
16941
16942
16943
16944.option disable_logging routers boolean false
16945If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
16946or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
16947unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
16948transport option of the same name.
16949
16950
16951.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
16952.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
16953.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
16954If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
16955the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
16956lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
16957expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
16958a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
16959
16960
16961
16962.option driver routers string unset
16963This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
16964to be used.
16965
16966
16967
16968.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
16969.cindex "envelope sender"
16970.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
16971If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
16972transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
16973there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
16974message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
16975provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
16976expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
16977
16978The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
16979subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
16980settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
16981setting.
16982
16983If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
16984the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
16985address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
16986expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
16987
16988If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
16989SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
16990any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
16991sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
16992settings:
16993.code
16994errors_to =
16995errors_to = ""
16996.endd
16997An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
16998this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
16999no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17000address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17001overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17002
17003.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17004If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17005MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17006path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17007setting &%return_path%&.
17008
17009The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17010manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17011implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17012
17013
17014
17015.option expn routers&!? boolean true
17016.cindex "address" "testing"
17017.cindex "testing" "addresses"
17018.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17019.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17020If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17021as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17022want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17023on for the system alias file.
17024See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17025are evaluated.
17026
17027The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17028&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17029an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17030
17031
17032
17033.option fail_verify routers boolean false
17034.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17035Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17036&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17037
17038
17039
17040.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17041If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17042verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17043
17044
17045
17046.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17047If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17048verifying a sender, verification fails.
17049
17050
17051
17052.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17053.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17054.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17055String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17056colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17057changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17058each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17059defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17060&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17061
17062If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17063associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17064list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17065randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17066transport for further details.
17067
17068
17069.option group routers string&!! "see below"
17070.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17071.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17072.cindex "transport" "local"
17073.cindex "router" "setting group"
17074When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17075specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17076process.
17077The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17078error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17079The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17080is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17081and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17082
17083
17084
17085.option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17086.cindex "header lines" "adding"
17087.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17088This option specifies a list of text headers, newline-separated,
17089that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17090Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17091option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17092the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17093&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17094message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17095header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17096&"see"& the added header lines.
17097
17098The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17099&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17100an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17101failures are treated as configuration errors.
17102
17103Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17104for a router; all listed headers are added.
17105
17106&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17107router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17108
17109.cindex "duplicate addresses"
17110.oindex "&%unseen%&"
17111&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17112additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17113For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17114address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17115modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17116circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17117which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17118avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17119
17120
17121
17122.option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17123.cindex "header lines" "removing"
17124.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17125This option specifies a list of text headers, colon-separated,
17126that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17127Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17128option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17129the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17130section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17131the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17132to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17133&"see"& the original header lines.
17134
17135The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17136&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17137the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17138errors.
17139
17140Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17141for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17142
17143&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17144router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17145
17146&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17147removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17148routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17149warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17150
17151
17152.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17153.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17154.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17155Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17156entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17157IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17158address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17159like
17160.code
17161remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17162.endd
17163by setting
17164.code
17165ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17166.endd
17167on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17168discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17169attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17170domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17171Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17172router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17173
17174You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17175means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17176.code
17177ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17178ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17179.endd
17180The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17181in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17182
17183This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17184addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17185is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17186domain that is being routed.
17187
17188.vindex "&$host_address$&"
17189During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17190checked.
17191
17192.option initgroups routers boolean false
17193.cindex "additional groups"
17194.cindex "groups" "additional"
17195.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17196.cindex "transport" "local"
17197If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17198the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17199&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17200any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17201and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17202
17203
17204
17205.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17206.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17207.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17208If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17209one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17210section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17211evaluated.
17212
17213The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17214used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17215asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17216the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17217some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17218.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17219.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17220Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17221section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17222
17223.vindex "&$local_part$&"
17224.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17225During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17226running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17227expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17228the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17229a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17230command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17231This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17232the relevant transport.
17233
17234When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17235behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17236means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17237callout.
17238
17239The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17240&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17241&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17242to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17243immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17244.code
17245real_localuser:
17246 driver = accept
17247 local_part_prefix = real-
17248 check_local_user
17249 transport = local_delivery
17250.endd
17251For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17252router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17253.code
17254 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17255 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17256.endd
17257
17258If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17259both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17260are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17261separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17262
17263
17264.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17265See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17266
17267
17268
17269.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17270.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17271.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17272This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17273local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17274&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17275mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17276character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17277parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17278&%username-foo%&.
17279
17280
17281.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17282See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17283
17284
17285
17286.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17287.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17288.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17289The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17290See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17291are evaluated, and
17292section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17293string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17294example:
17295.code
17296local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17297.endd
17298.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17299If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17300for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17301expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17302example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17303send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17304each virtual domain:
17305.code
17306postmaster:
17307 driver = redirect
17308 local_parts = postmaster
17309 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17310.endd
17311
17312
17313.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17314.cindex "log" "delivery line"
17315.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17316Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17317deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17318recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17319this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17320router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17321router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17322redirect addresses.
17323
17324
17325
17326.option more routers boolean&!! true
17327The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17328that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17329result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17330fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17331delivery to be deferred.
17332
17333If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17334further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17335.oindex "&%self%&"
17336However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17337means of the setting
17338.code
17339self = pass
17340.endd
17341or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17342does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17343case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17344
17345Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17346expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17347controls what happens next.
17348
17349
17350.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17351.cindex "timeout" "of router"
17352.cindex "router" "timeout"
17353If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17354address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17355router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17356intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17357host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17358
17359There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17360lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17361applies to all of them.
17362
17363
17364
17365.option pass_router routers string unset
17366.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17367Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17368&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17369routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17370these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17371router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17372of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17373be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17374to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17375&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17376
17377
17378
17379.option redirect_router routers string unset
17380.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17381Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17382generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17383example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17384point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17385
17386The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17387It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17388instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17389which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17390
17391
17392
17393.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17394.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17395.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17396This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17397router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17398Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17399through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17400
17401Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17402be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17403If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17404failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17405
17406If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17407below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17408&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17409existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17410preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17411
17412.cindex "NFS"
17413If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17414the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17415unavailable.
17416
17417This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17418options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17419look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17420full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17421these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17422to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17423that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17424transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17425
17426During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17427facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17428This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17429operates as follows:
17430
17431If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17432characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17433comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17434but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17435used. For example:
17436.code
17437require_files = mail:/some/file
17438require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17439.endd
17440If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17441&%require_files%& condition fails.
17442
17443Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17444checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17445directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17446access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17447
17448&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17449incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17450may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17451may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17452user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17453
17454&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17455&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17456without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17457is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17458check again in that process.
17459
17460The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17461be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17462existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17463circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17464not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17465name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17466as if the file did not exist. For example:
17467.code
17468require_files = +/some/file
17469.endd
17470If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17471handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17472option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17473
17474
17475
17476.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17477.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17478.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17479When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17480in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17481domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17482other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17483Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17484latter kind.
17485
17486This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17487hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17488router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17489set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17490for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17491same name.
17492
17493The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17494appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17495independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17496
17497
17498
17499.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17500.cindex "router" "home directory for"
17501.cindex "home directory" "for router"
17502.vindex "&$home$&"
17503This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17504&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17505transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17506sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17507forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17508cause the router to defer.
17509
17510Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17511&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17512place.
17513(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17514are evaluated.)
17515While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17516&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17517
17518When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17519the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17520delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17521of these values that is set:
17522
17523.ilist
17524The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17525.next
17526The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17527.next
17528The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17529.next
17530The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17531.endlist
17532
17533In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17534router, but not for the transport.
17535
17536
17537
17538.option self routers string freeze
17539.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17540.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17541This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17542list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17543and &(manualroute)& routers.
17544Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17545of remote hosts.
17546Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17547&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17548host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17549The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17550&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17551
17552Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17553example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17554error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17555reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17556freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17557cases:
17558
17559.vlist
17560.vitem &%defer%&
17561Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17562
17563.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17564The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17565be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17566behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17567
17568.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17569The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17570reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17571rewritten.
17572
17573.vitem &%pass%&
17574.oindex "&%more%&"
17575.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17576The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17577&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17578subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17579name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17580distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17581combination
17582.code
17583self = pass
17584no_more
17585.endd
17586ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17587Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17588be passed to the next router.
17589
17590.vitem &%fail%&
17591Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17592
17593.vitem &%send%&
17594.cindex "local host" "sending to"
17595The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17596setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17597makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17598is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17599different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17600.endlist
17601
17602
17603
17604.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17605.cindex "router" "checking senders"
17606If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17607address matches something on the list.
17608See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17609are evaluated.
17610
17611There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17612dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17613setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17614to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17615set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17616verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17617SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17618matters.
17619
17620
17621.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17622.cindex "IP address" "translating"
17623.cindex "packet radio"
17624.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17625There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17626it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17627mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17628routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17629is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17630code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17631SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17632
17633.vindex "&$host_address$&"
17634The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17635by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17636expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17637For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17638If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17639address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17640up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17641produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17642addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17643.code
17644translate_ip_address = \
17645 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17646 {$value}fail}}
17647.endd
17648The file would contain lines like
17649.code
1765010.2.3.128/26 some.host
1765110.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17652.endd
17653You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17654are doing.
17655
17656
17657
17658.option transport routers string&!! unset
17659This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17660and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17661only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17662after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17663and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17664delivery is deferred.
17665
17666The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17667have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17668(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17669
17670
17671
17672.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17673.cindex "current directory for local transport"
17674This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
17675to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
17676explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
17677file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
17678option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
17679overridden by a setting on the transport.
17680If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17681logged, and delivery is deferred.
17682See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
17683environment.
17684
17685
17686
17687
17688.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
17689.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
17690This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
17691local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
17692configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
17693pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
17694string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
17695setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
17696If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17697logged, and delivery is deferred.
17698
17699If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
17700&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
17701the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
17702the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
17703is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
17704
17705See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
17706environment.
17707
17708
17709
17710
17711.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
17712.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
17713The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17714that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17715result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17716fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
17717delivery to be deferred.
17718
17719When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
17720address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
17721overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
17722&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
17723the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
17724sometimes true and sometimes false).
17725
17726.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
17727Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
17728qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
17729delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
17730In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
17731&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
17732to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
17733&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
17734
17735&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
17736this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
17737only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
17738no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
17739a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
17740duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
17741duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
17742&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
17743so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
17744&%redirect%& router may be of help.
17745
17746Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
17747&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
17748subsequent routers.
17749
17750
17751.option user routers string&!! "see below"
17752.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
17753.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17754.cindex "transport" "local"
17755.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
17756.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
17757When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17758specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
17759The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17760error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17761This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
17762The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
17763the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
17764a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
17765See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
17766&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17767
17768
17769
17770.option verify routers&!? boolean true
17771Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
17772&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17773
17774
17775.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
17776.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
17777.oindex "&%-bv%&"
17778.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
17779If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
17780delivering in cutthrough mode or
17781testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
17782with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
17783restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
17784&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
17785
17786&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
17787SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
17788accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
17789user or group.
17790
17791
17792.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
17793If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
17794addresses,
17795delivering in cutthrough mode
17796or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
17797See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17798are evaluated.
17799See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
17800
17801
17802.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
17803If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
17804or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
17805See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17806are evaluated.
17807See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
17808.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
17809.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
17810
17811
17812
17813
17814
17815
17816. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17817. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17818
17819.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
17820.cindex "&(accept)& router"
17821.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
17822The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
17823used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
17824be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
17825specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
17826it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
17827up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
17828.code
17829localusers:
17830 driver = accept
17831 domains = mydomain.example
17832 check_local_user
17833 transport = local_delivery
17834.endd
17835The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
17836&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
17837When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
17838address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
17839
17840
17841
17842
17843
17844
17845. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17846. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17847
17848.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
17849.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
17850.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
17851The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
17852recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
17853unless &%verify_only%& is set.
17854
17855If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
17856SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
17857MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
17858However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
17859records.
17860
17861MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
17862looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
17863When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
17864except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
17865IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17866generic option, the router declines.
17867
17868Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
17869to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
17870are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
17871
17872.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17873.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17874.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
17875If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
17876address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
17877happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
17878
17879
17880.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
17881There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
17882Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
17883SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
17884MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
17885problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
17886
17887For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
17888&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
17889&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
17890an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
17891domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
17892such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
17893proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
17894look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
17895case routing fails.
17896
17897
17898.section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
17899.cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
17900There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
17901an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
17902domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
17903
17904Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
17905.ilist
17906The domain does not exist in DNS
17907.next
17908The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
17909convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
17910for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
17911.next
17912Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
17913.next
17914MX record points to a non-existent host.
17915.next
17916MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
17917&%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
17918.next
17919MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
17920addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
17921.next
17922The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
17923&%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
17924.next
17925&%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
17926not be found in the MX records (see below)
17927.endlist
17928
17929
17930
17931
17932.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
17933.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
17934The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
17935
17936.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
17937.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
17938If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
17939(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
17940process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
17941differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
17942the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17943
17944
17945.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
17946.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
17947The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
17948addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
17949enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
17950required. For example,
17951.code
17952check_srv = smtp
17953.endd
17954looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
17955expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
17956to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
17957submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
17958option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
17959normal way.
17960
17961When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
17962the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
17963host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
17964this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
17965SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
17966according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
17967
17968When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
17969the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
17970records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
17971this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
17972defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
17973and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
17974have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
17975trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
17976
17977See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
17978when there is a DNS lookup error.
17979
17980
17981
17982.option dnssec_request_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17983.cindex "MX record" "security"
17984.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17985.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17986.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17987DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17988the dnssec request bit set.
17989This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17990
17991
17992
17993.option dnssec_require_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17994.cindex "MX record" "security"
17995.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17996.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17997.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17998DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17999the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18000(AD bit) set wil be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18001This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18002
18003
18004
18005.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18006.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18007.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18008A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18009record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18010For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18011records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18012setting:
18013.code
18014mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18015.endd
18016This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18017has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18018the address record.
18019
18020
18021.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18022If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18023DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18024&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18025
18026
18027
18028
18029.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18030.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18031.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18032When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18033lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18034single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18035called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18036&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18037resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18038&'resolv.conf'&.
18039
18040
18041
18042.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18043.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18044.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18045If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18046qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18047an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18048expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18049occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18050&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18051any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18052header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18053
18054This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18055ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18056sense.
18057
18058When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18059servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18060making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18061some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18062name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18063header rewriting.
18064
18065
18066.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18067.cindex "address" "copying routing"
18068Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18069to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18070options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18071default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18072servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18073any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18074
18075If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18076domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18077local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18078lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18079routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18080message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18081without processing them independently,
18082provided the following conditions are met:
18083
18084.ilist
18085No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18086&%headers_remove%&.
18087.next
18088The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18089the domain.
18090.endlist
18091
18092
18093
18094
18095.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18096.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18097When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18098lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18099applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18100the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18101domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18102up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18103&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18104actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18105
18106Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18107record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18108local wildcard.
18109
18110
18111
18112.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18113If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18114DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18115&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18116
18117
18118
18119
18120.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18121.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18122If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18123added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18124if
18125.code
18126widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18127.endd
18128is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18129&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18130&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18131and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18132the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18133when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18134
18135
18136.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18137When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18138of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18139corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18140is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18141
18142These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18143for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18144such as that implied by
18145.code
18146domains = @mx_any
18147.endd
18148that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18149entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18150.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18151.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18152
18153
18154
18155
18156
18157
18158
18159
18160
18161. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18162. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18163
18164.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18165.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18166.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18167.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18168This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18169verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18170generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18171takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18172router handles the address
18173.code
18174root@[192.168.1.1]
18175.endd
18176by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18177consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18178are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18179.code
18180postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18181.endd
18182Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18183grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18184
18185.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18186If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18187declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18188&%self%& option determines what happens.
18189
18190The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18191controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18192also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18193Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18194
18195
18196
18197. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18198. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18199
18200.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18201.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18202.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18203The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18204Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18205not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18206must set
18207.code
18208ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18209.endd
18210in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18211
18212The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18213connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18214a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18215message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18216this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18217can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18218must not be specified for it.
18219
18220.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18221.option hosts iplookup string unset
18222This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18223names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18224(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18225and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18226happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18227
18228
18229.option optional iplookup boolean false
18230If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18231is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18232delivery to the address is deferred.
18233
18234
18235.option port iplookup integer 0
18236.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18237This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18238call.
18239
18240
18241.option protocol iplookup string udp
18242This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18243protocols is to be used.
18244
18245
18246.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18247This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18248default value is:
18249.code
18250$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18251.endd
18252The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18253query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18254
18255
18256.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18257If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18258returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18259string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18260in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18261&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18262whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18263up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18264
18265
18266.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18267This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18268returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18269router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18270response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18271check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18272address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18273the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18274following could be used:
18275.code
18276response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18277reroute = $local_part@$1
18278.endd
18279
18280.option timeout iplookup time 5s
18281This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18282machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18283call. It does not apply to UDP.
18284
18285
18286
18287
18288. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18289. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18290
18291.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18292.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18293.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18294.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18295The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18296routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18297route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18298normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18299route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18300messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18301
18302The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18303it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18304has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18305include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18306&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18307generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18308being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18309
18310.vindex "&$host$&"
18311In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18312router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18313an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18314transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18315with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18316passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18317host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18318text string.
18319
18320The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18321&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18322or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18323any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18324below, following the list of private options.
18325
18326
18327.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18328
18329.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18330The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18331
18332.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18333See &%host_find_failed%&.
18334
18335.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18336This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18337address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18338of the following values:
18339.code
18340decline
18341defer
18342fail
18343freeze
18344ignore
18345pass
18346.endd
18347The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18348error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18349forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18350&%pass_router%&),
18351.oindex "&%more%&"
18352overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18353router only if &%more%& is true.
18354
18355The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18356cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18357controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18358as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18359
18360The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18361state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18362generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18363
18364
18365.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18366.cindex "randomized host list"
18367.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18368If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18369is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18370overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18371crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18372same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18373(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18374deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18375
18376When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18377into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18378set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18379item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18380.code
18381route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18382.endd
18383The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18384randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18385If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18386randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18387&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18388
18389
18390.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18391If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18392Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18393example:
18394.code
18395route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18396.endd
18397If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18398router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18399deferred.
18400
18401
18402.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18403This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18404unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18405that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18406
18407
18408.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18409.cindex "address" "copying routing"
18410Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18411router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18412router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18413default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18414servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18415any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18416
18417If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18418domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18419local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18420lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18421&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18422addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18423same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18424if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18425
18426
18427
18428
18429.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18430The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18431rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18432entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18433described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18434Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18435.display
18436<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18437.endd
18438The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18439no options:
18440.code
18441route_list = \
18442 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18443 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18444.endd
18445The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18446list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18447usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18448single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18449pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18450&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18451except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18452That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18453lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18454in a &%route_list%&).
18455
18456The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18457matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18458then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18459&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18460
18461
18462
18463.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18464The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18465routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18466hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18467The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18468Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18469expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18470like this:
18471.code
18472dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18473thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18474.endd
18475This data can be accessed by setting
18476.code
18477route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18478.endd
18479Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18480decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18481requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18482possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18483be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18484
18485
18486
18487
18488.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18489A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18490always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18491declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18492and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18493in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18494as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18495
18496If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18497variables are set during its expansion:
18498
18499.ilist
18500.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18501If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18502&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18503.code
18504route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18505.endd
18506.next
18507&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18508.next
18509&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18510
18511.next
18512.vindex "&$value$&"
18513If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18514looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18515.code
18516route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18517.endd
18518.endlist
18519
18520Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18521semicolon is the default route list separator.
18522
18523
18524
18525.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18526Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18527optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18528is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18529specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18530by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18531
18532.ilist
18533Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18534the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18535be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18536.code
18537route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18538route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18539.endd
18540.next
18541When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18542colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18543enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18544number follows. For example:
18545.code
18546route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18547.endd
18548.endlist
18549
18550.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18551When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18552the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18553delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18554option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18555transport.
18556
18557Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18558hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18559interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18560records in the DNS. For example:
18561.code
18562route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18563.endd
18564If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18565example:
18566.code
18567route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18568.endd
18569If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18570randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18571that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18572be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18573Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18574happens is controlled by the
18575.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18576&%self%& option of the router.
18577
18578A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18579hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18580lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18581below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18582preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18583randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18584defined by MX preferences.
18585
18586If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18587not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18588preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18589
18590If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18591depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18592is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18593Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18594
18595If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18596most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18597router.
18598
18599DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18600failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18601&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18602
18603The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18604whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18605
18606
18607
18608.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18609The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18610present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18611&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18612other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18613per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18614routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18615
18616.ilist
18617&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18618setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18619.next
18620&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18621overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18622.next
18623&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18624find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18625also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18626.next
18627&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18628no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18629timeout), delivery is deferred.
18630.endlist
18631
18632For example:
18633.code
18634route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18635 domain2 host4:host5
18636.endd
18637If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18638DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18639result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18640or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18641call.
18642
18643&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18644called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18645instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18646lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18647function called.
18648
18649
18650
18651If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18652&%host_find_failed%& option.
18653
18654.vindex "&$host$&"
18655When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18656The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18657
18658
18659
18660.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18661In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18662transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18663
18664.ilist
18665.cindex "smart host" "example router"
18666The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18667&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18668named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18669.code
18670domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18671.endd
18672You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18673your first router something like this:
18674.code
18675smart_route:
18676 driver = manualroute
18677 domains = !+local_domains
18678 transport = remote_smtp
18679 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18680.endd
18681This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
18682&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
18683they are tried in order
18684(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
18685Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
18686.code
18687smart_route:
18688 driver = manualroute
18689 transport = remote_smtp
18690 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
18691.endd
18692There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
18693However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
18694example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
18695precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
18696always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
18697would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
18698always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
18699&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
18700
18701.next
18702.cindex "mail hub example"
18703A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
18704records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
18705the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
18706machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
18707&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
18708to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
18709using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
18710lookup is easier to manage.
18711
18712If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
18713to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
18714example:
18715.code
18716hub_route:
18717 driver = manualroute
18718 transport = remote_smtp
18719 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
18720.endd
18721This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
18722whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
18723if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
18724that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
18725domain can be used to find the host:
18726.code
18727through_firewall:
18728 driver = manualroute
18729 transport = remote_smtp
18730 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
18731.endd
18732The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
18733hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
18734data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
18735next router.
18736
18737.next
18738.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
18739.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
18740You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
18741SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
18742storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
18743can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
18744.code
18745save_in_file:
18746 driver = manualroute
18747 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
18748 route_list = saved.domain.example
18749.endd
18750though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
18751several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
18752different transports can be listed in the routing information:
18753.code
18754save_in_file:
18755 driver = manualroute
18756 route_list = \
18757 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
18758 *.saved.domain2.example \
18759 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
18760 batch_pipe
18761.endd
18762.vindex "&$domain$&"
18763.vindex "&$host$&"
18764The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
18765doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
18766file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
18767the address if the lookup fails.
18768
18769.next
18770.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
18771Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
18772&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
18773one way it can be done:
18774.code
18775# Transport
18776uucp:
18777 driver = pipe
18778 user = nobody
18779 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
18780 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
18781 return_fail_output = true
18782
18783# Router
18784uucphost:
18785 transport = uucp
18786 driver = manualroute
18787 route_data = \
18788 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
18789.endd
18790The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
18791.code
18792darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
18793.endd
18794It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
18795makes clear the distinction between the domain name
18796&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
18797.endlist
18798.ecindex IIDmanrou1
18799.ecindex IIDmanrou2
18800
18801
18802
18803
18804
18805
18806
18807
18808. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18809. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18810
18811.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
18812.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
18813.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
18814.cindex "routing" "by external program"
18815The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
18816and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
18817mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
18818However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
18819&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
18820be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
18821options:
18822.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
18823
18824.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
18825This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
18826command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
18827expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
18828&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
18829
18830
18831.option command_group queryprogram string unset
18832.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
18833This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
18834address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
18835uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
18836gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
18837
18838
18839.option command_user queryprogram string unset
18840.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
18841This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
18842command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
18843it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
18844using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
18845not set, a value for the gid also.
18846
18847&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
18848root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
18849However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
18850usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
18851is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
18852the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
18853gid.
18854
18855
18856.option current_directory queryprogram string /
18857This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
18858before running the command.
18859
18860
18861.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
18862If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
18863is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
18864timeout.
18865
18866
18867The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
18868the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
18869containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
18870the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
18871field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
18872
18873.ilist
18874&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
18875below).
18876.next
18877&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
18878&%no_more%& is set.
18879.next
18880&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
18881subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
18882of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
18883included in the SMTP response.
18884.next
18885&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
18886subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
18887included in any SMTP response.
18888.next
18889&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
18890.next
18891&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
18892&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
18893.next
18894&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
18895new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
18896or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
18897.endlist
18898
18899When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
18900number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
18901the page):
18902.code
18903ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
18904LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
18905.endd
18906The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
18907is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
18908used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
18909an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
18910
18911The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
18912As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
18913in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
18914&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
18915(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
18916
18917If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
18918find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
18919anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
18920goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
18921result of the lookup is the result of that call.
18922
18923.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18924If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
18925variable. For example, this return line
18926.code
18927accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
18928.endd
18929routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
18930the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
18931.ecindex IIDquerou1
18932.ecindex IIDquerou2
18933
18934
18935
18936
18937. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18938. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18939
18940.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
18941.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
18942.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
18943.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
18944.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
18945The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
18946common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
18947(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
18948files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
18949redirected in several different ways:
18950
18951.ilist
18952It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
18953independently.
18954.next
18955It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
18956.next
18957It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
18958.next
18959It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
18960.next
18961It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
18962.next
18963It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
18964.next
18965It can be discarded.
18966.endlist
18967
18968The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
18969However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
18970files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
18971&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
18972
18973
18974
18975.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
18976The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
18977expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
18978contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
18979options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
18980aliases, in a configuration like this:
18981.code
18982system_aliases:
18983 driver = redirect
18984 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
18985.endd
18986If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
18987expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
18988expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
18989cause delivery to be deferred.
18990
18991A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
18992&_.forward_& files, like this:
18993.code
18994userforward:
18995 driver = redirect
18996 check_local_user
18997 file = $home/.forward
18998 no_verify
18999.endd
19000If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19001empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19002is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19003yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19004comments.
19005
19006
19007
19008.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19009.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19010It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19011&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19012
19013.ilist
19014When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19015running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19016the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19017practice the router may not be able to operate.
19018.next
19019However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19020is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19021local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19022saves some resources.
19023.endlist
19024
19025
19026
19027
19028
19029
19030.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19031.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19032.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19033The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19034can be interpreted in two different ways:
19035
19036.ilist
19037If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19038&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19039&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19040respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19041in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19042document is intended for use by end users.
19043.next
19044Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19045described in the next section.
19046.endlist
19047
19048When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19049in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19050generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19051configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19052for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19053
19054
19055
19056.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19057.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19058When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19059comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19060addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19061&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19062disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19063depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19064commas or newlines.
19065If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19066quotes.
19067
19068Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19069also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19070next newline character is ignored.
19071
19072If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19073double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19074(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19075&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19076removed.
19077
19078.vindex "&$local_part$&"
19079&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19080and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19081of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19082special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19083&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19084setting:
19085.code
19086data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19087.endd
19088
19089
19090.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19091.cindex "routing" "loops in"
19092.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19093.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19094A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19095consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19096automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19097is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19098Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19099as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19100complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19101
19102.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19103Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19104filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19105mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19106&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19107.code
19108cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19109.endd
19110.cindex "backslash in alias file"
19111.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19112For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19113preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19114it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19115synonymously.
19116
19117If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
191182822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19119domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19120addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19121force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19122
19123Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19124Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19125contains:
19126.code
19127Sam.Reman: spqr
19128.endd
19129Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19130messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19131this forward file:
19132.code
19133Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19134.endd
19135With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19136&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19137second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19138and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19139should really contain
19140.code
19141spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19142.endd
19143but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19144below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19145&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19146
19147
19148
19149.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19150In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19151lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19152
19153.ilist
19154.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19155.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19156An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19157as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19158command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19159Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19160which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19161
19162Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19163the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19164the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19165in double quotes, for example:
19166.code
19167"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19168.endd
19169since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19170quote just the command. An item such as
19171.code
19172|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19173.endd
19174is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19175
19176Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19177of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19178redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19179quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19180string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19181are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19182data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19183transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19184an &%accept%& router.
19185
19186.next
19187.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19188.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19189An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19190parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19191.code
19192/home/world/minbari
19193.endd
19194is treated as a file name, but
19195.code
19196/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19197.endd
19198is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19199the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19200forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19201file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19202
19203Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19204which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19205
19206.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19207However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19208bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19209instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19210
19211.next
19212.cindex "included address list"
19213.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19214If an item is of the form
19215.code
19216:include:<path name>
19217.endd
19218a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19219point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19220out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19221by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19222item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19223the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19224.code
19225list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19226.endd
19227It must be given as
19228.code
19229list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19230.endd
19231.next
19232.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19233Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19234&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19235the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19236.cindex "black hole"
19237.cindex "abandoning mail"
19238&':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19239done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
19240&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19241
19242&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19243delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19244are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19245database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19246&_/dev/null_&.
19247
19248.next
19249.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19250.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19251.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19252.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19253.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19254An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19255redirection items of the form
19256.code
19257:defer:
19258:fail:
19259.endd
19260respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19261to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19262text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19263associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19264.code
19265X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19266.endd
19267In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19268of a
19269.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19270VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19271default.
19272.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19273The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19274the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19275
19276.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19277By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19278&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19279space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19280followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19281code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19282incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19283suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19284&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19285ignored.
19286
19287.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19288In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19289default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19290therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19291
19292Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19293not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19294normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19295as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19296lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19297
19298During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19299containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19300whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19301subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19302deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19303rules still apply.
19304
19305.next
19306.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19307Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19308chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19309for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19310&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19311router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19312results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19313.endlist
19314
19315
19316.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19317.cindex "duplicate addresses"
19318.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19319.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19320Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19321to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19322routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19323aliasing scheme of the type
19324.code
19325pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19326localpart1: pipe
19327localpart2: pipe
19328.endd
19329does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19330when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19331discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19332such as
19333.code
19334localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19335localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19336.endd
19337does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19338the pipes are distinct.
19339
19340
19341
19342.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19343.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19344.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19345When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19346leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19347afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19348delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19349members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19350can be used to avoid this.
19351
19352
19353.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19354.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19355If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19356error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19357for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19358detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19359deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19360
19361
19362
19363.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19364
19365.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19366The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19367
19368
19369.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19370Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19371data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19372
19373
19374.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19375.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19376If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19377and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19378
19379
19380.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19381.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19382.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19383Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19384&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19385are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19386lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19387
19388It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19389the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19390
19391
19392The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19393&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19394&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19395files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19396true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19397
19398
19399
19400.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19401.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19402Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19403This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19404default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19405let ordinary users do.
19406
19407
19408
19409.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19410This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19411as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19412Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19413configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19414for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19415
19416When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19417is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19418the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19419and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19420domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19421&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19422.code
19423\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19424.endd
19425Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19426&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19427originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19428(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19429&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19430&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19431file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19432original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19433
19434
19435.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19436When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19437when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19438&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19439&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19440deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19441is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19442&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19443
19444
19445
19446.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19447When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19448this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19449permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19450option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19451&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19452
19453
19454.option data redirect string&!! unset
19455This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19456set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19457list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19458expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19459has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19460
19461When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19462filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19463terminated with newline characters. For example:
19464.code
19465data = #Exim filter\n\
19466 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19467.endd
19468If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19469you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19470choice into a newline.
19471
19472
19473.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19474A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19475ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19476specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19477configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19478
19479
19480.option file redirect string&!! unset
19481This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19482is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19483use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19484failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19485must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19486data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19487entirely of comments), the router declines.
19488
19489.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19490If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19491runs a check on the containing directory,
19492unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19493If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19494happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19495is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19496not, the router declines.
19497
19498
19499.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19500.vindex "&$address_file$&"
19501A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19502ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19503specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19504configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19505it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19506
19507
19508.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19509When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19510relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19511relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19512relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19513
19514
19515.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19516If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19517redirection list.
19518
19519
19520.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19521If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19522&%allow_filter%& is true.
19523
19524
19525
19526
19527.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19528.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19529.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19530.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19531If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19532specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19533conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19534set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19535locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19536
19537
19538.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19539.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19540If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19541make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19542functions.
19543
19544.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19545.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19546If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19547make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19548
19549.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19550If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19551permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19552under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19553&_.forward_& files).
19554
19555
19556.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19557If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19558to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19559
19560
19561.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19562This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19563it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19564of the embedded Perl support.
19565
19566
19567.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19568If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19569to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19570
19571
19572.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19573If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19574to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19575
19576
19577.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19578If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19579message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19580files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19581&%one_time%& is set.
19582
19583
19584.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19585If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19586to make use of &%run%& items.
19587
19588
19589.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19590If this option is true, items of the form
19591.code
19592:include:<path name>
19593.endd
19594are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19595
19596
19597.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19598.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19599If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19600specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19601forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19602
19603
19604.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19605If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19606&%allow_filter%& is true.
19607
19608
19609.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19610.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19611If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19612of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19613the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19614
19615
19616
19617
19618.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19619.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19620If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19621generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19622generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19623bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19624bounce may well quote the generated address.
19625
19626
19627.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19628.cindex "EACCES"
19629If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19630EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19631file did not exist.
19632
19633
19634.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19635.cindex "ENOTDIR"
19636If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19637ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19638router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19639
19640Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19641router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19642(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19643against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19644is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19645is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19646a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19647that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19648
19649
19650
19651.option include_directory redirect string unset
19652If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19653redirection list must start with this directory.
19654
19655
19656.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19657This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19658&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19659
19660
19661.option one_time redirect boolean false
19662.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19663.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19664.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19665.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19666.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19667Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19668files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19669of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19670is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19671but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19672message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19673lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19674before they subscribed.
19675
19676If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
19677deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
19678&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
19679&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
19680attempt.
19681
19682&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
19683router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
19684reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
19685permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
19686
19687&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
19688to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
19689and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
19690
19691&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
19692&%one_time%&.
19693
19694The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
19695addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
19696addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
19697&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
19698typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
19699expansion.
19700
19701
19702.option owners redirect "string list" unset
19703.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
19704.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
19705.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
19706.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
19707This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
19708This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
19709See &%check_owner%& above.
19710
19711
19712.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
19713This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
19714The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
19715&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
19716
19717
19718.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
19719.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
19720A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
19721starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
19722transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
19723name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
19724When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
19725
19726
19727.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
19728.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
19729If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
19730generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
19731in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
19732expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
19733to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
19734&$qualify_recipient$&.
19735
19736This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
19737but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
19738not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
19739addresses.
19740
19741.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
19742.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
19743.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
19744.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
19745If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
19746set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
19747without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
19748address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
19749&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
19750this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
19751
19752
19753.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
19754If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
19755any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
19756the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
19757only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
19758&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
19759
19760
19761.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
19762A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
19763&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
19764by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
19765transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
19766are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
19767
19768
19769.option rewrite redirect boolean true
19770.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
19771If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
19772subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
19773and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
19774
19775
19776.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
19777The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
19778:subaddress part of an address.
19779
19780.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
19781The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
19782of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
19783(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
19784
19785
19786.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
19787.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
19788To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
19789&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
19790(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
19791&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
19792needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
19793
19794
19795
19796.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
19797.cindex "forward file" "broken"
19798.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
19799.cindex "alias file" "broken"
19800.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
19801.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
19802.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
19803.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
19804If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
19805non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
19806&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
19807giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
19808are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
19809&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
19810be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
19811&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
19812
19813If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
19814errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
19815the following routers.
19816
19817If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
19818error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
19819taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
19820so it is passed to the following routers.
19821
19822.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
19823Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
19824action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
19825&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
19826
19827&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
19828lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
19829option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
19830notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
19831.code
19832userforward:
19833 driver = redirect
19834 allow_filter
19835 check_local_user
19836 file = $home/.forward
19837 file_transport = address_file
19838 pipe_transport = address_pipe
19839 reply_transport = address_reply
19840 no_verify
19841 skip_syntax_errors
19842 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
19843 syntax_errors_text = \
19844 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
19845 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
19846 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
19847 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
19848 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
19849 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
19850 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
19851 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
19852 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
19853 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
19854.endd
19855You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
19856&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
19857put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
19858.code
19859real_localuser:
19860 driver = accept
19861 check_local_user
19862 local_part_prefix = real-
19863 transport = local_delivery
19864.endd
19865For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19866router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19867.code
19868 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19869 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19870.endd
19871
19872
19873.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
19874See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19875
19876
19877.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
19878See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19879.ecindex IIDredrou1
19880.ecindex IIDredrou2
19881
19882
19883
19884
19885
19886
19887. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19888. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19889
19890.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
19891 "Environment for local transports"
19892.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
19893.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
19894.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
19895Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
19896transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
19897in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
19898mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
19899
19900Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
19901some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
19902transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
19903&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
19904
19905The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
19906different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
19907settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
19908or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
19909configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
19910
19911
19912
19913.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
19914.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
19915.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
19916If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
19917simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
19918the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
19919rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
19920time.
19921
19922However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
19923locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
19924.code
19925my_transport:
19926 driver = pipe
19927 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
19928.endd
19929This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
19930messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
19931&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
19932file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
19933
19934
19935
19936
19937.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
19938.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19939.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
19940All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
19941overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
19942set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
19943delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
19944group (set by the transport). For example:
19945.code
19946# Routers ...
19947# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
19948local_users:
19949 driver = accept
19950 check_local_user
19951 transport = group_delivery
19952
19953# Transports ...
19954# This transport overrides the group
19955group_delivery:
19956 driver = appendfile
19957 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19958 group = mail
19959.endd
19960If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
19961address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
19962gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
19963set.
19964
19965.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
19966When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
19967function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
19968&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
19969by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
19970for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
19971
19972.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
19973The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
19974is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
19975receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
19976original gid is also used.
19977
19978This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
19979following that is set is used:
19980
19981.ilist
19982A &%group%& setting of the transport;
19983.next
19984A &%group%& setting of the router;
19985.next
19986A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
19987&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
19988.next
19989The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
19990.next
19991In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
19992the uid is the creator's uid;
19993.next
19994The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
19995.endlist
19996
19997If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
19998no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
19999This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20000The first of the following that is set is used:
20001
20002.ilist
20003A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20004.next
20005In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20006.next
20007A &%user%& setting of the router;
20008.next
20009A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20010.next
20011The Exim uid.
20012.endlist
20013
20014Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20015&%never_users%& list.
20016
20017
20018
20019
20020
20021.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20022.cindex "current directory for local transport"
20023.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20024.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20025.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20026Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20027the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20028However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20029are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20030for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20031
20032.ilist
20033The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20034.next
20035The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20036.next
20037The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20038.next
20039The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20040.endlist
20041
20042The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20043
20044.ilist
20045The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20046.next
20047The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20048.endlist
20049
20050
20051If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20052value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20053directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20054
20055
20056
20057.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20058.vindex "&$domain$&"
20059.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20060.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20061Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20062variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20063deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20064at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20065other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20066never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20067and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20068.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20069.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20070.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20071
20072
20073
20074
20075
20076
20077
20078. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20079. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20080
20081.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20082.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20083.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20084.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20085The following generic options apply to all transports:
20086
20087
20088.option body_only transports boolean false
20089.cindex "transport" "body only"
20090.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20091.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20092If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20093mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20094or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20095&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20096automatically suppress them.
20097
20098
20099.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20100.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20101This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20102transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20103If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20104logged, and delivery is deferred.
20105
20106
20107.option disable_logging transports boolean false
20108If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20109deliveries by the transport or for any
20110transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20111what you are doing.
20112
20113
20114.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20115.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20116If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20117option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20118transport is run.
20119If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20120output, and Exim carries on processing.
20121This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20122so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20123option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20124variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20125one.
20126The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20127transport and the router that called it.
20128
20129.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20130.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20131If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20132This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20133header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20134requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20135safely be resent to other recipients.
20136
20137
20138.option driver transports string unset
20139This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20140There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20141
20142
20143.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20144.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20145If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20146This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20147delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20148configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20149address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20150header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20151its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20152resent to other recipients.
20153
20154
20155.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20156.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20157This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20158value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20159&%user%& (see below).
20160
20161
20162.option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20163.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20164.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20165This option specifies a list of text headers, newline-separated,
20166which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20167portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20168&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20169routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20170is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20171errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20172
20173Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20174for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20175
20176
20177.option headers_only transports boolean false
20178.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20179.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20180.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20181If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20182exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20183transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20184checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20185
20186
20187.option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20188.cindex "header lines" "removing"
20189.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20190This option specifies a list of header names, colon-separated;
20191these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20192in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20193routers.
20194Each list item is separately expanded.
20195If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20196is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20197errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20198
20199Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20200for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20201
20202
20203
20204.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20205.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20206.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20207This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20208that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20209option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20210the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20211message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20212example,
20213.code
20214headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20215 x@y w@z
20216.endd
20217changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20218&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20219header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20220only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20221the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20222filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20223affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20224envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20225change envelope recipients at this time.
20226
20227
20228.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20229.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20230.vindex "&$home$&"
20231This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20232overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20233placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20234used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20235&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20236&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20237for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20238deferred.
20239
20240
20241.option initgroups transports boolean false
20242.cindex "additional groups"
20243.cindex "groups" "additional"
20244.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20245If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20246transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20247to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20248
20249
20250.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20251.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20252.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20253.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20254This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20255expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20256digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20257including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20258delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20259message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20260the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20261ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20262&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20263delivered.
20264
20265
20266
20267.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20268.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20269.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20270.cindex "local part" "prefix"
20271.cindex "local part" "suffix"
20272When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20273affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20274form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20275that contains
20276.code
20277local_part_prefix = *-
20278.endd
20279routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20280is delivered with
20281.code
20282RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20283.endd
20284This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20285recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20286whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20287deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20288&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20289
20290
20291.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20292.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20293When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20294in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20295is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20296deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20297part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20298temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20299deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20300
20301However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20302as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20303(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20304this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20305
20306For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20307the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20308on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20309
20310
20311.option return_path transports string&!! unset
20312.cindex "envelope sender"
20313.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20314.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20315If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20316the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20317that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20318designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20319SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20320only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20321header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20322
20323&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20324&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20325
20326.vindex "&$return_path$&"
20327The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20328either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20329&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20330replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20331option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20332section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20333
20334&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20335remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20336the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20337This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20338&%errors_to%& in a router.
20339
20340
20341
20342.option return_path_add transports boolean false
20343.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20344If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20345Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20346mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20347have easy access to it.
20348
20349RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20350the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20351header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20352option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20353incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20354recipients.
20355
20356
20357.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20358See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20359
20360
20361.option shadow_transport transports string unset
20362.cindex "shadow transport"
20363.cindex "transport" "shadow"
20364A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20365another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20366
20367Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20368&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20369string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20370passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20371expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20372cause a log line to be written.
20373
20374The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20375subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20376provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20377is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20378ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20379of the form
20380.code
20381ST=<shadow transport name>
20382.endd
20383If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20384parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20385purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20386provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20387headers that some sites insist on.
20388
20389
20390.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20391.cindex "transport" "filter"
20392.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20393This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20394at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20395individual users or via a system filter.
20396
20397When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20398&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20399the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20400input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20401command must be specified as an absolute path.
20402
20403The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20404terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20405SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20406lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20407settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20408&(pipe)& transports.
20409
20410The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20411standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20412destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20413filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20414are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20415
20416The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20417care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20418test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20419SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20420
20421.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20422A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20423at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20424message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20425a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20426not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20427
20428.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20429A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20430being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20431support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20432at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20433more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20434the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20435additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20436
20437.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20438The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20439the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20440parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20441Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20442section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20443to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20444of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20445an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20446&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20447
20448.vindex "&$host$&"
20449.vindex "&$host_address$&"
20450The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20451transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20452which the message is being sent. For example:
20453.code
20454transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20455 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20456.endd
20457
20458Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20459generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20460command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20461.ilist
20462If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20463part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20464expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20465example:
20466.code
20467transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20468.endd
20469This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20470&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20471stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20472the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20473&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20474Exim tried to expand the first one.
20475.next
20476Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20477expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20478arguments. Consider this example:
20479.code
20480transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20481 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20482.endd
20483The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20484if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20485.code
20486transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20487 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20488.endd
20489.endlist
20490
20491The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20492For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20493normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20494A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20495serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20496the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20497bounced from a transport filter.
20498
20499If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20500passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20501message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20502
20503
20504.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20505.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20506When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20507that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20508temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20509&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20510way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20511error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20512becomes a temporary error.
20513
20514
20515.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20516.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20517.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20518This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20519run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20520given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20521associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20522option is not set.
20523
20524For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20525specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20526&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20527
20528.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20529For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20530sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20531to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20532retry data.
20533.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20534.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20535.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20536
20537
20538
20539
20540
20541
20542. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20543. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20544
20545.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20546 "Address batching"
20547.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20548The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20549one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20550remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20551normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20552transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20553copy of the message is delivered each time.
20554
20555.cindex "batched local delivery"
20556.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20557.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20558In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20559local transport, for example:
20560
20561.ilist
20562In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20563delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20564recipients saves space.
20565.next
20566In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20567a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20568.next
20569In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20570to a scanner program or
20571to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20572acceptable.
20573.endlist
20574
20575These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20576(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20577repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20578
20579The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20580delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20581(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20582&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20583(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20584to certain conditions:
20585
20586.ilist
20587.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20588If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20589batching is possible.
20590.next
20591.vindex "&$domain$&"
20592If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20593addresses with the same domain are batched.
20594.next
20595.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20596If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20597addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20598customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20599including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20600from taking place.
20601.next
20602Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20603delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20604group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20605be the same.
20606.endlist
20607
20608In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20609both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20610is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20611course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20612option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20613&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20614&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20615.code
20616check_string = "."
20617escape_string = ".."
20618.endd
20619when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20620given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20621&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20622
20623.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20624If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20625&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20626that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20627transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20628addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20629
20630.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20631.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20632If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20633transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20634the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20635of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20636argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20637delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20638are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20639
20640
20641
20642
20643. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20644. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20645
20646.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
20647.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
20648.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
20649.cindex "directory creation"
20650.cindex "creating directories"
20651The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
20652file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
20653files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
20654format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
20655University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
20656being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
20657to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
20658delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
20659supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
20660directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
20661
20662The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
20663default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
20664SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
20665included.
20666
20667.cindex "quota" "system"
20668Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
20669also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
20670system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
20671
20672If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
20673partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
20674modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
20675creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
20676
20677Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
20678file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
20679private options.
20680
20681The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
20682users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
20683putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
20684&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
20685option).
20686
20687
20688
20689.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
20690The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
20691the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
20692the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
20693normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
20694
20695.vindex "&$address_file$&"
20696.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20697However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
20698directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
20699forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
20700user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
20701the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
20702name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
20703operation. There are two cases:
20704
20705.ilist
20706If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
20707must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
20708common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
20709different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
20710default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
20711name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
20712&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
20713.next
20714If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
20715used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
20716contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
20717.endlist
20718
20719
20720.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
20721.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
20722As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
20723have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
20724form:
20725.code
20726save folder23
20727.endd
20728or Sieve filter commands of the form:
20729.code
20730require "fileinto";
20731fileinto "folder23";
20732.endd
20733In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
20734must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
20735case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
20736is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
20737way of handling this requirement:
20738.code
20739file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
20740 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
20741 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
20742 {$address_file} \
20743 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
20744 }} \
20745 }
20746.endd
20747With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
20748location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
20749&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
20750
20751&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
20752&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
20753the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
20754you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
20755&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
20756path to the transport.
20757
20758&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
20759the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
20760
20761
20762
20763
20764.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
20765.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
20766
20767
20768
20769.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
20770.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
20771.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
20772.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
20773Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
20774regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
20775delivery is deferred.
20776
20777
20778.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
20779.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20780.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20781By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
20782that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
20783are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
20784what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
20785are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
20786
20787
20788.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
20789See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20790However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
20791happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
20792file.
20793
20794
20795.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
20796See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20797
20798
20799.option check_group appendfile boolean false
20800When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
20801option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
20802delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
20803file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
20804
20805
20806.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
20807When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
20808is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
20809process is running.
20810
20811
20812.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
20813.cindex "&""From""& line"
20814As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
20815matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
20816replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
20817a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
20818contains is significant.
20819
20820If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
20821are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
20822configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
20823&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
20824&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
20825
20826The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
20827suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
20828&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
20829if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
20830.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
20831.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
20832.code
20833check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20834escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
20835message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20836message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20837.endd
20838.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
20839.cindex "directory creation"
20840When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
20841directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
20842is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
20843
20844The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
20845operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
20846example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
20847is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
20848in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
20849
20850
20851
20852.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
20853This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
20854by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
20855directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
20856delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
20857beneath.
20858
20859The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
20860&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
20861set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
20862given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
20863names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
20864by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
20865&%file_must_exist%&.
20866
20867
20868.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
20869This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
20870or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
20871redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
20872
20873When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
20874into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
20875appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
20876(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
20877&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
20878
20879
20880.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
20881.cindex "base62"
20882.vindex "&$inode$&"
20883When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
20884&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
20885whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
20886.code
20887q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
20888.endd
20889This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
20890inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
20891option.
20892
20893
20894.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
20895If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
20896&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
20897
20898
20899.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
20900See &%check_string%& above.
20901
20902
20903.option file appendfile string&!! unset
20904This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
20905&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
20906of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
20907specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
20908&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
20909&%file%&.
20910
20911.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20912.cindex "locking files"
20913.cindex "lock files"
20914If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
20915mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
20916
20917The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
20918path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
20919examples:
20920.code
20921file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20922file = /home/$local_part/inbox
20923file = $home/inbox
20924.endd
20925.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
20926In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
20927is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
20928create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
20929deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
20930run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
20931
20932
20933
20934.option file_format appendfile string unset
20935.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
20936This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
20937before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
20938start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
20939colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
20940second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
20941string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
20942transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
20943this added to it:
20944.code
20945file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
20946 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
20947.endd
20948Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
20949a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
20950to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
20951to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
20952is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
20953match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
20954delivery is deferred.
20955
20956
20957.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
20958If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
20959A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
20960If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
20961
20962
20963.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
20964.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20965.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
20966.cindex "locking files"
20967By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
20968when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
20969sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
20970Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
20971for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
20972deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
20973mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
20974misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
20975
20976On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
20977not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
20978is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
20979and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
20980
20981If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
20982timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
20983retries is
20984.code
20985(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
20986.endd
20987rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
20988which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
20989&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
20990
20991You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
20992local deliveries because of errors of the form
20993.code
20994failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
20995.endd
20996
20997.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
20998This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
20999&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21000&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21001
21002
21003.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21004This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21005for details of locking.
21006
21007
21008.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21009This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21010is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21011
21012
21013.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21014This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21015used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21016
21017
21018.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21019.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21020When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21021exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21022accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21023
21024
21025.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21026.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21027.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21028If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21029number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21030followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21031external source that maintains the data.
21032
21033
21034.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21035.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21036.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21037If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21038size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21039This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21040maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21041it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21042
21043
21044
21045.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21046.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21047If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21048file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21049transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21050&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21051&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21052directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21053SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21054&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21055
21056
21057.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21058.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21059.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21060This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21061a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21062directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21063calculation. The default value is:
21064.code
21065maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21066.endd
21067This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21068(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21069&_Trash_&
21070folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21071.code
21072maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21073.endd
21074This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21075directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21076calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21077directly into that directory.
21078
21079
21080.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21081This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21082&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21083
21084
21085.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21086This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21087section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21088
21089
21090.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21091.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21092The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21093If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21094creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21095quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21096value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21097&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21098
21099.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21100.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21101.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21102The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21103effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21104matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21105containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21106delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21107&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21108See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21109
21110
21111.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21112.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21113If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21114new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21115SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21116below for further details.
21117
21118
21119.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21120This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21121section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21122
21123
21124.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21125This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21126section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21127
21128
21129.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21130.cindex "locking files"
21131.cindex "file" "locking"
21132.cindex "file" "MBX format"
21133.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21134This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21135set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21136the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21137traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21138IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21139
21140&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21141automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21142empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21143combination:
21144.code
21145mbx_format = true
21146message_prefix =
21147message_suffix =
21148.endd
21149If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21150&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21151is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21152&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21153interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21154should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21155going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21156mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21157
21158If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21159the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21160(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21161append messages to it.
21162
21163
21164.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21165.cindex "&""From""& line"
21166The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21167The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21168in which case it is:
21169.code
21170message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21171 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21172.endd
21173&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21174&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21175
21176.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21177The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21178The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21179in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21180setting
21181.code
21182message_suffix =
21183.endd
21184&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21185&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21186
21187.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21188If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21189has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21190permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21191if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21192a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21193value, and this option is ignored.
21194
21195
21196.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21197This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21198mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21199true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21200continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21201
21202
21203.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21204If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21205successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21206on users about incoming mail.
21207
21208
21209.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21210.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21211This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21212or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21213is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21214all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21215individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21216&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21217have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21218
21219As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21220multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21221For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21222
21223A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21224may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21225If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21226become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21227Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21228the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21229
21230The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21231(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21232for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21233large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21234be handled.
21235
21236&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21237
21238The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21239the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21240be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21241fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21242system quota failures.
21243
21244By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21245mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21246last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21247during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21248refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21249message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21250changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21251for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21252continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21253delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21254
21255
21256.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21257This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21258into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21259called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21260delivery directory.
21261
21262
21263.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21264This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21265number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21266can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21267failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21268&"no quota"&.
21269
21270
21271.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21272See &%quota%& above.
21273
21274
21275.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21276This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21277for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21278these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21279If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21280captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21281file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21282
21283This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21284&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21285facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21286the file length to the file name. For example:
21287.code
21288maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21289quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21290.endd
21291An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21292number of lines in the message.
21293
21294The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21295file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21296sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21297
21298Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21299
21300
21301.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21302See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21303&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21304.code
21305quota_warn_message = "\
21306 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21307 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21308 This message is automatically created \
21309 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21310 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21311 a warning threshold that is\n\
21312 set by the system administrator.\n"
21313.endd
21314
21315
21316.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21317.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21318.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21319.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21320This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21321resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21322size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21323threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21324may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21325sign. For example:
21326.code
21327quota = 10M
21328quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21329.endd
21330If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21331percent sign is ignored.
21332
21333The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21334and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21335warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21336the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21337can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21338&'From:'& line, the default is:
21339.code
21340From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21341.endd
21342.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21343If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21344option.
21345
21346The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21347are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21348percentage.
21349
21350
21351.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21352.cindex "envelope sender"
21353If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21354format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21355you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21356so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21357for details of batch SMTP.
21358
21359
21360.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21361.cindex "carriage return"
21362.cindex "linefeed"
21363This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21364(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21365of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21366of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21367
21368&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21369(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21370in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21371carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21372have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21373changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21374
21375
21376.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21377This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21378exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21379&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21380that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21381&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21382
21383
21384.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21385This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21386the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21387&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21388each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21389
21390This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21391&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21392where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21393both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21394
21395.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21396Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21397have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21398&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21399the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21400error.
21401
21402&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21403is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21404
21405
21406.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21407If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21408appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21409&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21410sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21411&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21412delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21413
21414.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21415In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21416necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21417achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21418file corruption.
21419
21420The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21421It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21422except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21423
21424
21425.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21426This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21427set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21428locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21429of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21430are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21431the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21432rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21433does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21434
21435You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21436&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21437MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21438without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21439
21440
21441
21442
21443.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21444.cindex "appending to a file"
21445.cindex "file" "appending"
21446Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21447
21448.ilist
21449If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21450return is given.
21451
21452.next
21453.cindex "directory creation"
21454If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21455&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21456&%directory_mode%& option.
21457
21458.next
21459If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21460indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21461transport.
21462
21463.next
21464.cindex "file" "locking"
21465.cindex "locking files"
21466.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21467If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21468reliably over NFS, as follows:
21469
21470.olist
21471Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21472current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21473as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21474.next
21475Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21476.next
21477If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21478Unlink the hitching post name.
21479.next
21480Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21481then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21482of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21483restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21484.next
21485If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21486up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21487mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21488lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21489existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21490it before trying again.
21491.endlist olist
21492
21493.next
21494A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21495so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21496than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21497
21498.next
21499.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21500.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21501If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21502&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21503checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21504is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21505ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21506directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21507idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21508checked.
21509
21510.next
21511If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21512and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21513different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21514delivery is deferred.
21515
21516.next
21517If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21518If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21519is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21520permissions.
21521
21522.next
21523The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21524If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21525hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21526
21527.next
21528If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21529changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21530have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21531
21532.next
21533If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21534option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21535directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21536open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21537except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21538set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21539the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21540that prevents link following.
21541
21542.next
21543.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21544If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21545existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21546being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21547after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21548
21549.next
21550If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21551
21552.next
21553.cindex "file" "locking"
21554.cindex "locking files"
21555Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21556are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21557&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21558However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21559file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21560.code
21561/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21562.endd
21563using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21564the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21565the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21566
21567If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21568depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21569&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21570
21571If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21572&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21573to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21574delivery is deferred.
21575
21576If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21577&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21578waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21579immediately. It retries up to
21580.code
21581(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21582.endd
21583times (rounded up).
21584.endlist
21585
21586At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21587and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21588
21589
21590.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21591.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21592.cindex "&""From""& line"
21593When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21594delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21595activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21596&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21597router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21598configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21599ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21600
21601No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21602locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21603separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21604of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21605newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21606&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21607any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21608
21609If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21610the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21611different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21612deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21613
21614
21615.cindex "maildir format"
21616.cindex "mailstore format"
21617There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21618done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21619&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21620formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21621SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21622
21623.cindex "directory creation"
21624In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21625sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21626option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21627constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21628the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21629&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21630deferred.
21631
21632
21633
21634.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21635.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21636If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21637it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21638directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21639directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21640&_new_& subdirectory.
21641
21642In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21643<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21644Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21645before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21646file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
21647opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
21648Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
21649
21650Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
21651called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
21652do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
21653path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
21654&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
21655contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
21656&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
21657&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
21658
21659These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
21660and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
21661folders. Consider this example:
21662.code
21663maildir_format = true
21664directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
21665 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
21666 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
21667maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
21668.endd
21669If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
21670delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
21671the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
21672not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
21673&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
21674&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
21675
21676However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
21677delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
21678does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
21679&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
21680directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
21681
21682&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
21683not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
21684&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
21685
21686.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21687.cindex "maildir++"
21688If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
21689&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
21690the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
21691Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
21692down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
21693the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
21694amount of space used.
21695
21696One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
21697computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
21698checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
21699needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
21700use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
21701of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
21702
21703
21704
21705
21706.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
21707If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
21708When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
21709tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
21710name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
21711the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
21712
21713
21714.vindex "&$message_size$&"
21715Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
21716&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
21717happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
21718variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
21719forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
21720be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
21721Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
21722empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
21723colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
21724maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
21725backwards compatibility).
21726
21727For one common implementation, you might set:
21728.code
21729maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
21730.endd
21731but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
21732
21733It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
21734as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
21735&[stat()]& each message file.
21736
21737
21738.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
21739.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21740.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21741If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
21742storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
21743within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
21744creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
21745the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
21746to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
21747
21748The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
21749messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
21750in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
21751value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
21752is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
21753need to know the quota.
21754
21755If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
21756file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
21757
21758A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
21759maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
21760See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
21761details.
21762
21763
21764.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
21765.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
21766If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
21767files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
21768message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
21769this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
21770contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
21771itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
21772
21773During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
21774&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
21775&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
21776mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
21777file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
21778the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
21779
21780The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
21781option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
21782the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
21783There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
21784greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
21785appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
21786
21787If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
21788failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
21789configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
21790&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
21791
21792
21793.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
21794If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
21795file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
21796messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
21797section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
21798.code
21799directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
21800.endd
21801might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
21802then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
21803expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
21804.ecindex IIDapptra1
21805.ecindex IIDapptra2
21806
21807
21808
21809
21810
21811
21812. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21813. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21814
21815.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
21816.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
21817.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
21818The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
21819the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
21820automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
21821&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
21822to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
21823
21824If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
21825&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
21826delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
21827that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
21828another router can set up a normal message delivery.
21829
21830
21831The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
21832&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
21833directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
21834message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
21835empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
21836
21837The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
21838by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
21839passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
21840transport is run as a consequence of a
21841&%mail%&
21842or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
21843supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
21844that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
21845case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
21846is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
21847&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
21848
21849&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
21850command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
21851gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
21852&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
21853
21854There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
21855that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
21856&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
21857address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
21858separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
21859the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
21860message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
21861
21862Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
21863message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
21864immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
21865the transport defers.
21866Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
21867controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
21868
21869If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
21870&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
21871of the original message that is included in the generated message when
21872&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
21873
21874.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
21875If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
21876the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
21877as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
21878is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
21879problems. They are just discarded.
21880
21881
21882
21883.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
21884.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
21885
21886.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
21887This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
21888message when the message is specified by the transport.
21889
21890
21891.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
21892This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
21893when the message is specified by the transport.
21894
21895
21896.option file autoreply string&!! unset
21897The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
21898is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
21899string comes first.
21900
21901
21902.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
21903If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
21904subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
21905
21906
21907.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
21908If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
21909option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
21910
21911
21912.option from autoreply string&!! unset
21913This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
21914specified by the transport.
21915
21916
21917.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
21918This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
21919when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
21920&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
21921
21922
21923.option log autoreply string&!! unset
21924This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
21925the message is specified by the transport.
21926
21927
21928.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
21929If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
21930used.
21931
21932
21933.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
21934If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
21935item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
21936discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
21937generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
21938
21939
21940
21941.option once autoreply string&!! unset
21942This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
21943recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
21944This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
21945
21946If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
21947By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
21948is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
21949However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
21950message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
21951this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
21952prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
21953infinity.
21954
21955If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
21956and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
21957greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
21958Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
21959regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
21960
21961In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
21962which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
21963be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
21964means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
21965unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
21966file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
21967
21968
21969.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
21970See &%once%& above.
21971
21972
21973.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
21974See &%once%& above.
21975After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
21976
21977
21978.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
21979This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
21980specified by the transport.
21981
21982
21983.option return_message autoreply boolean false
21984If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
21985message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
21986configuration option.
21987
21988
21989.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
21990This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
21991specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
21992automatic responses. For example:
21993.code
21994subject = Re: $h_subject:
21995.endd
21996There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
21997subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
21998bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
21999non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22000small.
22001
22002
22003
22004.option text autoreply string&!! unset
22005This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22006message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22007the text comes first.
22008
22009
22010.option to autoreply string&!! unset
22011This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22012when the message is specified by the transport.
22013.ecindex IIDauttra1
22014.ecindex IIDauttra2
22015
22016
22017
22018
22019. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22020. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22021
22022.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22023.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22024.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22025.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22026.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22027The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22028specified command
22029or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22030This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22031transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22032implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22033to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22034has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22035.code
22036TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22037.endd
22038.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22039is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22040included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22041as follows:
22042
22043.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22044See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22045
22046
22047.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22048This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22049Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22050good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22051batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22052
22053
22054.option command lmtp string&!! unset
22055This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22056is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22057arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22058number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22059is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22060LMTP protocol.
22061
22062.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22063.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22064If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22065commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22066in its response to the LHLO command.
22067
22068.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22069This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22070be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22071delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22072
22073
22074.option timeout lmtp time 5m
22075The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22076respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22077is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22078LMTP transport:
22079.code
22080lmtp:
22081 driver = lmtp
22082 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22083 batch_max = 20
22084 user = exim
22085.endd
22086This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22087necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22088
22089
22090
22091. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22092. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22093
22094.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22095.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22096.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22097The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22098running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22099pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22100(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22101their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22102following ways:
22103
22104.ilist
22105.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22106A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22107transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22108contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22109is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22110.next
22111.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22112If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22113transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22114more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22115(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22116(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22117that are routed to the transport.
22118.next
22119.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22120A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22121alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22122pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22123&%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22124(&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22125this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22126.endlist
22127
22128
22129The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22130deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22131implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22132
22133In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22134&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22135other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22136transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22137directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22138details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22139for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22140
22141
22142.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22143If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22144delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22145any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22146write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22147
22148
22149
22150
22151.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22152.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22153If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22154have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22155the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22156in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22157later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22158logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22159&"local delivery failed"&.
22160
22161If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22162the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22163will be sent as normal.
22164
22165If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22166script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22167value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22168apply in this case.
22169
22170If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22171return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22172asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22173a non-existent command may be the problem.
22174
22175The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22176set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22177error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22178return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22179included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22180similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22181failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22182&%temp_errors%&.
22183
22184
22185
22186.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22187.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22188The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22189by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22190&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22191run.
22192
22193.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22194Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22195double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22196way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22197
22198String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22199traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22200expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22201For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22202quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22203.code
22204command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22205.endd
22206will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22207arguments. You have to write
22208.code
22209command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22210.endd
22211to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22212argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22213result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22214interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22215generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22216expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22217example:
22218.code
22219command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22220.endd
22221
22222.cindex "transport" "filter"
22223.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22224.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22225Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22226&`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22227place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22228transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22229inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22230avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22231&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22232
22233If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22234for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22235is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22236argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22237&'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22238the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22239should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22240run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22241
22242After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22243in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22244message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22245standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22246read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22247may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22248control what is done with it.
22249
22250Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22251in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22252taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22253explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22254where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22255under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22256an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22257works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22258as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22259&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22260with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22261
22262
22263
22264.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22265.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22266.cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22267The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22268This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22269the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22270environment.
22271.display
22272&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22273&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22274&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22275&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22276&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22277&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22278&`LOGNAME `& see below
22279&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22280&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22281&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22282&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22283&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22284&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22285&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22286&`USER `& see below
22287.endd
22288When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22289router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22290called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22291the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22292removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22293LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22294same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22295
22296.cindex "HOST"
22297HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22298associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22299pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22300the router.
22301
22302.cindex "HOME"
22303If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22304for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22305by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22306user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22307
22308
22309.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22310.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22311
22312
22313
22314.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22315.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22316The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22317permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22318permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22319paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22320&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22321in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22322the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22323&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22324otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22325example, if
22326.code
22327allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22328.endd
22329and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22330&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22331&%use_shell%& is set.
22332
22333
22334.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22335See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22336
22337
22338.option batch_max pipe integer 1
22339This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22340See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22341
22342
22343.option check_string pipe string unset
22344As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22345&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22346by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22347&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22348any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22349of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22350the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22351ignored.
22352
22353
22354.option command pipe string&!! unset
22355This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22356obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22357set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22358the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22359Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22360&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22361
22362
22363.option environment pipe string&!! unset
22364.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22365.cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22366This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22367command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22368a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22369environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22370
22371
22372.option escape_string pipe string unset
22373See &%check_string%& above.
22374
22375
22376.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22377.cindex "exec failure"
22378.cindex "failure of exec"
22379.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22380Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22381any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22382is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22383frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22384
22385
22386.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22387.cindex "signal exit"
22388.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22389Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22390a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22391frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22392
22393
22394.option force_command pipe boolean false
22395.cindex "force command"
22396.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22397Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22398the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22399is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22400useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22401command. For example:
22402.code
22403command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22404force_command
22405.endd
22406
22407Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22408&%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22409separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22410
22411.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22412If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22413run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22414Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22415from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22416&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22417
22418&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22419See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22420
22421.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22422.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22423If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22424one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22425and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
22426
22427
22428.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22429If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
22430return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
22431&%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
22432written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
22433Only one of them may be set.
22434
22435
22436
22437.option log_output pipe boolean false
22438If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
22439output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
22440&%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22441
22442
22443
22444.option max_output pipe integer 20K
22445This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22446standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22447process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22448catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22449the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22450&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22451exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22452
22453
22454.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22455The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22456The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22457.code
22458message_prefix = \
22459 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22460 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22461.endd
22462.cindex "Cyrus"
22463.cindex "&%tmail%&"
22464.cindex "&""From""& line"
22465This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22466However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22467or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22468setting
22469.code
22470message_prefix =
22471.endd
22472&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22473&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22474
22475
22476.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22477The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22478The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22479The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22480.code
22481message_suffix =
22482.endd
22483&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22484&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22485
22486
22487.option path pipe string "see below"
22488This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22489variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22490.code
22491/bin:/usr/bin
22492.endd
22493If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22494sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22495apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22496
22497
22498.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22499Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22500a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22501during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22502It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22503for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22504resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22505installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22506of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22507
22508
22509.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22510.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22511If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22512process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22513to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22514&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22515accept the message is used.
22516
22517
22518.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22519When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22520contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22521in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22522command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22523handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22524
22525
22526.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22527If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22528return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22529is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22530However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22531message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22532&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22533
22534
22535
22536.option return_output pipe boolean false
22537If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22538deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22539is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22540However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22541output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22542option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22543of them may be set.
22544
22545
22546
22547.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22548.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22549This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22550asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22551and &%return_output%& is not set,
22552and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22553temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22554numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22555codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22556defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22557compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22558and 73, respectively.
22559
22560
22561.option timeout pipe time 1h
22562If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22563causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22564specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22565command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22566and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22567if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22568
22569.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22570A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22571runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22572treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22573is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22574delivery to be deferred.
22575
22576.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22577This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22578
22579
22580.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22581.cindex "envelope sender"
22582If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22583SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22584commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22585you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22586&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22587
22588.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22589.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22590This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22591BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22592resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22593limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22594class database.
22595
22596
22597.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22598.cindex "carriage return"
22599.cindex "linefeed"
22600This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22601(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22602of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22603of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22604
22605The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22606written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22607are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22608&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22609values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22610
22611
22612.option use_shell pipe boolean false
22613.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22614If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22615instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22616&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22617where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22618modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22619&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22620command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22621its &%-c%& option.
22622
22623
22624
22625.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22626.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22627.cindex "&'procmail'&"
22628.cindex "external local delivery"
22629.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22630.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22631The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22632delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22633this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22634uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22635by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22636necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22637appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22638configuration for &%procmail%&:
22639.code
22640# transport
22641procmail_pipe:
22642 driver = pipe
22643 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22644 return_path_add
22645 delivery_date_add
22646 envelope_to_add
22647 check_string = "From "
22648 escape_string = ">From "
22649 umask = 077
22650 user = $local_part
22651 group = mail
22652
22653# router
22654procmail:
22655 driver = accept
22656 check_local_user
22657 transport = procmail_pipe
22658.endd
22659In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
22660&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
22661or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
22662user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
22663&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
22664home directory is the user's home directory by default.
22665
22666&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
22667.code
22668IFS=" "
22669.endd
22670as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
22671use a shell to run pipe commands.
22672
22673.cindex "Cyrus"
22674The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
22675deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
22676.code
22677# transport
22678local_delivery_cyrus:
22679 driver = pipe
22680 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
22681 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
22682 user = cyrus
22683 group = mail
22684 return_output
22685 log_output
22686 message_prefix =
22687 message_suffix =
22688
22689# router
22690local_user_cyrus:
22691 driver = accept
22692 check_local_user
22693 local_part_suffix = .*
22694 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
22695.endd
22696Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
22697&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
22698sender.
22699.ecindex IIDpiptra1
22700.ecindex IIDpiptra2
22701
22702
22703. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22704. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22705
22706.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
22707.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
22708.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
22709The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
22710or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
22711that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
22712explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
22713&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
22714
22715
22716.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
22717The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
22718two ways:
22719
22720.ilist
22721If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
22722routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
22723that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
22724the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
22725does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
22726value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
22727section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
22728.next
22729.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
22730When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
22731looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
22732connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
22733for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
22734process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
22735process.
22736.endlist
22737
22738
22739For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
22740incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
22741no further messages are sent over that connection.
22742
22743
22744
22745.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
22746.vindex "&$host$&"
22747.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22748At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
22749&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
22750passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
22751specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
22752&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
22753that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
22754&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
22755
22756
22757.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
22758.vindex &$tls_bits$&
22759.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
22760.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
22761.vindex &$tls_sni$&
22762At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
22763&$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
22764are the values that were set when the message was received.
22765These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
22766SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
22767variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
22768appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
22769are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
22770&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
22771
22772These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
22773and will be removed in a future release.
22774
22775
22776.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
22777.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
22778The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
22779
22780
22781.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
22782.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
22783When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
22784is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
22785runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
22786reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
22787setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
22788problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
22789
22790.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
22791.cindex "local host" "sending to"
22792.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22793When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
22794to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
22795deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
22796the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
22797configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
22798configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
22799
22800
22801.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
22802.cindex "Cyrus"
22803When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
22804is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
22805overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
22806forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
22807to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
22808ignored.
22809
22810The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
22811started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
22812&$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
22813particular connection.
22814
22815If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
22816&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
22817deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
22818unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
22819
22820This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
22821deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
22822&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
22823.code
22824authenticated_sender = $local_part
22825.endd
22826This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
22827allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
22828
22829Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
22830domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
22831value.
22832
22833
22834.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
22835If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
22836is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
22837authenticated as a client.
22838
22839
22840.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
22841This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
22842sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
22843remote host. Its value must not be zero.
22844
22845
22846.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
22847This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
22848to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
22849several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
22850less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
22851systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
22852option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
22853
22854
22855.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
22856.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
22857.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
22858.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22859This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
22860over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
22861For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
22862option.
22863
22864
22865.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
22866This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
22867the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
22868of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
22869
22870
22871.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
22872This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
22873domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
22874cutoff times.
22875
22876In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
22877them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
22878Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
22879retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
22880a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
22881unhappy at this prospect, so...
22882
22883If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22884addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
22885IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22886none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
22887delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
22888addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
22889continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
22890&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
22891to them.
22892
22893
22894.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
22895If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
22896and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
22897the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
22898in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
22899
22900
22901.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
22902If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
22903&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
22904See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
22905details.
22906
22907
22908.option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
22909.cindex "MX record" "security"
22910.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
22911.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
22912.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
22913DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
22914the dnssec request bit set.
22915This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
22916
22917
22918
22919.option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
22920.cindex "MX record" "security"
22921.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
22922.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
22923.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
22924DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
22925the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
22926(AD bit) set wil be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
22927This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
22928
22929
22930
22931.option dscp smtp string&!! unset
22932.cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
22933This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
22934of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
22935The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
22936Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
22937&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
22938
22939The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
22940(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
22941that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
22942equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
22943Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
22944
22945
22946.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
22947.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22948String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
22949colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
22950port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
22951&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22952item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22953in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
22954
22955Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
22956addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
22957&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
22958not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
22959&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
22960However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
22961
22962If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
22963the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
22964transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
22965address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
22966list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
22967
22968Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
22969re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
22970addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
22971copy of the message is sent.
22972
22973The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
22974&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
22975both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
22976from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
22977fails"& facility.
22978
22979
22980.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
22981This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
22982line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
22983zero.
22984
22985.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
22986If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
22987being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
22988(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
22989instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
22990it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
22991
22992.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
22993This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
22994server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
22995implementations of TLS.
22996
22997.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
22998.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
22999.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23000.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23001The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23002been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23003command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23004option is:
23005.code
23006$primary_hostname
23007.endd
23008During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23009the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23010&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23011used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23012servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23013that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23014interface address, you could use this:
23015.code
23016helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23017 {$primary_hostname}}
23018.endd
23019The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23020callouts.
23021
23022.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23023Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23024finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23025&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23026email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23027all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23028
23029The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23030processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23031&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23032&%hosts_override%& is set.
23033
23034The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23035list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23036separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23037&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23038item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23039in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23040of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23041
23042If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23043the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23044well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23045address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23046&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23047&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23048that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23049address are used.
23050
23051During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23052unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23053
23054
23055.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23056.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23057.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23058.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23059.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23060This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23061example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23062matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23063start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23064facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23065
23066
23067.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23068.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23069Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23070that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23071
23072
23073.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23074.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23075Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23076matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23077
23078.option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
23079.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23080Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23081or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23082to any host that matches this list.
23083Note that the default is to not use TLS.
23084
23085
23086.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23087.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23088.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23089.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23090.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23091This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23092delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23093&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23094
23095
23096.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23097This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23098tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23099why it exists.
23100
23101
23102
23103.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23104.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23105.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23106.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23107For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23108been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23109message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23110explanation of when this might be needed.
23111
23112
23113.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23114If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23115attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23116&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23117&%fallback_hosts%&.
23118
23119
23120.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23121.cindex "randomized host list"
23122.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23123.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23124If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23125&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23126were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23127router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23128is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23129list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23130
23131When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23132order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23133behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23134&`+`& in the host list. For example:
23135.code
23136hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23137.endd
23138The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23139randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23140If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23141
23142.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23143.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23144This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23145before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23146servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23147authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23148temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23149hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23150&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23151
23152
23153.option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23154.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23155Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23156TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23157&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23158
23159.option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23160.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23161Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23162TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23163&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23164
23165.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23166.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23167Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23168matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23169&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23170incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23171
23172.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23173.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23174This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23175authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23176connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23177unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23178&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23179
23180.option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" unset
23181.cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23182This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23183PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23184for multi-recipient messages.
23185
23186.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23187.cindex "bind IP address"
23188.cindex "IP address" "binding"
23189.vindex "&$host$&"
23190.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23191This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23192call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23193&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23194message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23195&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23196outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23197interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23198unknown.
23199
23200During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23201&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23202during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23203string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23204string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23205separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23206.code
23207interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23208.endd
23209The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23210connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23211&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23212interface to use if the host has more than one.
23213
23214
23215.option keepalive smtp boolean true
23216.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23217This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23218connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23219periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23220of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23221or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23222that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23223that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23224TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23225unreachable hosts.
23226
23227
23228.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23229.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23230If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23231string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23232has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23233
23234.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23235.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23236This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23237SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23238so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23239permits this.
23240
23241
23242.option multi_domain smtp boolean true
23243.vindex "&$domain$&"
23244When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23245addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23246to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23247handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23248&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23249is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23250
23251
23252.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23253.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23254.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23255This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23256&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23257received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23258The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23259variable that contains an outgoing port.
23260
23261If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23262otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23263normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23264&"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23265is deferred.
23266
23267
23268
23269.option protocol smtp string smtp
23270.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23271.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23272.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23273.vindex "&$port$&"
23274If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23275the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23276protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23277deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23278over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23279
23280If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
23281changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23282connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23283The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23284
23285
23286.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
23287Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23288constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23289means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23290tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23291addresses is not affected.
23292
23293However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23294each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23295the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23296Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
23297instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
23298hosts.
23299
23300
23301.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23302.cindex "serializing connections"
23303.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23304Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23305host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23306the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23307slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23308Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23309&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23310
23311.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23312Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23313written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23314is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23315records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23316guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23317
23318If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23319relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23320start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23321may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23322are used for ETRN serialization.
23323
23324
23325.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23326.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23327.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23328.cindex "size" "of message"
23329.cindex "transport" "filter"
23330.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23331If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23332MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23333an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23334sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23335configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23336this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23337
23338Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23339the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23340
23341
23342.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23343.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23344.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23345.vindex "&$host$&"
23346.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23347The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23348client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23349connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23350address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23351details of TLS.
23352
23353&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23354certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23355name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23356assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23357client.
23358
23359
23360.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23361.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23362.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23363This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23364be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23365
23366
23367.option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23368.cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23369When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23370key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23371for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23372If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23373will fail.
23374
23375Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23376
23377
23378.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23379.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23380.vindex "&$host$&"
23381.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23382The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23383client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
23384connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
23385&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23386expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
23387result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23388the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23389
23390
23391.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23392.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23393.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23394.vindex "&$host$&"
23395.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23396The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23397when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23398the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23399&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23400expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23401is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23402&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23403ciphers is a preference order.
23404
23405
23406
23407.option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23408.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23409.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23410If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23411TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23412the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23413certificate and private key for the session.
23414
23415See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23416
23417Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23418TLS extensions.
23419
23420
23421
23422
23423.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23424.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23425When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23426setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23427to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23428current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23429option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23430response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23431TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23432unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23433in clear.
23434
23435
23436.option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23437.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23438.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23439This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23440certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23441The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23442Note that unless the host is in this list
23443TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
23444when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
23445The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
23446certificate verification succeeds.
23447
23448
23449.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
23450.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23451.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23452.vindex "&$host$&"
23453.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23454The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
23455permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23456Alternatively,
23457if you are using either GnuTLS version 3.3.6 (or later) or OpenSSL,
23458you can set
23459&%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
23460files.
23461For earlier versions of GnuTLS the option must be set to the name of a
23462single file.
23463
23464With OpenSSL the certificates specified
23465explicitly
23466either by file or directory
23467are added to those given by the system default location.
23468
23469The values of &$host$& and
23470&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23471expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23472
23473For back-compatability,
23474if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23475and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23476
23477
23478.option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23479.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23480.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23481This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23482certificate verification must succeed.
23483The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23484If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23485operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23486
23487
23488
23489
23490.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23491 "SECTvalhosmax"
23492.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23493.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23494There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23495tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23496&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23497
23498
23499The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23500for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23501option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23502multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23503retrying.
23504
23505Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23506multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23507created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23508
23509Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23510several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23511problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23512&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23513delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23514
23515Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23516arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23517limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23518some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23519&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23520that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23521see below for an exception).
23522
23523Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23524list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23525If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23526but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23527that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23528
23529Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23530higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23531hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23532which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23533tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23534reached their retry times.
23535
23536However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23537large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23538Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23539of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23540time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23541without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23542all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23543there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23544the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23545every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23546reached.
23547
23548The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23549particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23550out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23551reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23552been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23553take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23554
23555The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23556Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23557and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23558possible IP addresses have been tried.
23559.ecindex IIDsmttra1
23560.ecindex IIDsmttra2
23561
23562
23563
23564
23565
23566. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23567. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23568
23569.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23570.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23571There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23572addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23573(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23574abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23575
23576Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23577messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23578&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23579appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23580locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23581unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23582lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23583
23584One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23585when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23586such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23587do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23588
23589
23590.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23591This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23592main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23593&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23594
23595Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23596Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23597facility; you do not have to use it.
23598
23599The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23600configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23601addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23602address to which it applies.
23603
23604Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23605the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23606rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23607those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23608by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23609are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23610rules.
23611
23612Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
23613applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
23614well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
23615headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
23616
23617
23618In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
23619legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
23620in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
23621used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
23622Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
23623discouraged.
23624
23625There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
23626illustrated by these examples:
23627
23628.ilist
23629The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
23630exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
23631gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
23632&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
23633.next
23634A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
23635&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
23636.endlist
23637
23638
23639
23640.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
23641.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
23642.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
23643Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
23644message's processing.
23645
23646.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23647At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
23648by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
23649ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
23650is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
23651rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
23652rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
23653RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
23654rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
23655
23656.vindex "&$domain$&"
23657.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23658Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
23659may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
23660rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
23661from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
23662for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
23663value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
23664as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
23665SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
23666
23667As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
23668recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
23669the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
23670any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
23671.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
23672before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
23673
23674When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
23675rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
23676redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
23677
23678.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
23679.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
23680.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
23681At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
23682specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
23683This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
23684section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
23685header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
23686applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
23687
23688The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
23689transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
23690transport time.
23691
23692
23693
23694
23695.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
23696.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
23697.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
23698Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
23699configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
23700&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
237012822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
23702transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
23703appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
23704envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
23705.code
23706exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
23707.endd
23708might produce the output
23709.code
23710sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23711from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23712to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23713cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23714bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23715reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23716env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23717env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23718.endd
23719which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
23720the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
23721present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
23722set for a particular transport.
23723
23724
23725.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
23726.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
23727The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
23728rules in the form
23729.display
23730<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
23731.endd
23732Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
23733transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
23734takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
23735any colons must be doubled, of course).
23736
23737The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
23738Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
23739case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
23740characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
23741ignored.
23742
23743For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
23744order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
23745replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
23746
23747The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
23748releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
23749received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
23750lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
23751address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
23752(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
23753that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
23754
23755.vindex "&$domain$&"
23756.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23757The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
23758string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
23759rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
23760.code
23761*@* ${lookup ...
23762.endd
23763where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
23764refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23765
23766
23767.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
23768.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
23769.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
23770The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
23771address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
23772single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
23773against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
23774you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
23775facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
23776
23777Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
23778case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
23779can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
23780
23781.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
23782After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
23783depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
23784replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
23785refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
23786numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
23787of pattern they are set as follows:
23788
23789.ilist
23790If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
23791refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
23792the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
23793pattern
23794.code
23795*queen@*.fict.example
23796.endd
23797is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
23798.code
23799$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
23800$1 = hearts-
23801$2 = wonderland
23802.endd
23803Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
23804does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
23805
23806.next
23807If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
23808of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
23809for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
23810rewriting rule of the form
23811.display
23812&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
23813.endd
23814and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
23815.code
23816$1 = foo
23817$2 = bar
23818$3 = baz.example
23819.endd
23820If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
23821wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
23822&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
23823partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
23824whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
23825.endlist
23826
23827
23828.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
23829.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
23830If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
23831match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
23832rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
23833.code
23834hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
23835.endd
23836specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
23837&'From:'& headers.
23838
23839.vindex "&$domain$&"
23840.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23841If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
23842yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
23843&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23844Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
23845cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
23846matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
23847the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
23848current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
23849expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
23850entry written to the panic log.
23851
23852
23853
23854.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
23855There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
23856
23857.ilist
23858Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
23859c, f, h, r, s, t.
23860.next
23861A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
23862.next
23863Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
23864.endlist
23865
23866For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
23867E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
23868
23869
23870
23871.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
23872 "SECID154"
23873.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
23874If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
23875&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
23876and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
23877transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
23878rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
23879.display
23880&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
23881&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
23882&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
23883&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
23884&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
23885&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
23886&`h`& rewrite all headers
23887&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
23888&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
23889&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
23890.endd
23891"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
23892individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
23893other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
23894
23895You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
23896restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
23897
23898
23899.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
23900.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
23901.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
23902.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
23903The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
23904SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
23905before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
23906required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
23907data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
23908
23909.vindex "&$domain$&"
23910.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23911This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
23912compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
23913input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
23914the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
23915expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
23916original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
23917
23918
23919.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
23920There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
23921take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
23922correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
23923
23924.ilist
23925If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
23926unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
23927absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
23928.next
23929If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
23930even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
23931expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
23932(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
23933.next
23934The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
23935address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
23936rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
23937.next
23938.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
23939When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
23940to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
23941left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
23942.code
23943From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
23944.endd
23945into
23946.code
23947From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
23948.endd
23949.cindex "RFC 2047"
23950Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
23951done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
23952causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
23953replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
239542822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
23955brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
23956(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
23957is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
23958
23959When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
23960rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
23961.endlist
23962
23963
23964.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
23965Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
23966.code
23967*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
23968*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
23969 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
23970.endd
23971Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
23972the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
23973has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
23974consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
23975present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
23976explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
23977at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
23978error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
23979
23980The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
23981domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
23982.code
23983root@*.hitch.fict.example *
23984.endd
23985were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
23986local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
23987
23988Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
23989&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
23990messages that originate outside the local host:
23991.code
23992*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
23993 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
23994.endd
23995The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
23996space.
23997
23998.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
23999.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24000Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24001an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24002the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24003remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24004sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24005components. For example, the rule
24006.code
24007\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24008.endd
24009rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24010&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24011a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24012method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24013to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24014use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24015can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24016.ecindex IIDaddrew
24017
24018
24019
24020
24021
24022. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24023. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24024
24025.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24026.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24027.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24028The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24029retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24030be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24031empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24032errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24033general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24034line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24035address, domain and error.
24036
24037The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24038host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24039Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24040address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24041been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24042tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24043log selector is set, the message
24044.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24045&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24046skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24047the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24048
24049Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24050in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24051actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24052failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24053the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24054added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24055same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24056domain are maintained independently.
24057
24058When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24059receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24060always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24061behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24062quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24063suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24064subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24065the local address is reached.
24066
24067.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24068If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24069whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24070files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24071always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24072
24073The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24074rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24075record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24076timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24077and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24078messages that it should now be retaining.
24079
24080
24081
24082.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24083.cindex "retry" "rules"
24084Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24085separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24086addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24087enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24088in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24089present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24090message's sender, respectively.
24091
24092
24093The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24094&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24095which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24096has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24097list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24098which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24099example,
24100.code
24101lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24102.endd
24103provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24104whereas
24105.code
24106alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24107.endd
24108applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24109In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24110part.
24111
24112.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24113&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24114must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24115expressions work in address lists.
24116.display
24117&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24118&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24119.endd
24120
24121
24122.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24123When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24124example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24125against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24126router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24127regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24128A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24129&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24130&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24131
24132Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24133failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24134configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24135&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24136local transports).
24137
24138.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24139However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24140suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24141whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24142rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24143failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24144recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24145reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24146&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24147lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24148commands.
24149
24150
24151
24152.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24153 "SECID160"
24154For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24155example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24156twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24157&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24158the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24159suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24160.code
24161a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24162 MX 6 p.q.r.example
24163 MX 7 m.n.o.example
24164.endd
24165and the retry rules are
24166.code
24167p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24168a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24169.endd
24170and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24171first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24172rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24173to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24174tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24175first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24176
24177In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24178first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24179&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24180routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24181
24182&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24183However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24184host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24185.code
24186route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24187.endd
24188then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24189textual form of the IP address.
24190
24191.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24192.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24193The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24194asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24195
24196.vlist
24197.vitem &%auth_failed%&
24198Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24199&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24200
24201.vitem &%data_4xx%&
24202A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24203after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24204
24205.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24206A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24207
24208.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24209A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24210.endlist
24211
24212For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24213as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24214recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24215and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24216retry rule of this form:
24217.code
24218the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24219.endd
24220These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24221LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24222
24223.vlist
24224.vitem &%lost_connection%&
24225A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24226legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24227for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24228
24229.vitem &%refused_MX%&
24230A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24231
24232.vitem &%refused_A%&
24233A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24234
24235.vitem &%refused%&
24236A connection was refused.
24237
24238.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24239A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24240
24241.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24242A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24243
24244.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24245A connection attempt timed out.
24246
24247.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24248There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24249obtained from an MX record.
24250
24251.vitem &%timeout_A%&
24252There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24253obtained from an MX record.
24254
24255.vitem &%timeout%&
24256There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24257
24258.vitem &%tls_required%&
24259The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24260&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24261to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24262
24263.vitem &%quota%&
24264A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24265transport.
24266
24267.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24268.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24269.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24270A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24271transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24272&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24273for four days.
24274.endlist
24275
24276.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24277The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24278timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24279it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24280However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24281heuristic rules:
24282
24283.ilist
24284If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24285used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24286quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24287.next
24288.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24289For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24290subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24291the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24292change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24293MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24294time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24295.next
24296For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24297obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24298.endlist
24299
24300The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24301mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24302when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24303error).
24304
24305
24306
24307.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24308.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24309You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24310specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24311apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24312form:
24313.display
24314&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24315.endd
24316The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24317.code
24318* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24319.endd
24320matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24321host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24322For example:
24323.code
24324a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24325.endd
24326&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24327(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24328only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24329its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24330all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24331
24332When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24333&%-f%& command line option, like this:
24334.code
24335exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24336.endd
24337If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24338list is never matched.
24339
24340
24341
24342
24343
24344.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24345.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24346The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24347sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24348.display
24349<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24350.endd
24351The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24352time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24353arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24354time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24355relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24356
24357.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24358.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
24359.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
24360.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
24361The available algorithms are:
24362
24363.ilist
24364&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
24365the interval.
24366.next
24367&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
24368specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
24369is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
24370.next
24371&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
24372retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
24373maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
24374the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
24375rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
24376members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
24377queue processing times.
24378.endlist
24379
24380When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
24381order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
24382used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
24383case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
24384current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
24385computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
24386interval is found. The main configuration variable
24387.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
24388.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
24389.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
24390&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
24391cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
24392
24393A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
24394host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
24395basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
24396for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
24397generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
24398time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
24399time.
24400
24401.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
24402Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
24403run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
24404starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
24405new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
24406If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
24407occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
24408messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
24409processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
24410your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
24411number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
24412sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24413
24414The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24415&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24416&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24417&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24418are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24419deliveries that have been deferred.
24420
24421
24422.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24423Here are some example retry rules:
24424.code
24425alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24426wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24427wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24428lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24429* refused_A F,2h,20m;
24430* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24431.endd
24432The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24433&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24434mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24435hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24436parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24437effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24438fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24439days.
24440
24441The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24442happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24443intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24444first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24445so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24446
24447The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24448They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24449all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24450were not obtained from an MX record.
24451
24452The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24453first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24454not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24455hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
244561.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24457
24458
24459
24460.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24461.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24462.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24463.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24464.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24465Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24466consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24467set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24468been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24469arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24470failing for the first time.
24471
24472This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24473backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24474Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24475down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24476
24477If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24478every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24479message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24480
24481
24482
24483
24484.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24485.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24486.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24487Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24488that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24489default retry rule:
24490.code
24491* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24492.endd
24493the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24494long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24495failure for the recipient address that counts.
24496
24497When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24498addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24499causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24500In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24501time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24502
24503For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24504messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24505post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24506
24507If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24508.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24509&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24510default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24511reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24512attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24513those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24514the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24515
24516In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24517for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24518times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24519behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24520to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24521notice.
24522
24523If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24524addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24525addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24526no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24527words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24528addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24529If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24530&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24531deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24532true.
24533
24534.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24535.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24536Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24537intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24538its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24539because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24540host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24541failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24542reached.
24543
24544Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24545applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24546Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24547examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24548commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24549time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24550is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24551time out the address.
24552
24553The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24554the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24555given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24556time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24557not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24558considered immediately.
24559.ecindex IIDretconf1
24560.ecindex IIDregconf2
24561
24562
24563
24564
24565
24566
24567. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24568. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24569
24570.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24571.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24572.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24573The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24574with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24575described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24576to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24577permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24578transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24579other.
24580
24581.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24582Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24583
24584.ilist
24585The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24586the client's EHLO command.
24587.next
24588The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24589may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24590.next
24591The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24592appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24593just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24594any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24595with the AUTH command.
24596.next
24597The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24598.next
24599If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24600option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24601mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24602connection.
24603.next
24604If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
24605authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
24606unauthenticated connection.
24607.endlist
24608
24609If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
24610mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
24611SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
24612includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
24613.display
24614&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
24615&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
24616&`Connected to server.example.`&
24617&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
24618&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
24619&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
24620&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
24621&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
24622&`250-PIPELINING`&
24623&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
24624&`250 HELP`&
24625.endd
24626The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
24627authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
24628mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
24629routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
24630controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
24631included by setting
24632.code
24633AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
24634AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
24635AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
24636AUTH_GSASL=yes
24637AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
24638AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
24639AUTH_SPA=yes
24640.endd
24641in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
24642authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
24643the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
24644The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
24645work via a socket interface.
24646The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
24647provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
24648The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
24649supporting setting a server keytab.
24650The sixth can be configured to support
24651the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
24652not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
24653supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
24654
24655The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
24656section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
24657authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
24658authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
24659is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
24660messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
24661options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
24662
24663To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
24664&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
24665either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
24666functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
24667to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
24668both sets of options, is required. For example:
24669.code
24670cram:
24671 driver = cram_md5
24672 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24673 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
24674 client_name = ph10
24675 client_secret = secret2
24676.endd
24677The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
24678&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
24679
24680Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
24681The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
24682authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
24683in Exim.
24684
24685&*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
24686per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
24687account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
24688authenticating data.
24689
24690Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
24691&'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
24692and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
24693Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
24694used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
24695second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
24696user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
24697configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
24698&'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
24699as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
24700choose to honour.
24701
24702A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
24703to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
24704mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
24705typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
24706
24707
24708
24709.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
24710.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
24711.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
24712
24713.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24714When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
24715&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
24716used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
24717encrypted by a setting such as:
24718.code
24719client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
24720.endd
24721
24722
24723.option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24724When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
24725result is used in the log lines for outbound messasges.
24726Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
24727
24728
24729.option driver authenticators string unset
24730This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
24731authenticators is to be used.
24732
24733
24734.option public_name authenticators string unset
24735This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
24736implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
24737contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
24738but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
24739defaults to the driver's instance name.
24740
24741
24742.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24743When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
24744is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
24745mechanism is not advertised.
24746If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
24747forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
24748See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
24749
24750
24751.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24752This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
24753is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
24754for details.
24755
24756For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
24757mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
24758
24759For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
24760authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
24761authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
24762authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
24763to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
24764error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
24765string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24766expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
24767other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
24768the error text.
24769
24770
24771.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
24772If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
24773command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
24774output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
24775out the values of variables.
24776If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
24777output, and Exim carries on processing.
24778
24779
24780.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24781.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24782When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
24783expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
24784messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
24785lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
24786configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
24787refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
24788If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
24789
24790
24791.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24792This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
24793as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
24794driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
24795as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
24796remembered for later use.
24797How it is used is described in the following section.
24798
24799
24800
24801
24802
24803.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
24804.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
24805.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24806When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
24807the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
24808message:
24809
24810.ilist
24811If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
24812than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
24813.next
24814If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
24815.next
24816.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
24817If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
24818running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
24819from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
24820&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
24821return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
24822given for the MAIL command.
24823.next
24824If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
24825is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
24826authenticated.
24827.next
24828If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
24829the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
24830&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
24831valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
24832fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
24833&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
24834the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
24835message.
24836.endlist
24837
24838
24839When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
24840hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
24841&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
24842process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
24843
24844.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24845Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
24846MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
24847therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
24848value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
24849ACL is run.
24850
24851
24852
24853.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
24854.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
24855When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
24856authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
24857conditions:
24858
24859.ilist
24860The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
24861.next
24862It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
24863yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
24864.endlist
24865
24866The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
24867the mechanisms are advertised.
24868
24869Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
24870provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
24871even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
24872set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
24873You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
24874For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
24875that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
24876.code
24877auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
24878.endd
24879so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
24880
24881The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
24882authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
24883advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
24884such as:
24885.code
24886server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
24887.endd
24888.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
24889If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
24890yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
24891
24892When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
24893immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
24894command. This is the case if
24895
24896.ilist
24897The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
24898.next
24899No authenticators are configured with server options; or
24900.next
24901Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
24902server authenticators.
24903.endlist
24904
24905
24906Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
24907to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
24908AUTH is accepted from any client host.
24909
24910If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
24911server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
24912that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
24913the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
24914fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
24915rejected with a 504 error.
24916
24917.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
24918.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
24919When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
24920&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
24921or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
24922public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
24923client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
24924no successful authentication.
24925
24926
24927
24928
24929.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
24930.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
24931.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
24932.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
24933Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
24934configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
24935encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
24936script:
24937.code
24938use MIME::Base64;
24939printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
24940.endd
24941.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
24942This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
24943interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
24944some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
24945command line to run this script on such data might be
24946.code
24947encode '\0user\0password'
24948.endd
24949Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
24950backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
24951whose code value is zero.
24952
24953&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
24954digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
24955you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
24956interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
24957
24958&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
24959specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
24960example, a command such as
24961.code
24962encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
24963.endd
24964gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
24965
24966If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
24967base64-encoded strings is to run the command
24968.code
24969echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
24970.endd
24971The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
24972in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
24973output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
24974should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
24975
24976
24977
24978.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
24979.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
24980The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
24981&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
24982announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
24983of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
24984
24985.ilist
24986For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
24987they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
24988mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
24989of the authenticator.
24990.next
24991.vindex "&$host$&"
24992.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24993When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
24994variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
24995that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
24996any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
24997Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
24998delivery to be deferred.
24999.next
25000If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25001Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25002try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25003usual way.
25004.next
25005If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25006carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25007possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25008no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25009what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25010&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25011delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25012turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25013deliver the message unauthenticated.
25014.endlist
25015
25016.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25017When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25018parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25019the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25020is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25021incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25022allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25023to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25024&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25025&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25026the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25027.ecindex IIDauthconf1
25028.ecindex IIDauthconf2
25029
25030
25031
25032
25033
25034
25035. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25036. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25037
25038.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25039.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25040.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25041The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25042LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25043plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25044security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25045(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25046use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25047connections as you do for login accounts.
25048
25049.section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25050.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25051When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25052
25053.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25054This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25055configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25056
25057.option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25058The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25059prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25060given.
25061
25062.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25063.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25064.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25065.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25066 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25067.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25068.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25069
25070When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25071expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25072response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25073values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25074a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25075are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25076(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25077
25078For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25079the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25080variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25081string expansions that also use them for other things.
25082
25083If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25084supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25085data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25086
25087.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25088Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25089&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25090authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25091to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25092&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25093expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25094generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25095For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25096string as the error text
25097
25098&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25099password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25100There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25101
25102
25103
25104.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25105.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25106.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25107.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25108The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25109sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25110separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25111subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25112
25113The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25114Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25115configured as follows:
25116.code
25117fixed_plain:
25118 driver = plaintext
25119 public_name = PLAIN
25120 server_prompts = :
25121 server_condition = \
25122 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25123 server_set_id = $auth2
25124.endd
25125Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25126are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25127password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25128or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25129
25130The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25131the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25132AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25133authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25134.code
25135250-AUTH PLAIN
25136.endd
25137and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25138.code
25139AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25140.endd
25141As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25142data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25143.code
25144AUTH PLAIN
25145.endd
25146to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25147prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25148
25149The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25150when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25151represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25152is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25153second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25154
25155Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25156realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25157authenticating clients it could make sense.
25158
25159A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25160&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25161comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25162this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25163This is an incorrect example:
25164.code
25165server_condition = \
25166 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25167.endd
25168The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25169which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25170incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25171non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25172strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25173the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25174name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25175.code
25176server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25177 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25178.endd
25179In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25180fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25181used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25182always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25183writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25184
25185
25186.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25187.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25188.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25189The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25190in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25191user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25192plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25193.code
25194fixed_login:
25195 driver = plaintext
25196 public_name = LOGIN
25197 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25198 server_condition = \
25199 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25200 server_set_id = $auth1
25201.endd
25202Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25203with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25204if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25205strings are used to obtain two data items.
25206
25207Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25208example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25209&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25210strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25211name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25212.code
25213login:
25214 driver = plaintext
25215 public_name = LOGIN
25216 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25217 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25218 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
25219 ldapauth{\
25220 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25221 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25222 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25223 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25224.endd
25225We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25226does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25227operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25228&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25229correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25230the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25231uninterpreted string.
25232
25233
25234.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25235A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25236interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25237traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25238Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25239&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
25240
25241
25242
25243
25244.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25245.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25246The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25247
25248.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25249If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25250authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25251the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25252usual.
25253
25254.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25255The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25256string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25257string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25258to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25259most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25260with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25261way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25262(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25263so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25264&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25265&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25266
25267&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25268splitting takes priority and happens first.
25269
25270Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25271the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25272there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25273NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25274the string.
25275
25276This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25277authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25278.code
25279fixed_plain:
25280 driver = plaintext
25281 public_name = PLAIN
25282 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25283.endd
25284The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25285command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25286that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25287.code
25288fixed_login:
25289 driver = plaintext
25290 public_name = LOGIN
25291 client_send = : username : mysecret
25292.endd
25293The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25294the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25295prompts.
25296.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25297.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25298
25299
25300
25301
25302. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25303. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25304
25305.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25306.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25307.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25308.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25309.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25310The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25311sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25312name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25313string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25314is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25315secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25316available in plain text at either end.
25317
25318
25319.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25320.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25321This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25322authenticator as a server:
25323
25324.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25325.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25326When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25327the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25328obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25329that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25330string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25331fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25332returned to the client.
25333
25334For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25335in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25336deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25337numeric variables for other things.
25338
25339For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25340client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25341user name, authentication fails.
25342.code
25343fixed_cram:
25344 driver = cram_md5
25345 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25346 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25347 server_set_id = $auth1
25348.endd
25349.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25350If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25351name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25352secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25353.code
25354lookup_cram:
25355 driver = cram_md5
25356 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25357 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
25358 {$value}fail}
25359 server_set_id = $auth1
25360.endd
25361Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
25362because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
25363
25364As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
25365using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
25366lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
25367realm, with:
25368.code
25369cyrusless_crammd5:
25370 driver = cram_md5
25371 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25372 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
25373 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}}
25374 server_set_id = $auth1
25375.endd
25376
25377.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
25378.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
25379When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
25380
25381
25382
25383.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
25384This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
25385computing the response to the server's challenge.
25386
25387
25388.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25389This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
25390expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
25391
25392
25393.vindex "&$host$&"
25394.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25395Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
25396to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
25397expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
25398prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
25399authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
25400send the message to the current server.
25401
25402A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
25403strings, is:
25404.code
25405fixed_cram:
25406 driver = cram_md5
25407 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25408 client_name = ph10
25409 client_secret = secret
25410.endd
25411.ecindex IIDcramauth1
25412.ecindex IIDcramauth2
25413
25414
25415
25416. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25417. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25418
25419.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25420.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25421.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25422.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25423.cindex "Kerberos"
25424The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25425Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25426
25427The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25428library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25429Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25430including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25431directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25432
25433The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25434the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25435then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25436name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25437
25438Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25439or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25440user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25441by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25442depending on the driver you are using.
25443
25444The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25445be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25446Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25447changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25448layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25449implementation.
25450
25451For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25452may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25453variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25454Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25455With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25456environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25457is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25458the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25459
25460
25461.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25462The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25463(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25464previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25465use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25466confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25467things.
25468
25469
25470.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25471This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25472library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25473SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25474
25475
25476.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25477This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25478default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25479you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25480example:
25481.code
25482sasl:
25483 driver = cyrus_sasl
25484 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25485 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25486 server_set_id = $auth1
25487.endd
25488
25489.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25490This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25491
25492
25493.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25494This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25495
25496
25497For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25498private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25499the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25500PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25501.code
25502sasl_cram_md5:
25503 driver = cyrus_sasl
25504 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25505 server_set_id = $auth1
25506
25507sasl_plain:
25508 driver = cyrus_sasl
25509 public_name = PLAIN
25510 server_set_id = $auth2
25511.endd
25512Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25513not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25514but it is present in many binary distributions.
25515.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25516.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25517
25518
25519
25520
25521. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25522. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25523.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25524.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25525.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25526This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25527Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25528Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
25529If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25530to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25531authenticator only. There is only one option:
25532
25533.option server_socket dovecot string unset
25534
25535This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25536authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25537mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25538authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25539.code
25540dovecot_plain:
25541 driver = dovecot
25542 public_name = PLAIN
25543 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25544 server_set_id = $auth1
25545
25546dovecot_ntlm:
25547 driver = dovecot
25548 public_name = NTLM
25549 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25550 server_set_id = $auth1
25551.endd
25552If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25553&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25554option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25555connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25556option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25557who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25558.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25559.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25560
25561
25562. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25563. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25564.chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25565.scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25566.scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25567.cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25568.cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25569.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25570.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25571.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25572.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25573.cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25574.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25575.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25576The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25577library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25578and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25579scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25580made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25581without code changes in Exim.
25582
25583
25584.option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25585Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25586of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25587authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25588ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25589context.
25590
25591This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25592as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25593see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25594
25595This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25596only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25597writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25598
25599This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
25600this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
25601of Exim may switch the default to be true.
25602
25603
25604.option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
25605This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25606library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25607Some mechanisms will use this data.
25608
25609
25610.option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
25611This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25612default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25613you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25614example:
25615.code
25616sasl:
25617 driver = gsasl
25618 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25619 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25620 server_set_id = $auth1
25621.endd
25622
25623
25624.option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
25625Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
25626that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
25627the password itself.
25628
25629The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
25630In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
25631The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
25632if available, else the empty string.
25633The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
25634else the empty string.
25635
25636A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
25637
25638If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
25639option to be simply "true".
25640
25641
25642.option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
25643This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25644Some mechanisms will use this data.
25645
25646
25647.option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
25648This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25649&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25650(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25651
25652
25653.option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
25654This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25655&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25656(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25657
25658
25659.option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
25660This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25661Some mechanisms will use this data.
25662
25663
25664.section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
25665.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25666These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
25667They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
25668
25669Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
25670meanings for these variables:
25671
25672.ilist
25673.vindex "&$auth1$&"
25674&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
25675.next
25676.vindex "&$auth2$&"
25677&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
25678.next
25679.vindex "&$auth3$&"
25680&$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
25681.endlist
25682
25683On a per-mechanism basis:
25684
25685.ilist
25686.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25687EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
25688the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25689.next
25690.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25691ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
25692the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25693.next
25694.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25695GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
25696&$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
25697the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25698.endlist
25699
25700An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
25701identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
25702email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
25703
25704
25705An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
25706and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
25707.code
25708gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
25709 driver = gsasl
25710 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25711 server_realm = imap.example.org
25712 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
25713 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25714 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
25715 server_condition = yes
25716.endd
25717
25718
25719. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25720. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25721
25722.chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
25723.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
25724.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
25725.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25726.cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
25727The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
25728Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
25729reliably.
25730
25731.option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
25732This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
25733for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
25734identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25735
25736.option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
25737If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
25738&_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
25739The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
25740
25741.option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
25742This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
25743&%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
25744from the keytab.
25745
25746
25747.section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
25748Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
25749to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
25750not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
25751
25752The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
25753Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
25754Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
25755role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
25756
25757.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25758.ilist
25759.vindex "&$auth1$&"
25760&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
25761.next
25762.vindex "&$auth2$&"
25763&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
25764authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
25765GSS Display Name.
25766.endlist
25767
25768
25769. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25770. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25771
25772.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
25773.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
25774.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
25775.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
25776.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
25777.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
25778.cindex "NTLM authentication"
25779The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
25780Password Authentication'& mechanism,
25781which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
25782this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
25783taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
25784server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
25785follows:
25786
25787.ilist
25788After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
25789authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
25790.next
25791The server sends back a challenge.
25792.next
25793The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
25794and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
25795.endlist
25796
25797Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
25798
25799
25800
25801.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
25802.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
25803The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
25804
25805.option server_password spa string&!! unset
25806.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
25807This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
25808authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
25809compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
25810&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
25811it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
25812for other things. For example:
25813.code
25814spa:
25815 driver = spa
25816 public_name = NTLM
25817 server_password = \
25818 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
25819.endd
25820If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
25821failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
25822
25823
25824
25825
25826
25827.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
25828.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
25829The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
25830
25831
25832
25833.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
25834This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
25835
25836
25837.option client_password spa string&!! unset
25838This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
25839
25840
25841.option client_username spa string&!! unset
25842This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
25843configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
25844&'msn.com'&:
25845.code
25846msn:
25847 driver = spa
25848 public_name = MSN
25849 client_username = msn/msn_username
25850 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
25851 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
25852.endd
25853.ecindex IIDspaauth1
25854.ecindex IIDspaauth2
25855
25856
25857
25858
25859
25860. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25861. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25862
25863.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
25864 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
25865.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
25866.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
25867.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
25868.cindex "OpenSSL"
25869.cindex "GnuTLS"
25870Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
25871Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
25872GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
25873cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
25874order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
25875version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
25876You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
25877level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
25878certificates are used.
25879
25880RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
25881connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
25882server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
25883mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
25884between them is encrypted.
25885
25886Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
25887and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
25888certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
25889possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
25890encryption state.
25891
25892&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
25893disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
25894in order to get TLS to work.
25895
25896
25897
25898.section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
25899 "SECID284"
25900.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
25901.cindex "smtps protocol"
25902.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
25903.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
25904Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
25905SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
25906waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
25907port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
25908allocated for this purpose.
25909
25910This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
25911still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
25912the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
25913numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
25914.code
25915tls_on_connect_ports = 465
25916.endd
25917The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
25918via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
25919the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
25920the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
25921an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
25922defined elsewhere.
25923
25924There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
25925&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
25926
25927
25928
25929
25930
25931
25932.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
25933.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
25934The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
25935followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
25936to use GnuTLS, you need to set
25937.code
25938USE_GNUTLS=yes
25939.endd
25940in Local/Makefile, in addition to
25941.code
25942SUPPORT_TLS=yes
25943.endd
25944You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
25945include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
25946
25947There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
25948
25949.ilist
25950The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
25951name of a directory for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
25952(for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
25953.next
25954The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
25955.next
25956.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25957.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
25958Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
25959separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
25960affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
25961.next
25962OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
25963DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
25964RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
25965in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
25966for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
25967to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
25968&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
25969option).
25970.next
25971The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
25972sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
25973.next
25974The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
25975When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
25976(If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
25977let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
25978.next
25979Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
25980This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
25981explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
25982implementation, then patches are welcome.
25983.endlist
25984
25985
25986.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
25987This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
25988an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
25989but not the chosen filename.
25990By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
25991See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
25992
25993GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
25994to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
25995Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
25996&_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
25997of bits requested.
25998The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
25999its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26000parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26001that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26002renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26003this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26004place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26005
26006For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26007recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26008If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26009are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26010not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26011
26012Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26013values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26014parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26015If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26016until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26017a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26018
26019The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26020in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26021generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26022
26023To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26024and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26025&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26026renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26027.code
26028# ls
26029[ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26030# rm -f new-params
26031# touch new-params
26032# chown exim:exim new-params
26033# chmod 0600 new-params
26034# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26035# openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26036[ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26037 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26038 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26039# chmod 0400 new-params
26040# mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26041.endd
26042If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26043stalling is removed.
26044
26045The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26046Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26047the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26048a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26049and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26050failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26051of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26052which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26053GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26054to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26055limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26056
26057The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26058value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26059&%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
260602432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26061
26062In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26063increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26064bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26065procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26066the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26067
26068
26069.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26070.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26071.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26072There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26073suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26074are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26075DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26076directly to this function call.
26077Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26078&'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26079The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26080documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26081
26082.ilist
26083It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26084.next
26085It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26086or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26087ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26088SSL v3 algorithms.
26089.next
26090Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26091the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26092SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26093algorithms.
26094.endlist
26095
26096Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26097&`-`& or &`+`&.
26098.ilist
26099If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26100ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26101stated.
26102.next
26103If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26104of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26105.next
26106If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26107option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26108.endlist
26109
26110If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26111a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26112includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26113not be moved to the end of the list.
26114.endlist
26115
26116The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26117string:
26118.code
26119# note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26120$ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26121.endd
26122
26123This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26124there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26125submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26126choice of clients used:
26127.code
26128# OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26129tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26130 {DEFAULT}\
26131 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
26132.endd
26133
26134
26135
26136.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26137 "SECTreqciphgnu"
26138.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26139.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26140.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26141.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26142.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26143.cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26144.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26145The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26146as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26147ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26148
26149The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26150and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26151
26152The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26153controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26154&(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26155the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26156the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26157aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26158
26159Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26160"Priority strings". This is online as
26161&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26162but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26163installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26164&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26165on that site can be used to test a given string.
26166
26167For example:
26168.code
26169# Disable older versions of protocols
26170tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26171.endd
26172
26173Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26174additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26175"&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26176
26177This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26178there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26179by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26180where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26181used:
26182.code
26183# GnuTLS variant
26184tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26185 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
26186 {SECURE128}}
26187.endd
26188
26189
26190.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26191.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26192When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26193the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26194but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26195that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26196need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26197sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26198
26199If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26200problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26201persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26202with the error
26203.code
26204554 Security failure
26205.endd
26206If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26207rejected with a 554 error code.
26208
26209To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26210match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26211However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26212without some further configuration at the server end.
26213
26214It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26215encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26216.code
26217tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26218tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26219.endd
26220These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26221the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26222contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26223that goes with it. These files need to be
26224PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
26225always be given as full path names.
26226The key must not be password-protected.
26227They can be the same file if both the
26228certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26229set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26230is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26231certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26232the server's certificate.
26233
26234If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26235source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26236few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26237
26238&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26239they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26240Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26241transport.
26242
26243With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26244require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26245this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26246.code
26247tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26248.endd
26249is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26250with the parameters contained in the file.
26251Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26252available:
26253.code
26254tls_dhparam = none
26255.endd
26256This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26257DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26258used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26259documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26260
26261See the command
26262.code
26263openssl dhparam
26264.endd
26265for a way of generating file data.
26266
26267The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
26268host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
26269for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
26270in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
26271forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
26272
26273.cindex "cipher" "logging"
26274.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26275.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26276The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
26277an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
26278incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
26279also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
26280&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
26281condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
26282
26283Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
26284can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
26285cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
26286example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
26287contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
26288documentation for more details.
26289
26290For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
26291(again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
26292
26293
26294.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
26295.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26296.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26297If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
26298session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
26299&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
26300apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
26301Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
26302contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
26303expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
26304for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
26305&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
26306
26307A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
26308directory is used
26309(OpenSSL only),
26310each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
26311of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
26312certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
26313.code
26314openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
26315.endd
26316where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
26317
26318The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
26319what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
26320does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
26321&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
26322attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
26323dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
26324session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
26325fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
26326example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
26327relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
26328
26329.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26330When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
26331the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
26332&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
26333
26334.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26335Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
26336&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
26337&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
26338&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
26339certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
26340
26341
26342.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
26343.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
26344.cindex "revocation list"
26345.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
26346.cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
26347Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
26348certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
26349server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
26350an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
26351of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
26352CRL in PEM format.
26353The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
26354file from every certificate authority they know of.
26355
26356The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
26357Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
26358against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
26359usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
26360private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
26361is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
26362
26363The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
26364comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
26365connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
26366re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
26367
26368The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
26369issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
26370the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
26371negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
26372CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
26373resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
26374starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
26375proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
26376
26377Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
26378or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.1.3,
26379support for OCSP stapling is included.
26380
26381There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26382The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
26383an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
26384option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
26385contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
26386
26387Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
26388proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
26389Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
26390contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
26391on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
26392next connection.
26393
26394When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
26395in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
26396ignored.
26397
26398For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
26399also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
26400certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
26401of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
26402intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
26403file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26404
26405Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
26406not any of the chain from CA to it.
26407
26408There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
26409
26410.code
26411 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
26412 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
26413 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
26414
26415 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
26416 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
26417 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
26418.endd
26419
26420
26421
26422
26423.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
26424.cindex "cipher" "logging"
26425.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26426.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26427.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
26428The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
26429deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
26430server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
26431within the &(smtp)& transport.
26432
26433It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
26434transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
26435server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
26436this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
26437transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
26438
26439If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
26440to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
26441&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
26442those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
26443set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
26444usual way.
26445
26446When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
26447the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
26448a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
26449session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
26450&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
26451delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
26452it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
26453STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
26454negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26455unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26456unencrypted.
26457
26458The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
26459transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
26460if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
26461&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
26462
26463If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
26464must name a file or,
26465for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
26466expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
26467against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
26468in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
26469Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
26470&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
26471
26472The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
26473certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
26474or need not succeed respectively.
26475
26476The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
26477&%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
26478is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
26479value is empty.
26480&%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
26481a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
26482value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
26483otherwise.
26484
26485The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
26486&%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
26487for OCSP to be relevant.
26488
26489If
26490&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
26491list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
26492the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
26493alternative hosts, if any.
26494
26495 &*Note*&:
26496These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
26497is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
26498by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
26499client.
26500
26501.vindex "&$host$&"
26502.vindex "&$host_address$&"
26503All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
26504&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
26505which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
26506behave as if the relevant option were unset.
26507
26508.vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
26509.vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
26510.vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
26511.vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
26512Before an SMTP connection is established, the
26513&$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
26514variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
26515that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
26516successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
26517outgoing connection.
26518
26519
26520
26521.section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
26522.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26523.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
26524.oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
26525With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
26526information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
26527extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
26528&"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
26529client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
26530within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
26531for this session.
26532
26533This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
26534which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
26535address.
26536
26537With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
26538against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
26539provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
26540be of limited use in that environment.
26541
26542With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
26543connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
26544choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
26545wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
26546different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
26547
26548The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
26549if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
26550nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
26551only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
26552for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
26553
26554Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
26555received from a client.
26556It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
26557
26558If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
26559option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
26560during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
26561
26562.ilist
26563.vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
26564&%tls_certificate%&
26565.next
26566.vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
26567&%tls_crl%&
26568.next
26569.vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
26570&%tls_privatekey%&
26571.next
26572.vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
26573&%tls_verify_certificates%&
26574.next
26575.vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
26576&%tls_ocsp_file%&
26577.endlist
26578
26579Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
26580attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
26581can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
26582arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
26583
26584The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
26585are re-expanded.
26586
26587When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
26588for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
26589enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
26590see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
26591
26592When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
265930.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
26594built, then you have SNI support).
26595
26596
26597
26598.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
26599 "SECTmulmessam"
26600.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
26601.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
26602Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
26603an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
26604one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
26605of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
26606connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
26607to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
26608session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
26609try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
26610if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
26611
26612The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
26613after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
26614just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
26615reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
26616successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
26617SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
26618should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
26619subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
26620and delay other deliveries to that host.
26621
26622To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
26623closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
26624closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
26625information is recorded.
26626
26627There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
26628&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
26629connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
26630
26631
26632
26633
26634.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
26635.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
26636In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
26637certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
26638place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
26639myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
26640to Apache, currently at
26641.display
26642&url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
26643.endd
26644Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
26645links to further files.
26646Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
266470-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
26648Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
26649.display
26650&url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
26651.endd
26652
26653
26654.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
26655The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
26656certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
26657sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
26658not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
26659First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
26660certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
26661intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
26662certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
26663The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
26664validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
26665root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
26666install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
26667
26668Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
26669even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
26670server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
26671diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
26672
26673
26674
26675.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
26676.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
26677You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
26678with OpenSSL, like this:
26679. ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
26680. ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
26681.code
26682openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
26683 -days 9999 -nodes
26684.endd
26685&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
26686delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
26687specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
26688important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
26689that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
26690prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
26691this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
26692
26693. ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
26694. ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
26695. ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
26696. ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
26697. ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
26698. ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
26699. ==== -pdp, 2012
26700NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
26701epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
26702the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
26703the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
26704of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
26705writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
26706progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
26707be a sensible resolution).
26708
26709A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
26710may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
26711encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
26712
26713However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
26714user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
26715certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
26716must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
26717authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
26718signed with that self-signed certificate.
26719
26720For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
26721user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
26722Open-source PKI book, available online at
26723&url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
26724.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
26725.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
26726
26727
26728
26729. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26730. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26731
26732.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
26733.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
26734.cindex "control of incoming mail"
26735.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
26736.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
26737Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
26738configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
26739name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
26740one very small ACL:
26741.code
26742begin acl
26743small_acl:
26744 accept hosts = one.host.only
26745.endd
26746You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
26747which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
26748
26749The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
26750certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
26751when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
26752option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
26753in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
26754local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
26755a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
26756&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
26757
26758
26759.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
26760The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
26761configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
26762The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
26763relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
26764
26765
26766
26767.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
26768.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
26769In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
26770options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
26771.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
26772.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26773.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
26774.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
26775.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26776.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26777.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
26778.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26779.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
26780.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
26781.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
26782.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26783.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26784.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
26785.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
26786
26787.table2 140pt
26788.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
26789.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
26790.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
26791.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
26792.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
26793.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
26794.irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
26795.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
26796.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
26797.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
26798.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
26799.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
26800.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
26801.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
26802.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
26803.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
26804.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
26805.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
26806.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
26807.endtable
26808
26809For example, if you set
26810.code
26811acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
26812.endd
26813the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
26814in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
26815done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
26816sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
26817command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
26818trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
26819testing as possible at RCPT time.
26820
26821
26822.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
26823.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26824The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
26825apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
26826really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
26827the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
26828relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
26829are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
26830&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
26831&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
26832in any of these ACLs.
26833
26834The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
26835non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
26836analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
26837batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
26838result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
26839really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
26840on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
26841controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
26842.code
26843control = suppress_local_fixups
26844.endd
26845This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
26846run, it is too late.
26847
26848The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26849content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26850
26851The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
26852kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
26853temporary error for these kinds of message.
26854
26855
26856.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
26857.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26858.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
26859The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
26860session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
26861an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
26862accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
26863the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
26864&%smtp_banner%& option.
26865
26866
26867.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
26868.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26869.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26870The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
26871EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
26872&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
26873Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
26874session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
26875setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
26876
26877If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
26878modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
26879at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
26880affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
26881an EHLO response.
26882
26883
26884.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
26885.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26886Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
26887command, with two responses being sent to the client.
26888When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
26889is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
26890the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
26891response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
26892added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
26893are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
26894
26895You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
26896in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
26897tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
26898received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
26899the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
26900associated with the DATA command.
26901
26902For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
26903error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
26904MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
26905before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
26906and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
26907your resources.
26908
26909The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
26910the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
26911the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
26912and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
26913
26914.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
26915The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
26916enabled (which is the default).
26917
26918The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
26919received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
26920otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
26921
26922This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26923
26924For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
26925
26926
26927.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
26928The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26929content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26930
26931This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26932
26933
26934.section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
26935.oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
26936The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
26937with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
26938It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
26939client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
26940has been accepted.
26941
26942The ACL test specfied by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
26943has been recieved, and is executed for each recipient of the message.
26944The test may accept or deny for inividual recipients.
26945The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
26946can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
26947for some or all recipients.
26948
26949PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
26950one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
26951content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
26952for this can be disabled when the MAIL-time $smtp_command included
26953"PRDR". Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
26954ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
26955will avoid doing so in some situations (eg. single-recipient mails).
26956
26957See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
26958and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
26959
26960This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26961If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
26962the feature was not requested by the client.
26963
26964.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
26965.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26966The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
26967does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
26968does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
26969permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
26970
26971This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
26972session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
26973messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
26974more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
26975
26976&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
26977the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
26978
26979You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
26980&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
26981response to QUIT.
26982
26983This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
26984failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
26985because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
26986client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
26987connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
26988
26989
26990.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
26991.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
26992The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
26993an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
26994trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
26995because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
26996situation even worse.
26997
26998Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
26999logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27000modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27001and &%warn%&.
27002
27003.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27004When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27005to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27006connection. The possible values are:
27007.table2
27008.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27009.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27010.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27011.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27012.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27013.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27014.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27015.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27016.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27017.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27018.endtable
27019In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27020Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27021With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27022overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27023&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27024used.
27025
27026
27027.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27028.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27029The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27030you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27031.code
27032acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27033 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27034.endd
27035In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27036providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27037non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27038expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27039more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27040
27041The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27042configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27043string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27044
27045.ilist
27046If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27047contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27048Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27049lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27050If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27051causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27052.code
27053acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27054 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27055 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27056.endd
27057This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27058back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27059file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27060can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27061.next
27062If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27063Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27064matches the string.
27065.next
27066If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27067the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27068want to have something like
27069.code
27070acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27071.endd
27072in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27073newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27074.endlist
27075
27076
27077
27078
27079.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27080.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27081Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27082section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27083&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27084database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27085return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27086&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27087This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27088
27089For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27090&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27091submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27092
27093
27094ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27095has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27096individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27097blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27098
27099If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27100ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27101RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27102recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27103run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27104remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27105&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27106
27107
27108.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27109The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27110recipients; it may create new recipients.
27111
27112
27113
27114.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27115.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27116The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27117all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27118not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27119reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27120
27121For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27122these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27123used to accept or reject anything.
27124
27125For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27126&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27127&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27128when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27129
27130For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27131&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27132This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27133messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27134configuration file.
27135
27136
27137
27138
27139.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27140.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27141.vindex &$domain$&
27142.vindex &$local_part$&
27143.vindex &$sender_address$&
27144.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27145.vindex &$smtp_command$&
27146When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27147that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27148&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27149statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27150&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27151is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27152
27153When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27154contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27155set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27156how it is used.
27157
27158.vindex "&$message_size$&"
27159The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27160the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27161that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27162the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27163received).
27164
27165.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27166.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27167The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27168The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27169accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27170of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27171&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27172&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27173
27174
27175
27176
27177
27178.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27179.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27180.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27181.vindex &$smtp_command$&
27182When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27183the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27184and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27185These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27186here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27187encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27188does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27189unencrypted connections.
27190.code
27191acl_check_auth:
27192 accept encrypted = *
27193 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27194 {CRAM-MD5}}
27195 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27196.endd
27197(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27198that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27199encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27200option to do this.)
27201
27202
27203
27204.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27205.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27206.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27207An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27208with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27209Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27210set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27211
27212If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27213used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27214provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27215example:
27216.code
27217deny dnslists = list1.example
27218dnslists = list2.example
27219.endd
27220If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27221the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27222happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27223all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27224test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27225
27226
27227.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27228The ACL verbs are as follows:
27229
27230.ilist
27231.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27232&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27233of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27234appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27235is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27236after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27237check a RCPT command:
27238.code
27239accept domains = +local_domains
27240endpass
27241verify = recipient
27242.endd
27243If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
27244passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
27245the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
27246fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
27247&%endpass%&.
27248
27249The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
27250use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
27251that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
27252configuration.
27253
27254.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
27255If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
27256depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
27257(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
27258statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
27259SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
27260.display
27261&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
27262&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
27263.endd
27264You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
27265response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
27266same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
27267
27268If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
27269an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
27270for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
27271of &%endpass%&.
27272
27273
27274.next
27275.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
27276&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
27277an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
27278&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
27279temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
27280&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
27281be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
27282
27283
27284.next
27285.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
27286&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
27287the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
27288example,
27289.code
27290deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27291.endd
27292rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
27293
27294
27295.next
27296.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
27297&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
27298&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
27299that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
27300the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
27301recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
27302recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
27303message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
27304do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
27305
27306If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
27307its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
27308The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
27309
27310
27311.next
27312.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
27313&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
27314forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
27315.code
27316drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
27317 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
27318.endd
27319There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
27320The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
27321
27322.next
27323.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
27324&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
27325statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
27326example, when checking a RCPT command,
27327.code
27328require message = Sender did not verify
27329 verify = sender
27330.endd
27331passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
27332verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
27333&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
27334discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
27335
27336.next
27337.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27338&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
27339&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
27340to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
27341written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
27342message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
27343duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
27344
27345If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
27346and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
27347&%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
27348first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
27349&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27350
27351If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
27352some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
27353This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
27354is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
27355conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
27356is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
27357onwards.
27358
27359
27360.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27361When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
27362text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
27363want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
27364.code
27365warn !verify = sender
27366 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
27367.endd
27368.endlist
27369
27370At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
27371
27372As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
27373written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
27374subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
27375continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
27376mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
27377
27378
27379
27380.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
27381.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
27382There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
27383can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
27384of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
27385transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
27386variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
27387an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
27388alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
27389the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
27390.ilist
27391The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
27392throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
27393while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
27394on the same SMTP connection.
27395.next
27396The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
27397while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
27398reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
27399.endlist
27400
27401When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
27402preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
27403time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
27404.code
27405accept hosts = whatever
27406 set acl_m4 = some value
27407accept authenticated = *
27408 set acl_c_auth = yes
27409.endd
27410&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
27411be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
27412&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
27413
27414.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
27415What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
27416referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
27417false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
27418error is generated.
27419
27420Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
27421their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
27422
27423
27424.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
27425.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
27426.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
27427An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
27428.code
27429deny domains = *.dom.example
27430 !verify = recipient
27431.endd
27432causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
27433&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
27434negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
27435two statements are equivalent:
27436.code
27437deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
27438deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
27439.endd
27440However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
27441side negation of the whole condition is possible.
27442
27443The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
27444of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
27445condition is true. Consider these two statements:
27446.code
27447accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27448 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
27449accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27450 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
27451.endd
27452Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
27453the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
27454different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
27455condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
27456therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
27457the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
27458and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
27459
27460ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
27461specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
27462others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
27463warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
27464message is handled.
27465
27466The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
27467processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
27468modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
27469consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
27470.code
27471require message = Can't verify sender
27472 verify = sender
27473 message = Can't verify recipient
27474 verify = recipient
27475 message = This message cannot be used
27476.endd
27477If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
27478&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
27479so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
27480recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
27481verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
27482because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
27483
27484For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
27485modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
27486happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
27487the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
27488.code
27489deny hosts = ...
27490 !senders = *@my.domain.example
27491 message = Invalid sender from client host
27492.endd
27493The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
27494by which time Exim has set up the message.
27495
27496
27497
27498.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
27499.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
27500The ACL modifiers are as follows:
27501
27502.vlist
27503.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27504This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
27505incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
27506accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27507
27508.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27509.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
27510.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
27511This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
27512continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
27513the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
27514update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
27515write rather ugly lines like this:
27516.display
27517&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
27518.endd
27519Instead, all you need is
27520.display
27521&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
27522.endd
27523
27524.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27525.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27526This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
27527incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
27528lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
27529lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
27530controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
27531even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
27532
27533As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
27534separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
27535in several different ways. For example:
27536
27537. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
27538. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
27539. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
27540. ==== way.
27541
27542.ilist
27543It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
27544.code
27545 accept ...some conditions
27546 control = queue_only
27547.endd
27548In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
27549other words, when the conditions are all true.
27550
27551.next
27552It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
27553.code
27554 accept ...some conditions...
27555 control = queue_only
27556 ...some more conditions...
27557.endd
27558If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
27559statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
27560In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
27561to be relevant.
27562
27563.next
27564It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
27565decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
27566example:
27567.code
27568 warn ...some conditions...
27569 control = freeze
27570 accept ...
27571.endd
27572This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
27573&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
27574log entry.
27575
27576.next
27577If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
27578&%require%& verb. For example:
27579.code
27580 require control = no_multiline_responses
27581.endd
27582.endlist
27583
27584.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
27585.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
27586.oindex "&%-bh%&"
27587This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
27588the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
27589&%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
27590output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
27591happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
27592output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
27593
27594Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
27595example:
27596.code
27597deny ...some conditions...
27598 delay = 30s
27599.endd
27600The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
27601&"deny"&. Compare this with:
27602.code
27603deny delay = 30s
27604 ...some conditions...
27605.endd
27606which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
27607can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
27608.code
27609warn ...some conditions...
27610 delay = 2m
27611 control = freeze
27612accept ...
27613.endd
27614
27615If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
27616responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
27617they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
27618delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
27619appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
27620unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
27621using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
27622
27623
27624.vitem &*endpass*&
27625.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
27626This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
27627&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
27628failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
27629failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
27630confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
27631&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
27632
27633
27634.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27635.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
27636This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
27637ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
27638.code
27639require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
27640 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
27641.endd
27642&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
27643example:
27644.display
27645&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
27646&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
27647.endd
27648When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
27649that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
27650recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
27651message.
27652
27653The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
27654the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
27655denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
27656available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
27657variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
27658&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
27659ignored.
27660
27661.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27662If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
27663verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
27664error message.
27665
27666If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
27667the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
27668more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
27669actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
27670of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
27671is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
27672
27673If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
27674example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
27675the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
27676logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
27677both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
27678logging rejections.
27679
27680
27681.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
27682.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
27683.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
27684This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
27685about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
27686be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
27687may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
27688ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
27689.display
27690&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
27691&` log_reject_target =`&
27692.endd
27693This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
27694permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
27695current ACL.
27696
27697
27698.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27699.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
27700.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
27701This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
27702processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
27703&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
27704access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
27705ACLs. For example:
27706.display
27707&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
27708&` control = freeze`&
27709&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
27710.endd
27711By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
27712with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
27713another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
27714example:
27715.code
27716logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
27717logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
27718.endd
27719
27720
27721.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27722.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
27723This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
27724message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
27725or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
27726there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
27727&%accept%& for details.)
27728
27729The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
27730to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
27731generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
27732&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
27733the &%hosts%& condition fails:
27734.code
27735require message = Host not recognized
27736 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
27737.endd
27738(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
27739processed.)
27740
27741.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
27742.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
27743For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
27744of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
27745is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
27746is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
27747overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
27748accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
27749truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
27750EHLO options.
27751
27752When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
27753consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
27754of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
27755.code
27756deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
27757 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
27758.endd
27759The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
27760by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
27761access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
277622&'xx'&.
27763
27764Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
27765the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
27766
27767The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
27768literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
27769anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
27770response.
27771
27772.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27773.new
27774For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
27775stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
27776.wen
27777
27778If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
27779specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
27780However, the original message is available in the variable
27781&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
27782wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
27783routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
27784use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
27785
27786For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
27787is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
27788modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
27789all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
27790&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
27791&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
27792effect.
27793
27794
27795.vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27796This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
27797 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
27798the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
27799
27800
27801.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
27802.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
27803This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
27804&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
27805
27806
27807.vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
27808This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
27809collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
27810the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
27811of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
27812server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
27813separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
27814example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
27815when:
27816.code
27817udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
27818 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
27819.endd
27820.endlist
27821
27822
27823
27824
27825.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
27826.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27827The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
27828
27829.vlist
27830.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
27831This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
27832has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
27833apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
27834HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
27835really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
27836not work without it. For example:
27837.code
27838warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
27839 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
27840.endd
27841Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
27842the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
27843matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
27844mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
27845by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
27846
27847
27848.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
27849 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
27850.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
27851.cindex "case of local parts"
27852.vindex "&$local_part$&"
27853These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
27854(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
27855are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
27856any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
27857for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
27858is encountered.
27859
27860These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
27861local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
27862in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
27863handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
27864configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
27865
27866This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
27867containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
27868spam score:
27869.code
27870warn control = caseful_local_part
27871 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
27872 $acl_m4 + \
27873 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
27874 }
27875 control = caselower_local_part
27876.endd
27877Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
27878is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
27879
27880
27881.vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
27882.cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
27883.cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
27884This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
27885It is usable in the RCPT ACL and valid only for single-recipient mails forwarded
27886from one SMTP connection to another. If a recipient-verify callout connection is
27887requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for the data, otherwise one is made
27888after the ACL completes.
27889
27890Note that routers are used in verify mode,
27891and cannot depend on content of received headers.
27892Note also that headers cannot be
27893modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
27894Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
27895
27896Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
27897of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
27898before the entire message has been received from the source.
27899
27900Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
27901a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
27902If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
27903usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode the log line
27904is tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appears before the acceptance "<="
27905line.
27906
27907Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a (possibly faked)
27908sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
27909
27910
27911.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
27912.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
27913.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
27914This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
27915with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
27916&'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
27917may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
27918the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
27919option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
27920contexts):
27921.code
27922 control = debug
27923 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
27924 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
27925 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
27926.endd
27927
27928
27929.vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
27930.cindex "disable DKIM verify"
27931.cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
27932This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
27933the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27934
27935
27936.vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
27937.cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
27938.cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
27939This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
27940connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
27941strings or to numeric value.
27942The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
27943Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
27944&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
27945
27946The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
27947(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
27948that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
27949equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
27950Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
27951
27952
27953.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
27954 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
27955.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
27956.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
27957These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
27958is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
27959state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
27960in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
27961
27962The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27963connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
27964messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
27965&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
27966before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
27967synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
27968work with.
27969
27970
27971.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
27972.cindex "fake defer"
27973.cindex "defer, fake"
27974This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
27975except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
27976550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
27977messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
27978use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
27979
27980.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
27981.cindex "fake rejection"
27982.cindex "rejection, fake"
27983This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
27984words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
27985message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
27986However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
27987only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27988the same SMTP connection.
27989
27990The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
27991message is supplied, the following is used:
27992.code
27993550-Your message has been rejected but is being
27994550-kept for evaluation.
27995550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
27996550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
27997.endd
27998This facility should be used with extreme caution.
27999
28000.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28001.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28002This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28003other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28004it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28005current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28006SMTP connection.
28007
28008This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28009&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28010is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28011are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28012
28013.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28014.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28015Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28016avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28017use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28018disables such output flushing.
28019
28020.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28021.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28022Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28023avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28024use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28025that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28026
28027.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28028This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28029extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28030of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28031or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28032needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28033only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28034the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28035to be useful in production.
28036
28037.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28038.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28039This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28040It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28041SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28042
28043If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28044suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28045one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28046(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28047responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28048sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28049
28050.ilist
28051Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28052sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28053verification failed"&) is sent.
28054.next
28055If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28056line is output.
28057.endlist
28058
28059The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28060calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28061
28062.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28063.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28064This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28065the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28066response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28067controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28068&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28069
28070.vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28071.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28072.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28073This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28074other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28075it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28076runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28077effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28078to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28079same SMTP connection.
28080
28081.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28082.cindex "message" "submission"
28083.cindex "submission mode"
28084This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28085latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28086the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28087operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28088necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28089This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28090late (the message has already been created).
28091
28092Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28093messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28094submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28095The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28096that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28097
28098.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28099.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28100This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28101complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28102normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28103
28104.ilist
28105Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28106dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28107.next
28108No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28109.next
28110There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28111.endlist ilist
28112
28113This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28114passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28115used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28116and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28117data is read.
28118
28119&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28120that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28121.endlist vlist
28122
28123
28124.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28125All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28126
28127.ilist
28128Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28129.next
28130Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28131&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28132.next
28133Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28134.next
28135Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28136.endlist
28137
28138
28139
28140.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28141.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28142.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28143.cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28144The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28145to an incoming message, as in this example:
28146.code
28147warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28148 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28149 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28150.endd
28151The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28152MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28153receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28154&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28155any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28156RCPT ACL).
28157
28158Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28159DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28160
28161Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28162the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28163contains one or more newlines that
28164are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28165lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28166front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28167
28168Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28169They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28170However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28171is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28172during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28173with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28174lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28175In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28176non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28177message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28178are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28179
28180.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28181Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28182of message headers
28183until they are added to the
28184message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28185ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28186header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28187ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28188passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28189this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28190&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28191
28192The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28193
28194The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28195processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28196.display
28197&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28198&` `&<&'some condition'&>
28199
28200&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28201&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28202.endd
28203In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28204condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28205condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28206ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28207honoured.
28208
28209.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28210For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28211&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28212effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28213them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28214usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
28215are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
28216specifications.
28217
28218By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
28219header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
28220be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
28221after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
28222that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
28223
28224This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
28225&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
28226header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
28227to be a header name first.) For example:
28228.code
28229warn add_header = \
28230 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
28231.endd
28232If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
28233each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
28234you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
28235up in reverse order.
28236
28237&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28238added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
28239system filter or in a router or transport.
28240
28241
28242
28243.section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
28244.cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
28245.cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
28246.cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
28247The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
28248from an incoming message, as in this example:
28249.code
28250warn message = Remove internal headers
28251 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28252.endd
28253The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28254MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28255receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28256&%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
28257with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
28258any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
28259
28260Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
28261DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28262
28263More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
28264list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
28265not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
28266create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
28267are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
28268.code
28269warn hosts = +internal_hosts
28270 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28271warn message = Remove internal headers
28272 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
28273.endd
28274Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28275They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28276There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
28277a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
28278during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
28279if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
28280accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
28281all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
28282ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
28283would have been removed.
28284
28285.cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
28286Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
28287is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
28288not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
28289removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
28290this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
28291passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
28292you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
28293&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28294
28295The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28296processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28297.display
28298&`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
28299&` `&<&'some condition'&>
28300
28301&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28302&` remove_header = X-Internal`&
28303.endd
28304In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
28305condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
28306condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
28307same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
28308are honoured.
28309
28310&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28311present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
28312in a system filter or in a router or transport.
28313
28314
28315
28316
28317.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
28318.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
28319Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
28320compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
28321for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
28322content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28323
28324Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
28325senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
28326result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
28327done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
28328can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
28329same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
28330The conditions are as follows:
28331
28332
28333.vlist
28334.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
28335.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
28336.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
28337.cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
28338.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
28339The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
28340&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
28341&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
28342false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
28343condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
28344condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
28345ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
28346
28347If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
28348can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
28349and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
28350Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
28351The name and values are expanded separately.
28352Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
28353will act as argument separators.
28354
28355If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
28356the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
28357&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
28358conditions are tested.
28359
28360ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
28361loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
28362circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
28363for different local users or different local domains.
28364
28365.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28366.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
28367.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
28368.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
28369If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
28370the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
28371authentication by any authenticator, you can set
28372.code
28373authenticated = *
28374.endd
28375
28376.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
28377.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
28378.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
28379.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
28380.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
28381This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
28382expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
28383&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
28384number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
28385any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
28386&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
28387ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
28388negative.
28389
28390.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
28391.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
28392This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28393content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28394&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
28395If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
28396problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
28397chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28398
28399.vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
28400.cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
28401This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28402content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
28403&<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
28404
28405.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
28406.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
28407.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28408.cindex "black list (DNS)"
28409.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28410This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
28411&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
28412use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
28413different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
28414&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
28415
28416.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28417.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
28418.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
28419.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
28420.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
28421This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
28422of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
28423enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
28424lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
28425&%domains%& test.
28426
28427&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
28428use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
28429
28430
28431.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28432.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
28433.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
28434.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
28435If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
28436name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
28437encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
28438.code
28439encrypted = *
28440.endd
28441
28442
28443.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
28444.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
28445.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
28446.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
28447This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
28448name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
28449you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
28450.code
28451accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28452.endd
28453The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
28454the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
28455and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
28456
28457The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
28458Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
28459but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
28460find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
28461opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
28462found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
28463
28464If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
28465address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
28466.code
28467accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28468accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
28469.endd
28470The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
28471is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
28472statement can then check the IP address.
28473
28474.vindex "&$host_data$&"
28475If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
28476of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
28477allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
28478.code
28479deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
28480message = $host_data
28481.endd
28482which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
28483
28484.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
28485.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
28486.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
28487.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
28488.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
28489This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
28490part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
28491enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
28492result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
28493the next &%local_parts%& test.
28494
28495.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
28496.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
28497.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
28498.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
28499This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28500content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
28501viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28502
28503.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
28504.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
28505.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
28506This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28507content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28508&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
28509with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
28510&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28511
28512.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
28513.cindex "rate limiting"
28514This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
28515messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
28516
28517.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
28518.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
28519.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
28520.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
28521This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
28522recipient address against a list of recipients.
28523
28524.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
28525.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
28526.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
28527This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28528content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
28529non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
28530any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28531
28532.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28533.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
28534.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
28535.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
28536.vindex "&$domain$&"
28537.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
28538This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
28539domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
28540&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
28541of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
28542lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
28543RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
28544influence the sender checking.
28545
28546&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
28547relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
28548
28549.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
28550.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
28551.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
28552.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
28553This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
28554for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
28555.code
28556senders = :
28557.endd
28558&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
28559relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
28560
28561.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
28562.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
28563.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
28564This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28565content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
28566SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28567
28568.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
28569.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28570.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28571.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28572.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
28573.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
28574This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
28575certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
28576server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
28577or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28578
28579.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
28580.cindex "CSA verification"
28581This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
28582send email. Details of how this works are given in section
28583&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
28584
28585.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
28586.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28587.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28588.cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28589.cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
28590This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28591received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28592&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
28593there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
28594allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
28595
28596Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
28597problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
28598detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
28599
28600.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
28601.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28602.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
28603.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
28604.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
28605.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
28606This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28607received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28608&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
28609of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
28610is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
28611However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
28612that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
28613to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
28614might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
28615
28616Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
28617section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
28618&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
28619condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
28620.code
28621deny senders = :
28622 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
28623 !verify = header_sender
28624.endd
28625
28626.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
28627.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28628.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
28629.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
28630.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
28631This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28632received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28633&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
28634lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
28635and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
28636permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
28637&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
28638appropriate.
28639
28640Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
28641ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
28642.code
28643To: @
28644.endd
28645and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
28646common as they used to be.
28647
28648.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
28649.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28650.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
28651.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
28652.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
28653.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
28654.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
28655This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
28656client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
28657attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
28658condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
28659&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
28660independently of this condition.
28661
28662For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
28663option), this condition is always true.
28664
28665
28666.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
28667.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
28668.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
28669This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
28670Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
28671&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
28672case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
28673&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
28674used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
28675
28676There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
28677recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
28678
28679
28680.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
28681.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28682.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
28683.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
28684.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
28685.vindex "&$address_data$&"
28686This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
28687recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
28688&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
28689of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
28690This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
28691verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
28692address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
28693value for the child address.
28694
28695.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
28696.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28697.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
28698.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
28699This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
28700address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
28701was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
28702Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
28703one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
28704original IP address.
28705
28706If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
28707is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
28708
28709.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
28710.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28711.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
28712.cindex "sender" "verifying"
28713.cindex "verifying" "sender"
28714This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
28715message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
28716the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
28717condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
28718
28719.vindex "&$address_data$&"
28720.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
28721If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
28722value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
28723value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
28724statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
28725want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
28726
28727Details of verification are given later, starting at section
28728&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
28729to avoid doing it more than once per message.
28730
28731.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
28732.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28733This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
28734verified as a sender.
28735.endlist
28736
28737
28738
28739.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
28740.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28741.cindex "black list (DNS)"
28742.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28743In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
28744is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
28745address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
28746domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
28747special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
28748address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
28749.code
28750deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
28751 dialups.mail-abuse.org
28752.endd
28753the following records are looked up:
28754.code
2875543.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
2875643.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
28757.endd
28758As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
28759Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
28760to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
28761use two separate conditions:
28762.code
28763deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28764 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28765.endd
28766If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
28767behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
28768record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
28769processed.
28770
28771This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
28772(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
28773blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
28774following special items in the list:
28775.display
28776&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
28777&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
28778&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
28779.endd
28780.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
28781.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
28782.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
28783Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
28784.code
28785deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
28786.endd
28787Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
28788warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
28789.code
28790deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28791warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
28792 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28793.endd
28794DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
28795so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
28796connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
28797connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
28798
28799
28800
28801.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
28802.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
28803By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
28804of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
28805after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
28806.code
28807deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
28808.endd
28809This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
28810use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
28811MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
28812&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
28813
28814
28815
28816
28817.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
28818.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
28819There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
28820addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
28821&url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
28822with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
28823listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
28824.code
28825deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
28826 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28827.endd
28828This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
28829RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
28830example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
28831up by this example is
28832.code
28833tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
28834.endd
28835A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
28836addresses. For example:
28837.code
28838deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28839 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28840.endd
28841The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
28842name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
28843
28844
28845
28846
28847.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
28848.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
28849The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
28850names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
28851name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
28852As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
28853this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
28854either to double the separators like this:
28855.code
28856dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
28857.endd
28858or to change the separator character, like this:
28859.code
28860dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
28861.endd
28862If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
28863blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
28864occurs. Consider this condition:
28865.code
28866dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
28867.endd
28868The DNS lookups that occur are:
28869.code
288702.1.168.192.black.list.tld
28871a.domain.black.list.tld
28872.endd
28873Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
28874address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
28875are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
28876or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
28877only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
28878successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
28879error for a previous item.
28880
28881The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
28882syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
28883.code
28884dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
28885dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
28886.endd
28887However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
28888is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
28889.code
28890deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
28891 $sender_address_domain \
28892 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
28893 see $dnslist_text.
28894 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
28895 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
28896 $sender_address_domain} }} }
28897.endd
28898Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
28899multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
28900and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
28901of expanding the condition might be something like this:
28902.code
28903dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
28904.endd
28905Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
28906domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
28907
28908The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
28909&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
28910
28911
28912
28913
28914.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
28915.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
28916DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
28917just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
28918RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
28919The values used on the RBL+ list are:
28920.display
28921127.1.0.1 RBL
28922127.1.0.2 DUL
28923127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
28924127.1.0.4 RSS
28925127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
28926127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
28927127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
28928.endd
28929Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
28930different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
28931see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
28932
28933
28934.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
28935.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
28936.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
28937.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
28938.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
28939.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
28940.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
28941When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
28942the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
28943&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
28944(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
28945the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
28946&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
28947cases, for example:
28948.code
28949deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
28950.endd
28951the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
28952&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
28953For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
28954might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
28955.code
28956deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
28957.endd
28958If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
28959&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
28960
28961If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
28962addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
28963The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
28964record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
28965very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
28966information.
28967
28968You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
28969&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
28970expanded until after it has failed. For example:
28971.code
28972deny hosts = !+local_networks
28973 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
28974 at $dnslist_domain
28975 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
28976.endd
28977
28978
28979
28980.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
28981.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
28982You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
28983in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
28984For example,
28985.code
28986deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
28987.endd
28988rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
28989any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
28990that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
28991describes how multiple records are handled.
28992
28993More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
28994separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
28995&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
28996.code
28997deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28998.endd
28999If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29000addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29001first. For example:
29002.code
29003deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29004 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29005.endd
29006
29007If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29008listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29009In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29010true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29011tested. For example:
29012.code
29013dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29014.endd
29015matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29016want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29017being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29018.code
29019dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29020.endd
29021matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29022an odd number.
29023
29024
29025
29026.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29027You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29028condition. Whereas
29029.code
29030deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29031.endd
29032means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29033IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29034.code
29035deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29036.endd
29037means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29038IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29039words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29040the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29041
29042&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29043host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29044
29045If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29046previous example is precisely equivalent to
29047.code
29048deny dnslists = a.b.c
29049 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29050.endd
29051However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29052Consider this example:
29053.code
29054deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29055 list.dsbl.org : \
29056 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29057 relays.ordb.org
29058.endd
29059Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29060.code
29061deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29062 list.dsbl.org
29063deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29064 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29065deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29066.endd
29067which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29068
29069
29070
29071
29072.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29073A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29074thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29075is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29076the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29077the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29078.code
29079dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29080.endd
29081What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29082127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29083condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29084because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29085affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29086additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29087
29088.ilist
29089If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29090IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29091condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29092.next
29093If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29094looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29095changed to:
29096.code
29097dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29098.endd
29099and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29100false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29101.code
29102dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29103.endd
29104for the condition to be true.
29105.endlist
29106
29107When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29108the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29109.ilist
29110If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29111addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29112.code
29113dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29114.endd
29115If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29116false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29117.next
29118If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29119looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29120.code
29121dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29122.endd
29123If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29124true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29125.code
29126dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29127.endd
29128for the condition to be false.
29129.endlist
29130When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29131between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29132
29133
29134
29135
29136.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29137.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29138When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29139the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29140the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29141address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29142only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29143can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29144in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29145lists.
29146
29147A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29148two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29149do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29150If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29151restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29152a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29153domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29154.code
29155reject message = \
29156 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29157 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29158 dnslists = \
29159 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29160 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29161.endd
29162For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29163&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29164match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29165value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29166record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29167The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29168
29169If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29170given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29171the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29172.code
29173reject dnslists = \
29174 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29175 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29176 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29177 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29178.endd
29179In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29180values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29181done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29182
29183
29184
29185.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29186.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29187.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29188If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29189nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
291903ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29191.code
291921.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29193 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29194.endd
29195(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29196lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29197IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29198.code
29199*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29200.endd
29201is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29202Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29203
29204You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
29205&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
29206.code
29207deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
29208 dnslists = some.list.example
29209.endd
29210
29211If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
29212address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
29213(DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
29214.code
29215 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
29216.endd
29217
29218.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
29219.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
29220.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
29221.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
29222The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
29223which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
29224&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
29225commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
29226works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
29227host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
29228.display
29229&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
29230.endd
29231If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
29232period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
29233
29234As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
29235&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
29236configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
29237of &'p'&.
29238
29239The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
29240time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
29241means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
29242parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
29243send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
29244in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
29245constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
29246changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
29247both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
29248
29249There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
29250log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
29251when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
29252instructions when it is run with no arguments.
29253
29254The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
29255sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
29256retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
29257which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
29258By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
29259of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
29260user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
29261&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
29262example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
29263authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
29264
29265The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
29266rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
29267&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
29268ACL.
29269
29270Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
29271specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
29272or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
29273&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
29274using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
29275separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
29276
29277Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
29278any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
29279stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
29280remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
29281remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
29282behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
29283the &%count=%& option.
29284
29285
29286.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
29287.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
29288The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
29289normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
29290&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
29291
29292The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
29293the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
29294&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
29295&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
29296
29297The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
29298the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
29299in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
29300used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
29301in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
29302follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
29303in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
29304
29305The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
29306accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29307&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
29308&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
29309ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
29310in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
29311recipients as a large high-speed burst.
29312
29313The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
29314number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
29315last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
29316recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
29317&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
29318
29319The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
29320condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
29321command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
29322multiple different commands.
29323
29324The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
29325measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
29326&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
29327increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
29328other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
29329
29330The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
29331
29332
29333.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
29334.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
29335You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
29336control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
29337mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
29338
29339If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
29340previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
29341
29342For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
29343it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
29344can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
29345in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
29346new rate.
29347.code
29348acl_check_connect:
29349 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
29350 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29351 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29352# ...
29353acl_check_mail:
29354 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
29355 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29356 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29357.endd
29358
29359If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
29360processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
29361it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
29362in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
29363same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
29364multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
29365checks.
29366
29367The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
29368use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
29369update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
29370&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
29371next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
29372
29373
29374.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
29375.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
29376If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
29377engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
29378&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
29379counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
29380rest of the ACL.
29381
29382The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
29383updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
29384client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
29385the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
29386counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
29387email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
29388is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
29389For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
29390from getting any email through.
29391
29392The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
29393updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
29394of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
29395actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
29396counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
29397pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
29398again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
29399attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
29400.code
29401 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
29402.endd
29403
29404
29405.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
29406.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
29407The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
29408rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
29409mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
29410sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
29411&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
29412measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
29413options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
29414
29415For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
29416has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
29417rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
29418per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
29419go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
29420recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
29421
29422When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
29423&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
29424rate.
29425
29426The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
29427other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
29428unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
29429required increases with larger limits.
29430
29431The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
29432will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
29433the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
29434the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
29435events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
29436times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
29437throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
29438limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
29439are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
29440as intended.
29441
29442
29443.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
29444Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
29445when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
29446(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
29447policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
29448message. For example:
29449.code
29450# Log all senders' rates
29451warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
29452 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
29453
29454# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
29455# at the decimal point.
29456warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
29457 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
29458 $sender_rate_limit }s
29459
29460# Keep authenticated users under control
29461deny authenticated = *
29462 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
29463
29464# System-wide rate limit
29465defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
29466 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
29467
29468# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
29469# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
29470defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
29471 messages per $sender_rate_period
29472 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
29473 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
29474 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
29475.endd
29476&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
29477especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
29478bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
29479making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
29480RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
29481this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
29482hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
29483
29484
29485
29486.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
29487.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
29488.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
29489Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
29490&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
29491&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
29492The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
29493verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
29494other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
29495.code
29496verify = sender/callout
29497verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
29498.endd
29499The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
29500address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
29501difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
29502be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
29503(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
29504The available options are as follows:
29505
29506.ilist
29507If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
29508remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
29509check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
29510.next
29511If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
29512normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
29513options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
29514verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
29515.next
29516The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
29517discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
29518.next
29519The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
29520immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
29521generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
29522discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
29523.endlist
29524
29525.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
29526.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
29527.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
29528.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29529After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
29530error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
29531coding like this:
29532.code
29533warn !verify = sender
29534 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
29535.endd
29536If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
29537denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
29538verification failure.
29539
29540In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
29541appropriate) contains one of the following words:
29542
29543.ilist
29544&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
29545was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
29546.next
29547&%route%&: Routing failed.
29548.next
29549&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
29550occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
29551connection, HELO, or MAIL).
29552.next
29553&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
29554.next
29555&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
29556.endlist
29557
29558The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
29559rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
29560
29561
29562
29563
29564.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
29565.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
29566.cindex "callout" "verification"
29567.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
29568For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
29569checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
29570the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
29571&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
29572a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
29573address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
29574sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
29575deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
29576sender's domain.
29577
29578Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
29579request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
29580described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
29581lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
29582cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
29583caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
29584
29585Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
29586the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
29587callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
29588callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
29589on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
29590
29591If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
29592second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
29593one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
29594&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
29595router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
29596&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
29597&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
29598supplies a host list.
29599Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
29600
29601The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
29602remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
29603specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
29604specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
29605specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
29606the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
29607&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
29608
29609For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
29610test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
29611following SMTP commands are sent:
29612.display
29613&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
29614&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
29615&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
29616&`QUIT`&
29617.endd
29618LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
29619set to &"lmtp"&.
29620
29621The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
29622settings.
29623
29624A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
29625for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
29626the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
29627that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
29628do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
29629&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
29630
29631If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
29632succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
29633Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
29634hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
29635&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
29636
29637.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29638A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
29639output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
29640clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
29641disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
29642
29643
29644
29645
29646.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
29647.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
29648The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
29649optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
29650.code
29651verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
29652.endd
29653The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
29654separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
29655deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
29656
29657
29658.vlist
29659.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
29660.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
29661This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
29662For example:
29663.code
29664verify = sender/callout=5s
29665.endd
29666The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
29667remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
29668the &%connect%& parameter.
29669
29670
29671.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
29672.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
29673This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
29674for making the SMTP connection. For example:
29675.code
29676verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
29677.endd
29678If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
29679
29680.vitem &*defer_ok*&
29681.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
29682When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
29683of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
29684updated in this circumstance.
29685
29686.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
29687.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
29688This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
29689&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
29690accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
29691unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
29692
29693
29694.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29695.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
29696When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
29697verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
29698sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
29699whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
29700MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
29701as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
29702(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
29703address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
29704.code
29705require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
29706.endd
29707This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
29708
29709
29710.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
29711.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
29712This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
29713For example:
29714.code
29715verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
29716.endd
29717This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
29718commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
29719be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
29720very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
29721(for example, when network connections are timing out).
29722
29723
29724.vitem &*no_cache*&
29725.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
29726.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
29727When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
29728
29729.vitem &*postmaster*&
29730.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
29731When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
29732check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
29733rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
29734the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
29735used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
29736made, until the cache record expires.
29737
29738.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29739The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
29740You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
29741For example:
29742.code
29743require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
29744.endd
29745If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
29746one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
29747.code
29748require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
29749.endd
29750&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
29751account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
29752a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
29753postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
29754
29755
29756.vitem &*random*&
29757.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
29758When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
29759check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
29760really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
29761&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
29762.code
29763$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
29764.endd
29765The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
29766parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
29767specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
29768a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
29769succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
29770
29771.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
29772.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
29773This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29774.code
29775deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
29776.endd
29777.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29778It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
29779performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
29780that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
29781domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
29782
29783.vitem &*use_sender*&
29784This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29785.code
29786require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
29787.endd
29788It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
29789command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
29790need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
29791sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
29792usefulness of callout caching.
29793.endlist
29794
29795If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
29796command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
29797&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
29798usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
29799that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
29800Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
29801these circumstances.
29802
29803However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
29804host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
29805callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
29806sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
29807callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
29808own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
29809is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
29810
29811Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
29812caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
29813by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
29814actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
29815
29816
29817
29818
29819.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
29820.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
29821.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
29822.cindex "caching" "callout"
29823Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
29824used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
29825option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
29826different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
29827a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
29828entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
29829
29830When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
29831the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
29832is not available.
29833
29834The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
29835independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
29836(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
29837
29838If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
29839commands up to and including
29840.code
29841MAIL FROM:<>
29842.endd
29843(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
29844any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
29845domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
29846making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
29847separate expiry times for domain cache records:
29848&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
29849&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
29850
29851Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
29852cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
29853Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
29854ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
29855will eventually be noticed.
29856
29857The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
29858being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
29859behaviour will be the same.
29860
29861
29862
29863.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
29864.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
29865See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
29866verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
29867failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
29868relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
29869you might see:
29870.code
29871MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
29872250 OK
29873RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
29874550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
29875550-Called: 192.168.34.43
29876550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
29877550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
29878550 Sender verification failed
29879.endd
29880If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
29881only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
29882out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
29883&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
29884example:
29885.code
29886verify = sender/no_details
29887.endd
29888
29889.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
29890.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
29891.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
29892A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
29893during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
29894or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
29895it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
29896
29897.ilist
29898When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
29899continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
29900verification also fails.
29901.next
29902When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
29903verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
29904.endlist
29905
29906This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
29907way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
29908example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
29909.code
29910A.Wol: aw123
29911aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
29912.endd
29913work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
29914redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
29915mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
29916verification to succeed.
29917
29918It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
29919redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
29920generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
29921option. For example:
29922.code
29923require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
29924.endd
29925In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
29926the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
29927
29928When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
29929redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
29930also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
29931address and a report is output for each of them.
29932
29933
29934
29935.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
29936.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
29937Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
29938which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
29939special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
29940domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
29941Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
29942.code
29943verify = csa
29944.endd
29945This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
29946valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
29947succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
29948&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
29949&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
29950be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
29951
29952The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
29953detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
29954looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
29955address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
29956
29957.ilist
29958The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
29959.next
29960The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
29961.next
29962The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
29963(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
29964.next
29965The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
29966that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
29967.endlist
29968
29969The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
29970use for the DNS query. The default is:
29971.code
29972verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
29973.endd
29974This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
29975is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
29976address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
29977the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
29978meaningful to say:
29979.code
29980verify = csa/$sender_host_address
29981.endd
29982In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
29983This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
29984&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
29985
29986If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
29987is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
29988making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
29989using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
29990default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
29991default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
29992(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
29993of legitimate HELO domains.
29994
29995The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
29996direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
29997search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
29998addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
29999lookup such as:
30000.code
30001${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30002.endd
30003has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30004The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30005authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30006
30007
30008
30009
30010.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30011.cindex "BATV, verifying"
30012Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30013of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30014Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30015recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30016bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30017spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30018
30019There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30020&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30021the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30022address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30023item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30024The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30025&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30026
30027As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30028database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30029like this:
30030.code
30031PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30032 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30033 }{$value}}
30034.endd
30035Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30036list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30037use this:
30038.code
30039# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30040deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30041 senders = :
30042 recipients = +batv_senders
30043
30044# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30045deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30046 senders = :
30047 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30048 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30049 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30050.endd
30051The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30052to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30053send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30054recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30055the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30056
30057A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30058&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30059prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30060the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30061the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30062timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30063of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30064
30065There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30066you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30067deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30068router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30069.code
30070batv_redirect:
30071 driver = redirect
30072 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30073.endd
30074This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30075of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30076address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30077local addresses.
30078
30079To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30080can be used:
30081.code
30082external_smtp_batv:
30083 driver = smtp
30084 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30085 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30086 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30087 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30088 {$value}fail}}}
30089.endd
30090If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30091
30092
30093
30094.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30095.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30096.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30097.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30098An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30099delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30100within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30101passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30102.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30103but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30104
30105Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30106A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30107relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30108a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30109with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30110same host is fulfilling both functions,
30111. ///
30112. as illustrated in the diagram below,
30113. ///
30114but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30115not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30116system to arbitrary domains.
30117
30118
30119You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30120runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30121Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30122example, suppose you want to do the following:
30123
30124.ilist
30125Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30126locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30127&'my.dom2.example'&.
30128.next
30129Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30130These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30131.next
30132Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30133Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30134.endlist
30135
30136
30137In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30138.code
30139domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30140domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30141hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30142.endd
30143Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30144command:
30145.code
30146acl_check_rcpt:
30147 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30148 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30149.endd
30150The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30151the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30152statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30153hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30154than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30155default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30156in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30157
30158
30159
30160.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30161.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30162You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30163that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30164the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30165
30166For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30167&'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30168host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30169will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30170patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30171trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30172results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30173.ecindex IIDacl
30174
30175
30176
30177. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30178. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30179
30180.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30181.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30182The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30183as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30184was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30185maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30186specification.
30187
30188It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30189&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30190scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30191messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30192chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30193
30194If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30195Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30196&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30197
30198.ilist
30199Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30200for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30201.next
30202Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30203&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30204run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30205.next
30206An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30207of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30208.next
30209Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30210conditions.
30211.next
30212Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
30213.endlist
30214
30215There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
30216called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
30217condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
30218
30219Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
30220added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
30221changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
30222EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
30223this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
30224&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
30225
30226All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
30227temporarily created in a file called:
30228.display
30229<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
30230.endd
30231The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
30232expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
30233first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
30234scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
30235removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
30236.code
30237control = no_mbox_unspool
30238.endd
30239has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
30240same directory by default.
30241
30242
30243
30244.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
30245.cindex "virus scanning"
30246.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
30247.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
30248The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
30249It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
30250specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
30251in memory and thus are much faster.
30252
30253
30254.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
30255You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
30256file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
30257are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
30258.display
30259&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
30260.endd
30261If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
30262.code
30263av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
30264.endd
30265If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
30266before use.
30267The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
30268The following scanner types are supported in this release:
30269
30270.vlist
30271.vitem &%aveserver%&
30272.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30273This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
30274at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
30275which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
30276example:
30277.code
30278av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
30279.endd
30280
30281
30282.vitem &%clamd%&
30283.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
30284This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
30285&url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
30286unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
30287in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
30288required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
30289number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
30290.code
30291av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
30292av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
30293av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
30294av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
30295.endd
30296If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
30297keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
30298to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
30299more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
30300Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
30301There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
30302you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
30303
30304The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
30305randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
30306that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
30307socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
30308unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
30309When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
30310not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
30311selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
30312email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
30313.code
303142013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
30315 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
30316 (Connection refused)
30317.endd
30318
30319If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
30320contributing the code for this scanner.
30321
30322.vitem &%cmdline%&
30323.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
30324This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
30325used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
30326type takes 3 mandatory options:
30327
30328.olist
30329The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
30330and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
30331
30332.next
30333A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
30334virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
30335absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
30336the &"trigger"& expression.
30337
30338.next
30339Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
30340match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
30341&"name"& expression.
30342.endlist olist
30343
30344For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
30345.code
30346Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
30347.endd
30348For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
30349name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
30350for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
30351configuration setting:
30352.code
30353av_scanner = cmdline:\
30354 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
30355 found in file:'(.+)'
30356.endd
30357.vitem &%drweb%&
30358.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
30359The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
30360argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
30361separated by white space, as in these examples:
30362.code
30363av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
30364av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
30365.endd
30366If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
30367is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
30368
30369.vitem &%fsecure%&
30370.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
30371The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
30372argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
30373.code
30374av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
30375.endd
30376If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
30377Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
30378
30379.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
30380.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30381This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
30382Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
30383scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
30384For example:
30385.code
30386av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
30387.endd
30388The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
30389
30390.vitem &%mksd%&
30391.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
30392This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
30393parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
30394&url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
30395the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
30396provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
30397been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
30398.code
30399av_scanner = mksd:2
30400.endd
30401You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
30402
30403.vitem &%sock%&
30404.cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
30405This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
30406running on the local machine.
30407There are four options:
30408an address (which may be an IP addres and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
30409a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
30410the path to the mail file to be scanned),
30411an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
30412an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
30413For example:
30414.code
30415av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
30416.endd
30417Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
30418Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
30419Both regular-expressions are required.
30420
30421.vitem &%sophie%&
30422.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
30423Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
30424You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
30425for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
30426client communication. For example:
30427.code
30428av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
30429.endd
30430The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
30431the option.
30432.endlist
30433
30434When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
30435the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
30436ACL.
30437
30438The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
30439makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
30440The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
30441for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
30442However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
30443which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
30444message.
30445
30446The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
30447use. It can then be one of
30448
30449.ilist
30450&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
30451The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
30452recommended usage.
30453.next
30454&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
30455the condition fails immediately.
30456.next
30457A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
30458condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
30459expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
30460.endlist
30461
30462You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
30463even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
30464causes the ACL to defer.
30465
30466.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
30467When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
30468&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
30469&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
30470logging data.
30471
30472If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
30473use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
30474&%malware%& condition.
30475
30476Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
30477imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
30478
30479Here is a very simple scanning example:
30480.code
30481deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30482 demime = *
30483 malware = *
30484.endd
30485The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
30486.code
30487deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30488 demime = *
30489 malware = */defer_ok
30490.endd
30491The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
30492aveserver. It assumes you have set:
30493.code
30494av_scanner = $acl_m0
30495.endd
30496in the main Exim configuration.
30497.code
30498deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30499 set acl_m0 = sophie
30500 malware = *
30501
30502deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30503 set acl_m0 = aveserver
30504 malware = *
30505.endd
30506
30507
30508.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
30509.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
30510.cindex "spam scanning"
30511.cindex "SpamAssassin"
30512The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
30513score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
30514&url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
30515installation, you can use CPAN by running:
30516.code
30517perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
30518.endd
30519SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
30520documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
30521nicely, however.
30522
30523.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
30524After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
30525By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
30526port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
30527part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
30528.code
30529spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
30530.endd
30531You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
30532&%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
30533these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
30534address/port pair:
30535.code
30536spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
30537.endd
30538You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
30539reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
30540&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
30541option, separated with colons:
30542.code
30543spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
30544 192.168.2.11 783 : \
30545 192.168.2.12 783
30546.endd
30547Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
30548fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
30549servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
30550condition defers.
30551
30552&*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
30553multiple &%spamd%& servers.
30554
30555The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
30556a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
30557used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
30558expansion.
30559
30560.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
30561Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
30562.code
30563deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30564 spam = joe
30565.endd
30566The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
30567relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
30568to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
30569default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
30570However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
30571
30572The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
30573principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
30574have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
30575&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
30576read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
30577are not set.
30578
30579The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
30580you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
30581&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
30582
30583
30584Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
30585large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
30586are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
30587example:
30588.code
30589deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30590 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
30591 spam = nobody
30592.endd
30593
30594The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
30595SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
30596&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
30597it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
30598
30599.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
30600When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
30601variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
30602available for use at delivery time.
30603
30604.vlist
30605.vitem &$spam_score$&
30606The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
30607for inclusion in log or reject messages.
30608
30609.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
30610The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
30611example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
30612because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
30613The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
30614
30615.vitem &$spam_bar$&
30616A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
30617integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
30618&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
30619headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
30620
30621.vitem &$spam_report$&
30622A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
30623message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
30624.endlist
30625
30626The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
30627spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
30628does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
30629
30630The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
30631the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
30632failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
30633statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
30634spam condition, like this:
30635.code
30636deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30637 spam = joe/defer_ok
30638.endd
30639This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
30640
30641Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
30642condition:
30643.code
30644# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
30645warn spam = nobody:true
30646 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
30647 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
30648
30649# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
30650# is over threshold
30651warn spam = nobody
30652 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
30653
30654# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
30655deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
30656 spam = nobody:true
30657 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
30658.endd
30659
30660
30661
30662.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
30663.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
30664.cindex "MIME content scanning"
30665.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
30666.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
30667The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
30668each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
30669of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
30670specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
30671options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
30672cases.
30673
30674These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
30675ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
30676the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
30677message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
30678ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
30679result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
30680&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
30681
30682You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
30683only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
30684condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
30685&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
30686&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
30687
30688At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
30689information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
30690of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
30691parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
30692part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
30693syntax is:
30694.display
30695&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
30696.endd
30697The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
30698the value can be:
30699
30700.olist
30701&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
30702.next
30703The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
30704&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
30705a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
30706full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
30707.next
30708A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
30709directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
30710is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
30711the full path and file name.
30712.next
30713If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
30714filename, and the default path is then used.
30715.endlist
30716The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
30717errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
30718a file with its original, proposed filename using
30719.code
30720decode = $mime_filename
30721.endd
30722However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
30723anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
30724automatically unlinked.
30725
30726For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
30727content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
30728as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
30729variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
30730before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
30731
30732The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
30733used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
30734respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
30735
30736.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
30737The following list describes all expansion variables that are
30738available in the MIME ACL:
30739
30740.vlist
30741.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
30742If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
30743have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
30744has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
30745contains the empty string.
30746
30747.vitem &$mime_charset$&
30748This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
30749&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
30750.code
30751us-ascii
30752gb2312 (Chinese)
30753iso-8859-1
30754.endd
30755Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
30756case-insensitively.
30757
30758.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
30759This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
30760header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
30761implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
30762only used for display purposes.
30763
30764.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
30765This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
30766header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
30767
30768.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
30769This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
30770This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
30771
30772.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
30773This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30774successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
30775size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
30776has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
30777
30778.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
30779This variable contains the normalized content of the
30780&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
30781type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
30782
30783.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
30784If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
30785value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
30786are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
30787.code
30788text/plain
30789text/html
30790application/octet-stream
30791image/jpeg
30792audio/midi
30793.endd
30794If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
30795empty string.
30796
30797.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
30798This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30799successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
30800containing the decoded data.
30801.endlist
30802
30803.cindex "RFC 2047"
30804.vlist
30805.vitem &$mime_filename$&
30806This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
30807proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
30808&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
30809RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
30810found, this variable contains the empty string.
30811
30812.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
30813This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
30814attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
30815content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
30816
30817The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
30818cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
30819follows:
30820
30821.olist
30822The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
30823
30824.next
30825If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
30826so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
30827
30828.next
30829If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
30830and the rest are attachments.
30831
30832.next
30833All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
30834.endlist olist
30835
30836As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
30837alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
30838coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
30839.code
30840deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
30841!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
30842condition = $mime_is_coverletter
30843condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
30844.endd
30845.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
30846This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
30847&"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
30848Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
30849want to carry out specific actions on them.
30850
30851.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
30852This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
30853checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
30854decoding is fully recursive.
30855
30856.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
30857This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
30858starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
30859counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
30860&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
30861complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
30862parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
30863.endlist
30864
30865
30866
30867.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
30868.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
30869.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
30870You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
30871the message, or on individual MIME parts.
30872
30873The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
30874matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
30875MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
30876linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
30877have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
30878
30879The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
30880to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
30881part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
30882is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
30883and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
3088432K characters are checked.
30885
30886The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
30887literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
30888expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
30889with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
30890Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
30891.code
30892deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
30893 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
30894.endd
30895The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
30896&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
30897matching regular expression.
30898
30899&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
30900CPU-intensive.
30901
30902
30903
30904
30905.section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
30906.cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
30907.cindex "MIME content scanning"
30908The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
30909extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
30910&%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
30911ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
30912condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
30913the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
30914use the &%demime%& condition.
30915
30916The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
30917errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
30918against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
30919parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
30920scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
30921antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
30922
30923On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
30924colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
30925example:
30926.code
30927deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
30928 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
30929.endd
30930If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
30931false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
30932full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
30933the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
30934
30935The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
30936conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
30937zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
30938
30939The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
30940
30941.vlist
30942.vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
30943.vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
30944When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
30945severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
30946severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
30947zero, no error occurred.
30948
30949.vitem &$demime_reason$&
30950.vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
30951When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
30952human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
30953.endlist
30954
30955.vlist
30956.vitem &$found_extension$&
30957.vindex "&$found_extension$&"
30958When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
30959extension it found.
30960.endlist
30961
30962Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
30963the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
30964
30965If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
30966condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
30967right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
30968facility:
30969.code
30970# Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
30971deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
30972 demime = *
30973 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
30974
30975# Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
30976# Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
30977deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
30978 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
30979
30980# Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
30981# examine them and eventually thaw them.
30982deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
30983 demime = exe:doc
30984 control = freeze
30985.endd
30986.ecindex IIDcosca
30987
30988
30989
30990
30991. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30992. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30993
30994.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
30995 "Local scan function"
30996.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
30997.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
30998.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
30999In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
31000want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
31001
31002The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
31003passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
31004a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
31005condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
31006non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
31007
31008To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
31009possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
31010in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
31011can of course use a little C stub to call it.
31012
31013The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
31014when Exim is just about to accept the message.
31015It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
31016well as messages arriving via SMTP.
31017
31018Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
31019option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
31020Zero means &"no timeout"&.
31021Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
31022before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
31023are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
31024incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
31025For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31026code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31027
31028
31029
31030.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31031.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31032To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31033function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31034&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
31035directory, so you might set
31036.code
31037LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
31038.endd
31039for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
31040Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
31041be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
31042function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
31043commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
31044_src/local_scan.c_.
31045
31046If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
31047for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
31048.code
31049LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31050.endd
31051in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
31052
31053
31054
31055
31056.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
31057.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
31058You must include this line near the start of your code:
31059.code
31060#include "local_scan.h"
31061.endd
31062This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
31063prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
31064almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
31065for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
31066It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
31067strings and pointers to character strings:
31068.code
31069#define CS (char *)
31070#define CCS (const char *)
31071#define CSS (char **)
31072#define US (unsigned char *)
31073#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
31074#define USS (unsigned char **)
31075.endd
31076The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
31077.code
31078extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
31079.endd
31080The arguments are as follows:
31081
31082.ilist
31083&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
31084(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
31085recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
31086
31087The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
31088character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
31089id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
31090macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
31091case this changes in some future version.
31092.next
31093&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
31094string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
31095.endlist
31096
31097The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
31098
31099.vlist
31100.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
31101.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
31102The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
31103the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
31104newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
31105maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
31106
31107.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
31108This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31109queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
31110
31111.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
31112This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31113queued without immediate delivery.
31114
31115.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
31116The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
31117passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
31118they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
31119&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
31120used.
31121
31122.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
31123The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
31124message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
31125problem"& is used.
31126
31127.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31128This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
31129message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
31130&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
31131&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
31132&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
31133same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31134
31135.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31136This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
31137LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31138.endlist
31139
31140If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
31141reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
31142&%-oe%& command line options.
31143
31144
31145
31146.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
31147.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
31148It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
31149that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
31150want to do this, you must have the line
31151.code
31152LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31153.endd
31154in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
31155&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
31156file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
31157to define them.
31158
31159The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
31160&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
31161and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
31162alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
31163variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
31164entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
31165.code
31166static int my_integer_option = 42;
31167static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
31168
31169optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
31170 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
31171 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
31172};
31173
31174int local_scan_options_count =
31175 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
31176.endd
31177The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
31178configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
31179.code
31180begin local_scan
31181my_integer = 99
31182my_string = some string of text...
31183.endd
31184The available types of option data are as follows:
31185
31186.vlist
31187.vitem &*opt_bool*&
31188This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
31189variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
31190that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
31191whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
31192TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
31193values.)
31194
31195.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
31196This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
31197The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
31198multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
31199
31200.vitem &*opt_int*&
31201This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
31202&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
31203Exim.
31204
31205.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
31206This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
31207&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
31208printed with the suffix K or M.
31209
31210.vitem &*opt_octint*&
31211This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
31212octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
31213always output in octal.
31214
31215.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
31216This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
31217variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
31218
31219.vitem &*opt_time*&
31220This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
31221type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
31222.endlist
31223
31224If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
31225out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
31226
31227
31228
31229.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
31230.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
31231The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
31232are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
31233Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
31234including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
31235C variables are as follows:
31236
31237.vlist
31238.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
31239This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
31240
31241.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
31242This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
31243
31244.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
31245This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
31246is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
31247&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
31248
31249.ilist
31250The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
31251testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
31252other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
31253
31254.next
31255The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
31256by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
31257of debugging bits.
31258.endlist ilist
31259
31260Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
31261selected, you should use code like this:
31262.code
31263if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31264 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31265.endd
31266.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
31267After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
31268variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
31269
31270.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
31271A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
31272discussed below.
31273
31274.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
31275A pointer to the last of the header lines.
31276
31277.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
31278The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
31279
31280.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
31281This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
31282&%-bh%& command line option.
31283
31284.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
31285The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
31286is NULL for locally submitted messages.
31287
31288.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
31289The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
31290command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
31291specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
31292
31293.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
31294This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
31295&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
31296
31297.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
31298The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
31299
31300.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
31301The number of accepted recipients.
31302
31303.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
31304.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
31305.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
31306The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
31307&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
31308can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
31309below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
31310adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
31311&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
31312value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
31313blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
31314and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
31315
31316.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
31317The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
31318
31319.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
31320The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
31321locally-submitted messages.
31322
31323.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
31324The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
31325was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
31326
31327.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
31328The name of the sending host, if known.
31329
31330.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
31331The port on the sending host.
31332
31333.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
31334This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
31335
31336.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
31337This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
31338
31339.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
31340The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
31341requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
31342.endlist
31343
31344
31345.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
31346The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
31347You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
31348(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
31349their type to *.
31350
31351
31352.vlist
31353.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
31354A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
31355
31356.vitem &*int&~type*&
31357A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
31358characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
31359Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
31360with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
31361rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
31362lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
31363
31364.vitem &*int&~slen*&
31365The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
31366internal newlines.
31367
31368.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
31369A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
31370a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
31371.endlist
31372
31373
31374
31375.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
31376The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
31377
31378.vlist
31379.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
31380This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
31381
31382.vitem &*int&~pno*&
31383This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
31384the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
31385and must always contain -1 at this stage.
31386
31387.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
31388If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
31389recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
31390envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
31391router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
31392an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
31393&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
31394is NULL for all recipients.
31395.endlist
31396
31397
31398
31399.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
31400.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
31401The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
31402These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
31403release:
31404
31405.vlist
31406.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
31407 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
31408
31409This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
31410&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
31411be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
31412for the process in &%newumask%&.
31413
31414Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
31415and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
31416standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
31417descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
31418argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
31419
31420The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
31421
31422.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
31423This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
31424seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
31425return value is as follows:
31426
31427.ilist
31428>= 0
31429
31430The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
31431ending status.
31432
31433.next
31434< 0 and > &--256
31435
31436The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
31437signal number.
31438
31439.next
31440&--256
31441
31442The process timed out.
31443.next
31444&--257
31445
31446The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
31447.endlist
31448
31449.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
31450This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
31451Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
31452want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
31453forks a subprocess that is running
31454.code
31455exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
31456.endd
31457and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
31458that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
31459of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
31460recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
31461
31462When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
31463finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
31464fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
31465addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
31466
31467
31468.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
31469 *sender_authentication)*&
31470This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
31471that it runs is:
31472.display
31473&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
31474.endd
31475The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
31476
31477
31478.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
31479This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
31480output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
31481calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
31482conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
31483.code
31484if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31485 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31486.endd
31487
31488.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
31489This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
31490expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
31491The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
31492expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
31493the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
31494block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
31495&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
31496
31497.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
31498This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
31499existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
31500character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
31501substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
31502if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
31503
31504.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
31505 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
31506This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
31507chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
31508
31509If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
31510&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
31511NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
31512matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
31513&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
31514found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
31515marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
31516option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
31517top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
31518headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
31519.code
31520header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
31521 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
31522.endd
31523Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
31524there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
31525
31526
31527.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
31528This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
31529occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
31530particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
31531match the specification, the function does nothing.
31532
31533
31534.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
31535 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
31536This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
31537a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
31538colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
31539&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
31540.code
31541if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
31542.endd
31543.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
31544.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
31545This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
31546The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
31547back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
31548zero-terminated.
31549
31550.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
31551This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
31552zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
31553to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
31554string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
31555yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
31556easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
31557added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
31558
31559.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
31560This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
31561matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
31562.display
31563&`OK `& match succeeded
31564&`FAIL `& match failed
31565&`DEFER `& match deferred
31566.endd
31567DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
31568inability to contact a database.
31569
31570.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
31571 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
31572This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
31573controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
31574&'lss_match_domain()'&.
31575
31576.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
31577 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
31578This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
31579controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
31580matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
31581
31582.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
31583 uschar&~*list)*&"
31584This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
31585expected to be
31586.code
31587lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
31588.endd
31589.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
31590An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
31591is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
31592looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
31593values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
31594returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
31595failed.
31596
31597.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
31598 *format,&~...)*&"
31599This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
31600is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
31601&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
31602them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
31603arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
31604contain any newlines, not even at the end.
31605
31606
31607.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
31608This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
31609is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
31610with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
31611
31612This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
31613described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
31614the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
31615value afterwards. For example:
31616.code
31617 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
31618 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
31619 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
31620.endd
31621
31622.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
31623This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
31624recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
31625matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
31626address.
31627.endlist
31628
31629
31630.cindex "RFC 2047"
31631.vlist
31632.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
31633 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
31634This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
31635these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
31636from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
31637a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
31638made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
31639binary string is returned with an error message.
31640
31641The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
31642maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
31643encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
31644
31645.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
31646.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
31647If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
31648contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
31649not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
31650
31651The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
31652&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
31653which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
31654
31655If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
31656argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
31657set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
31658returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
31659with translation.
31660
31661
31662.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
31663This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
31664below.
31665
31666.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
31667The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
31668output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
31669stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
31670SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
31671is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
31672opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
31673test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
31674is involved.
31675
31676If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
31677output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
31678
31679Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
31680must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
31681LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
31682LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
31683initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
31684to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
31685that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
31686.code
31687smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
31688return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
31689.endd
31690Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
31691the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
31692&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
31693multiple output lines.
31694
31695The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
31696does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
31697the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
31698detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
31699you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
31700dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
31701arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
31702is an error.
31703
31704.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
31705This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
31706chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
31707runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31708
31709.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
31710This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
31711permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31712
31713.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
31714See below.
31715
31716.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
31717See below.
31718
31719.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
31720These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
31721The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
31722number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
31723and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
31724pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
31725more discussion.
31726.endlist
31727
31728
31729
31730.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
31731.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
31732No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
31733The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
31734recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
31735to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
31736message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
31737terminates.
31738
31739Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
31740data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
31741connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
31742one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
31743
31744If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
31745in the same SMTP connection, you should set
31746.code
31747store_pool = POOL_PERM
31748.endd
31749before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
31750restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
31751the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
31752set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
31753
31754The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
31755&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
31756There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
31757block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
31758&%store_pool%&.
31759.ecindex IIDlosca
31760
31761
31762
31763
31764. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31765. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31766
31767.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
31768.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
31769.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
31770.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
31771The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
31772that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
31773also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
31774they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
31775
31776The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
31777is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
31778It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
31779commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
31780The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
31781
31782The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
31783is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
31784the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
31785If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
31786of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
31787prevent it happening on retries.
31788
31789.vindex "&$domain$&"
31790.vindex "&$local_part$&"
31791&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
31792specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
31793&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
31794you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
31795independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
31796described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
31797
31798
31799.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
31800.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
31801.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
31802The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
31803setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
31804other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
31805&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
31806.code
31807system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
31808system_filter_user = exim
31809.endd
31810If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
31811&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
31812specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
31813&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
31814&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
31815by the &%reply%& command.
31816
31817
31818.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
31819You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
31820filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
31821are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
31822
31823If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
31824you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
31825
31826
31827
31828.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
31829The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
31830files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
31831mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
31832available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
31833If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
31834they cause errors.
31835
31836.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
31837There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
31838files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
31839is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
31840&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
31841subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
31842manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
31843
31844&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
31845specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
31846succeed, it will not be tried again.
31847If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
31848arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
31849
31850When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
31851&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
31852users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
31853to which users' filter files can refer.
31854
31855
31856
31857.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
31858.vindex "&$recipients$&"
31859The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
31860of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
31861filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
31862
31863
31864
31865.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
31866.cindex "freezing messages"
31867.cindex "message" "freezing"
31868.cindex "message" "forced failure"
31869.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
31870.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
31871.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
31872There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
31873always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
31874filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
31875for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
31876word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
31877.code
31878fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
31879.endd
31880The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
31881
31882The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
31883message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
31884and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
31885delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
31886that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
31887run.
31888
31889The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
31890not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
31891filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
31892is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
31893
31894.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
31895.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
31896The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
31897well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
31898up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
31899log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
31900two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
31901strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
31902message. For example:
31903.code
31904fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
31905 because it contains attachments that we are \
31906 not prepared to receive."
31907.endd
31908
31909.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
31910Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
31911the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
31912the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
31913command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
31914Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
31915use, for example
31916.code
31917if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
31918then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
31919.endd
31920though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
31921alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
31922generated by the filter.
31923
31924The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
31925&%defer%&,
31926&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
31927set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
31928as
31929.code
31930mail ...
31931freeze
31932.endd
31933to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
31934failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
31935take place.
31936
31937
31938
31939.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
31940.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
31941.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
31942.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
31943Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
31944.code
31945headers add <string>
31946headers remove <string>
31947.endd
31948The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
31949added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
31950filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
31951space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
31952forced to fail, the command has no effect.
31953
31954You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
31955continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
31956including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
31957example:
31958.code
31959headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
31960 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
31961 X-header-2: ...."
31962.endd
31963Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
31964be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
31965space after input continuations is ignored.
31966
31967The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
31968This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
31969those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
31970&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
31971header with the same name, they are all removed.
31972
31973The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
31974of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
31975from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
31976modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
31977Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
31978used for all recipients of the message.
31979
31980During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
31981header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
31982that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
31983routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
31984routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
31985until the message is actually being written (see section
31986&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
31987
31988If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
31989added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
31990present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
31991present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
31992message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
31993conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
31994modified more than once.
31995
31996Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
31997use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
31998For example:
31999.code
32000headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
32001headers remove "Subject"
32002headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
32003headers remove "Old-Subject"
32004.endd
32005
32006
32007
32008.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
32009.cindex "envelope sender"
32010In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
32011.code
32012errors_to <some address>
32013.endd
32014in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
32015delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
32016user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
32017might use
32018.code
32019unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
32020.endd
32021to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
32022address if its delivery failed.
32023
32024
32025
32026.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32027.vindex "&$domain$&"
32028.vindex "&$local_part$&"
32029In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32030delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32031operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32032such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32033filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32034which implements such a filter:
32035.code
32036central_filter:
32037 check_local_user
32038 driver = redirect
32039 domains = +local_domains
32040 file = /central/filters/$local_part
32041 no_verify
32042 allow_filter
32043 allow_freeze
32044.endd
32045The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
32046&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
32047the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
32048use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
32049
32050Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
32051specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
32052its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
32053address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
32054normal way.
32055.ecindex IIDsysfil1
32056.ecindex IIDsysfil2
32057.ecindex IIDsysfil3
32058
32059
32060
32061
32062
32063
32064. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32065. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32066
32067.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
32068.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
32069Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
32070all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
32071these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
32072this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
32073removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
32074before it is placed on Exim's queue.
32075
32076Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
32077&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
32078that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
32079its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
32080set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
32081
32082&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
32083or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
32084loopback interface specially in any way.
32085
32086If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
32087that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
32088
32089
32090
32091
32092.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
32093.cindex "message" "submission"
32094.cindex "submission mode"
32095Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
32096&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
32097received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
32098state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
32099.code
32100control = submission
32101.endd
32102in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
32103&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
32104a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
32105known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
32106example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
32107interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
32108.code
32109warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
32110 control = submission
32111.endd
32112.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
32113There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
32114is used to separate options. For example:
32115.code
32116control = submission/sender_retain
32117.endd
32118Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
32119true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
32120of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
32121the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
32122authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
32123&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
32124attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
32125
32126When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
32127domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
32128example:
32129.code
32130control = submission/domain=some.domain
32131.endd
32132The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
32133&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
32134that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
32135&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
32136.code
32137accept authenticated = *
32138 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
32139 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
32140 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
32141.endd
32142Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
32143option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
32144the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
32145.code
32146bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
32147.endd
32148then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
32149line would be:
32150.code
32151Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
32152.endd
32153.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
32154By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
32155used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
32156specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
32157
32158&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
32159ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
32160untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
32161specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
32162does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
32163spoof another's address.
32164
32165.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
32166.cindex "line endings"
32167.cindex "carriage return"
32168.cindex "linefeed"
32169RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
32170linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
32171SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
32172conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
32173use CRLF or just CR.
32174
32175Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
32176using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
32177receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
32178Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
32179MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
32180has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
32181that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
32182other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
32183follows:
32184
32185.ilist
32186LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
32187.next
32188CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
32189is ignored.
32190.next
32191The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
32192nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
32193terminator.
32194.next
32195If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
32196the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
32197is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
32198people trying to play silly games.
32199.next
32200If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
32201bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
32202line.
32203.endlist
32204
32205
32206
32207
32208
32209.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
32210.cindex "unqualified addresses"
32211.cindex "address" "qualification"
32212By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
32213host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
32214SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
32215messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
32216requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
32217
32218Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
32219sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
32220&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
32221cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
32222value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
32223
32224.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
32225.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
32226Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
32227that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
32228line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
32229are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
32230other words, such qualification is also controlled by
32231&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
32232
32233
32234
32235
32236.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
32237.cindex "&""From""& line"
32238.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
32239.cindex "sender" "address"
32240.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
32241.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
32242.cindex "envelope sender"
32243.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32244Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
32245with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
32246&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
32247.code
32248From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
32249From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
32250.endd
32251This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
32252Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
32253via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
32254such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
32255&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
32256and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
32257regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
32258default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
32259that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
32260
32261.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
32262When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
32263a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
32264contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
32265then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
32266qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
32267the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
32268
32269If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
32270sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
32271that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
32272
32273Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
32274treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
32275as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
32276incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
32277
32278
32279
32280.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
32281.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
32282RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
32283&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
32284recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
32285&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
32286&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
32287
32288.blockquote
32289&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
32290processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
32291.endblockquote
32292
32293This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
32294address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
32295follows:
32296
32297.ilist
32298A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
32299is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
32300.next
32301If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
32302&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
32303&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
32304.next
32305For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
32306also removed.
32307.next
32308For a locally-submitted message,
32309if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
32310&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
32311the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
32312included in log lines in this case.
32313.next
32314The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
32315&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
32316.endlist
32317
32318
32319
32320
32321.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
32322Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
32323includes the header line:
32324.code
32325Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
32326.endd
32327
32328.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
32329.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
32330If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
32331message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
32332extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
32333existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
32334
32335
32336.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
32337.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
32338If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
32339Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
32340&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
32341
32342.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
32343.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
32344.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
32345&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
32346set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
32347the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
32348in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
32349set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
32350messages.
32351
32352
32353.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
32354.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
32355.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
32356&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
32357Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
32358generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
32359messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
32360(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
32361messages.
32362
32363
32364.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
32365.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
32366.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32367.cindex "message" "submission"
32368.cindex "submission mode"
32369If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
32370adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
32371
32372.ilist
32373The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
32374message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
32375.next
32376.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
32377The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
32378.olist
32379.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32380If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
32381&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
32382.next
32383If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
32384part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
32385.next
32386If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
32387&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
32388.endlist
32389.endlist
32390
32391A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
32392
32393If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
32394line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
32395containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
32396are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
32397They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
32398&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
32399&%qualify_domain%&.
32400
32401For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
32402&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
32403user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
32404name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
32405
32406
32407.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
32408.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
32409.cindex "message" "submission"
32410.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
32411If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
32412&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
32413&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
32414to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
32415creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
32416message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
32417followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
32418in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
32419&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
32420
32421
32422.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
32423.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
32424A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
32425contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
32426Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
32427
32428The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
32429have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
32430line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
32431that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
32432
32433Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
32434changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
32435-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
32436
32437
32438.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
32439.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
32440Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
32441header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
32442section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
32443header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
32444responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
32445processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
32446than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
32447incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3244811 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
32449
32450
32451
32452.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
32453.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
32454.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
32455&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
32456it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
32457transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
32458transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
32459default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
32460
32461
32462
32463.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
32464.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
32465.cindex "message" "submission"
32466For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
32467existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
32468these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
32469&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
32470control setting.
32471
32472When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
32473&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
32474control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
32475&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
32476that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
32477&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
32478be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
32479appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
32480line is added to the message.
32481
32482If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
32483the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
32484&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
32485options true at the same time.
32486
32487.cindex "submission mode"
32488By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
32489received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
32490a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
32491not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
32492
32493.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
32494First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
32495authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
32496created as follows:
32497
32498.ilist
32499.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32500If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
32501&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
32502.next
32503If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
32504is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
32505.next
32506If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
32507&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
32508.endlist
32509
32510This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
32511are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
32512added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
32513by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
32514
32515.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
32516&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
32517the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
32518except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
32519
32520
32521
32522.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
32523 "SECTheadersaddrem"
32524.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
32525.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
32526When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
32527specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
32528process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
32529modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
32530as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
32531
32532In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
32533specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
32534addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
32535changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
32536transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
32537they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
32538
32539&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
32540the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
32541expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
32542
32543For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
32544option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
32545newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
32546.code
32547headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
32548 X-added-second: another added header line
32549.endd
32550Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
32551
32552Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
32553specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
32554Each header-line is separately expanded.
32555
32556The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
32557list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
32558often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
32559not part of the names. For example:
32560.code
32561headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
32562.endd
32563
32564Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
32565specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
32566Each item is separately expanded.
32567Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
32568form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
32569will act as list separators.
32570
32571When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
32572items are expanded at routing time,
32573and then associated with all addresses that are
32574accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
32575an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
32576forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
32577
32578.oindex "&%unseen%&"
32579However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
32580the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
32581&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
32582
32583Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
32584settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
32585dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
32586requirements.
32587
32588The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
32589with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
32590these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
32591recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
32592consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
32593names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
32594instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
32595
32596After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
32597lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
32598the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
32599header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
32600
32601This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
32602the following consequences:
32603
32604.ilist
32605The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
32606remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
32607to it, at all times.
32608.next
32609Header lines that are added by a router's
32610&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
32611expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
32612.next
32613Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
32614in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
32615.next
32616Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
32617a later router or by a transport.
32618.next
32619An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
32620removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
32621.code
32622headers_remove = subject
32623headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
32624.endd
32625.endlist
32626
32627&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
32628for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
32629
32630
32631
32632
32633
32634.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
32635.cindex "address" "constructed"
32636.cindex "constructed address"
32637When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
32638the form
32639.display
32640<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
32641.endd
32642For example:
32643.code
32644Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
32645.endd
32646The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
32647otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
32648&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
32649ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
32650upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
32651&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
32652The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
32653there is no password file entry.
32654
32655.cindex "RFC 2047"
32656In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
32657parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
32658characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
32659including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
32660&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
32661characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
32662&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
32663is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
32664
32665
32666
32667.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
32668.cindex "case of local parts"
32669.cindex "local part" "case of"
32670RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
32671be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
32672addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
32673because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
32674routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
32675original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
32676router option.
32677
32678.cindex "mixed-case login names"
32679If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
32680assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
32681your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
32682correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
32683.code
32684correct_case:
32685 driver = redirect
32686 domains = +local_domains
32687 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
32688 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
32689 @$domain
32690.endd
32691For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
32692(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
32693up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
32694on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
32695local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
32696
32697
32698
32699.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
32700.cindex "dot" "in local part"
32701.cindex "local part" "dots in"
32702RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
32703part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
32704middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
32705empty components for compatibility.
32706
32707
32708
32709.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
32710.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
32711Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
32712happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
32713in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
32714&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
32715
32716Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
32717in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
32718routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
32719example, a header such as
32720.code
32721To: hare@teaparty
32722.endd
32723might get rewritten as
32724.code
32725To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
32726.endd
32727Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
32728does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
32729been routed.
32730
32731Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
32732addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
32733result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
32734deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
32735immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
32736routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
32737.ecindex IIDmesproc
32738
32739
32740
32741. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32742. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32743
32744.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
32745.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
32746.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
32747Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
32748LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
32749closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
32750processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
32751
32752.ilist
32753SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
32754.next
32755SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
32756.next
32757Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
32758.endlist
32759
32760For mail delivery, the following are available:
32761
32762.ilist
32763SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
32764.next
32765LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
32766&"lmtp"&);
32767.next
32768LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
32769transport);
32770.next
32771Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
32772the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
32773.endlist
32774
32775&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
32776stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
32777used to contain the envelope information.
32778
32779
32780
32781.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
32782.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
32783.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
32784.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
32785.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
32786.cindex "EHLO"
32787.cindex "HELO"
32788.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
32789Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
32790The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
32791processing is the same in both cases.
32792
32793If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
32794parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
32795command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
32796&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
32797such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
32798.cindex "transport" "filter"
32799.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
32800transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
32801suppressed.
32802
32803If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
32804pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
32805required for the transaction.
32806
32807If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
32808was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
32809server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
32810Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
32811is called for verification.
32812
32813If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
32814the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
32815in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
32816
32817.cindex "carriage return"
32818.cindex "linefeed"
32819Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
32820LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
32821order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
32822line terminator.
32823
32824If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
32825characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
32826same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
32827even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
32828of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
32829they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
32830each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
32831in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
32832significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
32833
32834When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
32835message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
32836records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
32837particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
32838
32839.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
32840Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
32841a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
32842See the next section for more detail about error handling.
32843
32844.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
32845.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
32846When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
32847looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
32848messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
32849creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
32850a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
32851so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
32852does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
32853turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
32854
32855The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
32856limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
32857
32858.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32859The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
32860identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
32861square bracket of the IP address.
32862
32863
32864
32865
32866.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
32867.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
32868.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
32869.cindex "host" "error"
32870Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
32871message errors, and recipient errors.
32872
32873.vlist
32874.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
32875A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
32876particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
32877
32878.ilist
32879Connection refused or timed out,
32880.next
32881Any error response code on connection,
32882.next
32883Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
32884.next
32885Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
32886.next
32887I/O errors at any time,
32888.next
32889Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
32890the &"."& at the end of the data.
32891.endlist ilist
32892
32893For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
32894EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
32895error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
32896host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
32897the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
32898alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
32899host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
32900made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
32901
32902.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
32903.cindex "message" "error"
32904A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
32905particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
32906message errors are:
32907
32908.ilist
32909Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
32910the data,
32911.next
32912Timeout after MAIL,
32913.next
32914Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
32915timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
32916connection at any other time.
32917.endlist ilist
32918
32919For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
32920to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
32921temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
32922addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
32923a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
32924message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
32925that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
32926time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
32927affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
32928it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
32929
32930If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
32931to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
32932over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
32933response to MAIL.
32934
32935.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
32936.cindex "recipient" "error"
32937A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
32938recipient errors are:
32939
32940.ilist
32941Any error response to RCPT,
32942.next
32943Timeout after RCPT.
32944.endlist
32945
32946For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
32947recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
32948sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
32949address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
32950used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
32951routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
32952operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
32953to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
32954if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
32955(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
32956have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
32957the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
32958the retry clock is reset.
32959
32960The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
32961host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
32962other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
32963in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
32964proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
32965than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
32966if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
32967through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
32968recipient's retry time.
32969.endlist
32970
32971In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
32972current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
32973tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
32974own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
32975until the next delivery attempt.
32976
32977Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
32978MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
32979would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
32980host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
32981What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
32982is created.
32983
32984The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
32985these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
32986procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
32987response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
32988it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
32989message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
32990helpful to treat this case as a message error.
32991
32992Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
32993host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
32994or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
32995the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
32996then to be treated as a host error.
32997
32998There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
32999terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
33000reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
33001should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
33002host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
33003
33004
33005
33006
33007.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
33008.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
33009.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
33010.cindex "inetd"
33011.cindex "daemon"
33012Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
33013listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
33014&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
33015.code
33016smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
33017.endd
33018Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
33019agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
33020a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
33021the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
33022with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
33023stream and exits with an error code.
33024
33025By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33026disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33027unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33028&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33029
33030.cindex "carriage return"
33031.cindex "linefeed"
33032Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33033LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33034order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33035line terminator.
33036Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
33037sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
33038sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
33039
33040.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
33041.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
33042One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
33043HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
33044commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
33045the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
33046Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
33047match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
33048
33049.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33050.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
33051The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
33052a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
33053&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
33054false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
33055&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
33056value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
33057message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
33058
33059When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
33060its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
33061logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
33062
33063The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
33064prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
33065number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
33066&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
33067rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
33068
33069The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
33070subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
33071for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
33072things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
33073processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
33074sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
33075it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
33076
33077When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
33078and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
33079high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
33080&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
33081applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
33082
33083Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
33084can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
33085&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
33086number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
33087SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
33088&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
33089subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
33090a delivery process.
33091
33092The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
33093&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
33094started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
33095handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
33096however, available with &'inetd'&.
33097
33098Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
33099are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
33100to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
33101section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
33102
33103Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
33104MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
33105&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
33106
33107
33108
33109.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
33110.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
33111If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
33112commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
33113the error response to the last command. The default value for
33114&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
33115abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
33116circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
33117
33118
33119.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
33120.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
33121.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
33122A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
33123something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
33124address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
33125sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
33126&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
33127drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
33128default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
33129broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
33130
33131
33132
33133.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
33134.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
33135The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
33136DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
33137many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
33138denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
33139client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
33140defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
33141
33142When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
33143allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
33144but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
33145or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
33146starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
33147counted.
33148
33149The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
33150STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
33151RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
33152
33153You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
33154&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
33155&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
33156the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
33157specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
33158
33159
33160
33161
33162.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
33163When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
33164runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
33165appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
33166If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33167
33168.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
33169When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
33170called with the &%-bv%& option.
33171
33172.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
33173When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
33174EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
33175than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
33176as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
33177of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
33178VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
33179RCPT failures.
33180
33181
33182
33183.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
33184.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
33185RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
33186overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
33187disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
33188the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
33189should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33190
33191The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
33192delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
33193the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
33194text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
33195specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
33196the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
33197argument. For example,
33198.code
33199ETRN #brigadoon
33200.endd
33201runs the command
33202.code
33203exim -R brigadoon
33204.endd
33205which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
33206containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
33207default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
33208for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
33209a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
33210
33211.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
33212Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
33213record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
33214the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
33215the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
33216a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
33217left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
33218Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
33219
33220.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
33221For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
33222used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
33223whatever the form of its argument. For
33224example:
33225.code
33226smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
33227 $sender_host_address
33228.endd
33229.vindex "&$domain$&"
33230The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
33231expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
33232and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
33233wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
33234under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
33235for it to change them before running the command.
33236
33237
33238
33239.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
33240.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
33241Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
33242standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
33243line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
33244&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
33245messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
33246sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
33247an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
33248identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
33249runs for RCPT commands:
33250.code
33251accept hosts = :
33252.endd
33253This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
33254
33255
33256
33257.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
33258.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
33259.cindex "batched SMTP output"
33260Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
33261batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
33262be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
33263delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
33264envelope along with the message.
33265
33266The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
33267MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
33268the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
33269HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
33270can be used to specify it.
33271
33272Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
33273one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
33274to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
33275this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
33276chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
33277
33278.vindex "&$host$&"
33279When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
33280sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
33281transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
33282router:
33283.code
33284begin routers
33285route_append:
33286 driver = manualroute
33287 transport = smtp_appendfile
33288 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
33289
33290begin transports
33291smtp_appendfile:
33292 driver = appendfile
33293 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
33294 batch_max = 1000
33295 use_bsmtp
33296 user = exim
33297.endd
33298This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
33299format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
33300message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
33301
33302
33303
33304.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
33305.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
33306.cindex "batched SMTP input"
33307The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
33308reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
33309is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
33310sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
33311rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
33312and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
33313as NOOP; QUIT quits.
33314
33315Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
33316ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
33317
33318If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
33319the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
33320standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
33321make some use of automatically, for example:
33322.code
33323554 Unexpected end of file
33324Transaction started in line 10
33325Error detected in line 14
33326.endd
33327It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
33328file, for example:
33329.code
33330An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
33331The error message was:
33332
33333501 '>' missing at end of address
33334
33335The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
33336The error was detected in line 12.
33337The SMTP command at fault was:
33338
33339rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
33340
333411 previous message was successfully processed.
33342The rest of the batch was abandoned.
33343.endd
33344The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
33345messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
33346accepted.
33347.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
33348.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
33349
33350
33351
33352. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33353. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33354
33355.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
33356 "Customizing messages"
33357When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
33358configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
33359to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
33360the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
33361string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
33362
33363The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
33364cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
33365option. Exim also adds the line
33366.code
33367Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
33368.endd
33369to all warning and bounce messages,
33370
33371
33372.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
33373.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
33374.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
33375If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
33376message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
33377delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
33378&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
33379
33380When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
33381constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
33382separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
33383opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
33384logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
33385item.
33386
33387.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
33388.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
33389Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
33390expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
33391the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
33392&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
33393option, rounded to a whole number.
33394
33395The items must appear in the file in the following order:
33396
33397.ilist
33398The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
33399&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
33400.next
33401The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
33402failing addresses with their error messages.
33403.next
33404The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
33405returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
33406.next
33407The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
33408as part of the error report.
33409.next
33410The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
33411truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
33412.next
33413The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
33414.endlist
33415
33416The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
33417following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
33418other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
33419.code
33420Subject: Mail delivery failed
33421 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
33422 {: returning message to sender}}
33423****
33424This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
33425
33426A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
33427 {that you sent }{sent by
33428
33429<$sender_address>
33430
33431}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
33432This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
33433****
33434The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
33435****
33436------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
33437 ------
33438****
33439------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
33440 only the first
33441------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
33442****
33443.endd
33444.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
33445.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
33446.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
33447The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
33448warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
33449text sections:
33450
33451.ilist
33452The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
33453&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
33454.next
33455The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
33456the delayed addresses.
33457.next
33458The third item then ends the message.
33459.endlist
33460
33461The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
33462have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
33463.code
33464Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
33465 $warn_message_delay
33466****
33467This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
33468
33469A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
33470{that you sent }{sent by
33471
33472<$sender_address>
33473
33474}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
33475more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
33476
33477The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
33478The subject of the message is: $h_subject
33479The date of the message is: $h_date
33480
33481The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
33482****
33483No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
33484continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
33485intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
33486mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
33487the message will be returned to you.
33488.endd
33489.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
33490.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
33491However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
33492appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
33493&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
33494minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
33495of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
33496multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
33497handled them.
33498
33499
33500
33501
33502. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33503. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33504
33505.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
33506This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
33507common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
33508
33509
33510
33511.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
33512.cindex "smart host" "example router"
33513If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
33514should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
33515routing explicitly:
33516.code
33517send_to_smart_host:
33518 driver = manualroute
33519 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
33520 transport = remote_smtp
33521.endd
33522You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
33523If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
33524receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
33525synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
33526&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
33527
33528
33529
33530
33531.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
33532.cindex "mailing lists"
33533Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
33534requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
33535Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
33536
33537The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
33538is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
33539independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
33540lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
33541.code
33542lists:
33543 driver = redirect
33544 domains = lists.example
33545 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
33546 forbid_pipe
33547 forbid_file
33548 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
33549 no_more
33550.endd
33551This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
33552in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
33553such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
33554routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
33555
33556The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
33557expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
33558a mailing list.
33559
33560.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
33561The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
33562taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
33563original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
33564the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
33565
33566For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
33567&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
33568&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
33569&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
33570There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
33571the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
33572such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
33573or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
33574&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
33575
33576
33577
33578.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
33579.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
33580If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
33581delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
33582list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
33583list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
33584addresses are not rigorously checked.
33585
33586If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
33587entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
33588&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
33589whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
33590&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
33591
33592
33593
33594.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
33595.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
33596Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
33597in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
33598recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
33599cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
33600delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
33601account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
33602the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
33603message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
33604
33605If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
33606on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
33607router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
33608&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
33609&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
33610subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
33611failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
33612pre-existing messages.
33613
33614The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
33615addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
33616addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
33617&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
33618one level of expansion anyway.
33619
33620
33621
33622.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
33623.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
33624The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
33625send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
33626from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
33627&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
33628
33629The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
33630of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
33631.code
33632lists_request:
33633 driver = redirect
33634 domains = lists.example
33635 local_part_suffix = -request
33636 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
33637 no_more
33638
33639lists_post:
33640 driver = redirect
33641 domains = lists.example
33642 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
33643 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
33644 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
33645 forbid_pipe
33646 forbid_file
33647 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
33648 no_more
33649
33650lists_closed:
33651 driver = redirect
33652 domains = lists.example
33653 allow_fail
33654 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
33655.endd
33656All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
33657they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
33658&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
33659mailing list.
33660
33661The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
33662checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
33663checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
33664necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
33665because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
33666not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
33667means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
33668&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
33669&"unrouteable address"& error.
33670
33671The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
33672a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
33673the address, giving a suitable error message.
33674
33675
33676
33677
33678.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
33679.cindex "VERP"
33680.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
33681.cindex "envelope sender"
33682Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
33683are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
33684address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
33685the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
33686if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
33687original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
33688
33689.oindex &%errors_to%&
33690.oindex &%return_path%&
33691Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
33692facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
33693list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
33694these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
33695host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
33696of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
33697of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
33698.code
33699verp_smtp:
33700 driver = smtp
33701 max_rcpt = 1
33702 return_path = \
33703 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
33704 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
33705.endd
33706This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
33707SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
33708&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
33709local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
33710example, that a message whose return path has been set to
33711&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
33712&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
33713rewritten as
33714.code
33715somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
33716.endd
33717.vindex "&$local_part$&"
33718For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
33719have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
33720achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
33721might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
33722&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
33723
33724Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
33725probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
33726extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
33727can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
33728.code
33729dnslookup:
33730 driver = dnslookup
33731 domains = ! +local_domains
33732 transport = \
33733 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
33734 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
33735 no_more
33736.endd
33737If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
33738of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
33739routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
33740errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
33741address.
33742
33743On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
33744&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
33745SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
33746and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
33747of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
33748.code
33749verp_dnslookup:
33750 driver = dnslookup
33751 domains = ! +local_domains
33752 transport = remote_smtp
33753 errors_to = \
33754 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
33755 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
33756 no_more
33757.endd
33758Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
33759configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
33760Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
33761router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
33762them.
33763
33764The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
33765message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
33766host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
33767a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
33768a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
33769than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
33770used).
33771
33772
33773
33774
33775
33776
33777.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
33778.cindex "virtual domains"
33779.cindex "domain" "virtual"
33780The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
33781meanings:
33782
33783.ilist
33784A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
33785aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
33786top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
33787.next
33788One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
33789with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
33790have login accounts on that host.
33791.endlist
33792
33793The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
33794the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
33795aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
33796virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
33797whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
33798to a router of this form:
33799.code
33800virtual:
33801 driver = redirect
33802 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
33803 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
33804 no_more
33805.endd
33806The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
33807is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
33808domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
33809part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
33810setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
33811string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
33812
33813This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
33814follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
33815can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
33816a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
33817
33818The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
33819way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
33820valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
33821.code
33822my_domains:
33823 driver = accept
33824 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
33825 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
33826 transport = my_mailboxes
33827.endd
33828The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
33829can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
33830file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
33831option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
33832because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
33833follows:
33834.code
33835my_mailboxes:
33836 driver = appendfile
33837 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
33838 user = mail
33839.endd
33840This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
33841required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
33842
33843The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
33844requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
33845up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
33846information about the domains.
33847
33848
33849
33850.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
33851.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
33852.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
33853.cindex "local part" "prefix"
33854.cindex "local part" "suffix"
33855Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
33856incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
33857allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
33858identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
33859parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
33860&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
33861example, consider this router:
33862.code
33863userforward:
33864 driver = redirect
33865 check_local_user
33866 file = $home/.forward
33867 local_part_suffix = -*
33868 local_part_suffix_optional
33869 allow_filter
33870.endd
33871.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
33872It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
33873&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
33874cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
33875.code
33876if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
33877save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
33878endif
33879.endd
33880If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
33881fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
33882&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
33883control over which suffixes are valid.
33884
33885Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
33886&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
33887another MTA:
33888.code
33889userforward:
33890 driver = redirect
33891 check_local_user
33892 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
33893 local_part_suffix = -*
33894 local_part_suffix_optional
33895 allow_filter
33896.endd
33897If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
33898example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
33899does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
33900subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
33901&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
33902
33903
33904
33905.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
33906.cindex "vacation processing"
33907The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
33908a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
33909(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
33910This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
33911that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
33912
33913.ilist
33914A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
33915can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
33916alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
33917&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
33918.code
33919spqr, vacation-spqr
33920.endd
33921.next
33922The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
33923vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
33924user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
33925ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
33926to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
33927message.
33928.endlist
33929
33930Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
33931use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
33932
33933
33934
33935.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
33936.cindex "message" "copying every"
33937Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
33938be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
33939command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
33940each day's messages.
33941
33942There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
33943messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
33944delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
33945notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
33946
33947
33948
33949.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
33950.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
33951It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
33952Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
33953arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
33954permanently connected.
33955
33956Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
33957particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
33958Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
33959
33960
33961.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
33962It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
33963host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
33964approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
33965being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
33966some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
33967to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
33968resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
33969
33970A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
33971intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
33972into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
33973format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
33974destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
33975in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
33976if required.
33977
33978On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
33979you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
33980intermittent host. For example:
33981.code
33982cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
33983.endd
33984This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
33985which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
33986online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
33987options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
33988causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
33989connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
33990immediately.
33991
33992If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
33993issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
33994mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
33995used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
33996avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
33997Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
33998arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
33999
34000
34001
34002.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
34003The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
34004increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
34005connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
34006delivered immediately.
34007
34008.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34009.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
34010.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
34011Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
34012not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
34013possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
34014each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
34015avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
34016&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
34017first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
34018normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
34019destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
34020single SMTP connection.
34021
34022
34023
34024. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34025. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34026
34027.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34028 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34029.cindex "client, non-queueing"
34030.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34031On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34032email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
34033configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
34034However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
34035configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
34036&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
34037messages this way.
34038
34039If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
34040run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
34041any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
34042continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
34043email is not desirable.
34044
34045There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
34046&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
34047any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
34048host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
34049informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
34050to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
34051to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
34052
34053There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
34054that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
34055ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
34056before sending a message to the smart host.
34057
34058Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
34059tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
34060overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
34061
34062.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
34063There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
34064Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
34065assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
34066just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
34067compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
34068router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
34069
34070When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
34071following ways:
34072
34073.ilist
34074A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
34075In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
34076.next
34077Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
34078assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
34079&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
34080does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
34081successful, a zero return code is given.
34082.next
34083Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
34084be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
34085the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
34086must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
34087deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
34088are.
34089.next
34090If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
34091failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
34092successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
34093.next
34094Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
34095is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
34096smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
34097the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
34098there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
34099.next
34100If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
34101connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
34102failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
34103.next
34104When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
34105(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
34106value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
34107are ever generated.
34108.next
34109No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
34110.next
34111A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
34112true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
34113&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
34114.endlist
34115
34116The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
34117the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
34118deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
34119privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
34120to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
34121the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
34122
34123
34124
34125
34126. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34127. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34128
34129.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
34130.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
34131.cindex "log" "types of"
34132Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
34133and the panic log:
34134
34135.ilist
34136.cindex "main log"
34137The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
34138line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
34139down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
34140out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
34141them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
34142they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
34143analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
34144&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
34145.next
34146.cindex "reject log"
34147The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
34148of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
34149The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
34150the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
34151is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
34152lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
34153reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
34154host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
34155can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
34156false.
34157.next
34158.cindex "panic log"
34159.cindex "system log"
34160When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
34161error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
34162are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
34163other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
34164therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
34165regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
34166panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
34167is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
34168message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
34169.endlist
34170
34171Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
34172example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
34173In the log file, this would be all on one line:
34174.code
341752001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
34176 by QUIT
34177.endd
34178By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
34179ways of changing this:
34180
34181.ilist
34182You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
34183you set
34184.code
34185timezone = UTC
34186.endd
34187the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
34188.next
34189If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
34190example:
34191.code
341922003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
34193.endd
34194.endlist
34195
34196.cindex "log" "process ids in"
34197.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34198Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
34199request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
34200&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
34201brackets, immediately after the time and date.
34202
34203
34204
34205
34206.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
34207.cindex "log" "destination"
34208.cindex "log" "to file"
34209.cindex "log" "to syslog"
34210.cindex "syslog"
34211The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
34212should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
34213are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
34214arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
34215It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
34216need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
34217Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
34218
34219The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
34220&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
34221configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
34222references to the host name:
34223.code
34224log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
34225.endd
34226It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
34227rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
34228start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
34229before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
34230configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
34231log at all.
34232
34233The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
34234list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
34235facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
34236colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
34237otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
34238point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
34239implying the use of a default path.
34240
34241When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
34242LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
34243&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
34244mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
34245files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
34246equivalent to the setting:
34247.code
34248log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
34249.endd
34250If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
34251logs are written.
34252
34253A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
34254are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
34255
34256Here are some examples of possible settings:
34257.display
34258&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
34259&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
34260&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
34261&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
34262.endd
34263If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
34264error is logged.
34265
34266
34267
34268.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
34269.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34270.cindex "cycling logs"
34271.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34272.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
34273Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
34274log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
34275provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
34276main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
34277keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
34278
34279An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
34280and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
34281example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
34282message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
34283that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
34284something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
34285ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
34286&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
34287does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
34288tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
34289for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
34290renamed.
34291
34292
34293
34294.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
34295.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
34296Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
34297periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
34298for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
34299&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
34300the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
34301point where the datestamp is required. For example:
34302.code
34303log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
34304log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
34305log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
34306log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
34307.endd
34308As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
34309examples of names generated by the above examples:
34310.code
34311/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
34312/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
34313/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
34314/var/log/exim/main.200212
34315.endd
34316When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
34317files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
34318will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
34319run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
34320
34321The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
34322is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
34323When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
34324the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
34325non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
34326character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
34327log names:
34328.code
34329/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
34330/var/log/exim-panic.log
34331/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
34332/var/log/exim/panic
34333.endd
34334
34335
34336.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
34337.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
34338The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
34339except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
34340Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
34341that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
34342&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
34343by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
34344&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
34345SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
34346&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
34347LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
34348the time and host name to each line.
34349The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
34350
34351.ilist
34352&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
34353.next
34354&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
34355.next
34356&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
34357.endlist
34358
34359Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
34360written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
34361these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
34362by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
34363
34364Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
34365entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
34366these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
34367calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
34368870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
34369additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
34370replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
34371RFC 3164, you should set
34372.code
34373SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
34374.endd
34375in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
34376lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
34377
34378To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
34379entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
34380where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
34381components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
34382because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
34383delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
34384870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
34385&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
34386name, and pid as added by syslog:
34387.code
34388[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
34389[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
34390[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
34391[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
34392[5/5] mple>)
34393.endd
34394The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
34395(LOG_NOTICE):
34396.code
34397[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
34398[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
34399[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
34400[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
34401[5\18] .example>)
34402[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
34403[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
34404[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
34405[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
34406[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
34407[11\18] 09:43 +0100
34408[12\18] F From: <>
34409[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
34410[18\18] X-something: this is another header
34411[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
34412[16\18] le>
34413[17\18] B Bcc:
34414[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
34415.endd
34416Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
34417without modification.
34418
34419If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
34420display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
34421the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
34422where it is.
34423
34424
34425
34426.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
34427One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
34428successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
34429picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
34430timestamp. The flags are:
34431.display
34432&`<=`& message arrival
34433&`=>`& normal message delivery
34434&`->`& additional address in same delivery
34435&`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
34436&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
34437&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
34438&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
34439.endd
34440
34441
34442.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
34443.cindex "log" "reception line"
34444The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
34445message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
34446several lines in order to fit it on the page:
34447.code
344482002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
34449 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
34450 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
34451.endd
34452The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
34453bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
34454generated, this is followed by an item of the form
34455.code
34456R=<message id>
34457.endd
34458which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
34459
34460.cindex "HELO"
34461.cindex "EHLO"
34462For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
34463record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
34464received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
34465host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
34466above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
34467&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
34468by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
34469verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
34470EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
34471name in parentheses.
34472
34473Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
34474without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
34475the log containing text like these examples:
34476.code
34477H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
34478H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
34479.endd
34480This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
34481on.
34482
34483For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
34484the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
34485of Exim.
34486
34487.cindex "authentication" "logging"
34488.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
34489For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
34490message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
34491of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
34492extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
34493session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
34494suite that was used.
34495
34496The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
34497hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
34498value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
34499there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
34500was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
34501&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
34502authenticator name.
34503
34504.cindex "size" "of message"
34505The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
34506received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
34507headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
34508message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
34509other).
34510
34511The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
34512data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
34513
34514
34515
34516.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
34517.cindex "log" "delivery line"
34518The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
34519delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
34520deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
34521to fit it on the page:
34522.code
345232002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
34524 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
345252002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
34526 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
34527 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
34528.endd
34529For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
34530after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
34531intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
34532last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
34533fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
34534
34535If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
34536followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
34537If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
34538option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
34539
34540If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
34541for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
34542.display
34543&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
34544.endd
34545If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
34546parentheses afterwards.
34547
34548.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34549When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
34550SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
34551flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
34552down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
34553lines for the second and subsequent messages.
34554
34555.cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
34556.cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
34557When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
34558line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
34559rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
34560
34561The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
34562&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
34563
34564The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
34565data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
34566
34567
34568.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
34569.cindex "discarded messages"
34570.cindex "message" "discarded"
34571.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
34572When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
34573obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
34574.code
345752002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
34576 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
34577.endd
34578is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
34579because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
34580.code
345811999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
34582 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
34583.endd
34584
34585
34586.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
34587When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
34588.code
345892002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
34590 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
34591.endd
34592In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
34593last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
34594written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
34595.code
345962002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
34597 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
34598.endd
34599When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
34600a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
34601appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
34602
34603
34604
34605.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
34606.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
34607If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
34608following form is logged:
34609.code
346101995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
34611 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
34612.endd
34613If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
34614the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
34615.code
346162002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
34617 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
34618 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
34619 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
34620 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
34621.endd
34622The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
34623used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
34624disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
34625flagged with &`**`&.
34626
34627
34628
34629.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
34630.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
34631If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
34632used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
34633&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
34634
34635
34636
34637.section "Completion" "SECID257"
34638A line of the form
34639.code
346402002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
34641.endd
34642is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
34643at the end of its processing.
34644
34645
34646
34647
34648.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
34649.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
34650A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
34651the following table:
34652.display
34653&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
34654&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
34655&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
34656&`CV `& certificate verification status
34657&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
34658&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
34659&`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
34660&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
34661&`H `& host name and IP address
34662&`I `& local interface used
34663&`id `& message id for incoming message
34664&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
34665&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
34666&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
34667&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
34668&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
34669&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
34670&`S `& size of message
34671&`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
34672&`ST `& shadow transport name
34673&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
34674&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
34675&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
34676&`X `& TLS cipher suite
34677.endd
34678
34679
34680.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
34681Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
34682self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
34683
34684.ilist
34685.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
34686&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
34687during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
34688This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
34689during the first delivery attempt.
34690.next
34691&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
34692temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
34693for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
34694.next
34695.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
34696&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
34697some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
34698common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
34699&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
34700doing.
34701.next
34702.cindex "error" "ignored"
34703&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
34704message:
34705.olist
34706Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
34707&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
34708.next
34709A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
34710failed. The delivery was discarded.
34711.next
34712A delivery set up by a router configured with
34713. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
34714. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
34715.code
34716 errors_to = <>
34717.endd
34718failed. The delivery was discarded.
34719.endlist olist
34720.endlist ilist
34721
34722
34723
34724
34725
34726.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
34727.cindex "log" "selectors"
34728By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
34729default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
34730&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
34731example:
34732.code
34733log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
34734.endd
34735The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
34736selection marked by asterisks:
34737.display
34738&` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
34739&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
34740&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
34741&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
34742&` arguments `& command line arguments
34743&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
34744&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
34745&` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
34746&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
34747&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
34748&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
34749&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
34750&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
34751&` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
34752&` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
34753&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
34754&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
34755&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
34756&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
34757&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
34758&` pid `& Exim process id
34759&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
34760&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
34761&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
34762&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
34763&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
34764&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
34765&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
34766&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
34767&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
34768&`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
34769&` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
34770&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
34771&` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
34772&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
34773&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
34774&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
34775&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
34776&` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
34777&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
34778&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
34779&` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
34780&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
34781
34782&` all `& all of the above
34783.endd
34784More details on each of these items follows:
34785
34786.ilist
34787.cindex "8BITMIME"
34788.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
34789&%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
34790which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
34791that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
34792&`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
34793&`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
34794.next
34795.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
34796&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
34797its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
34798this log selector is set.
34799.next
34800.cindex "log" "rewriting"
34801.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
34802&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
34803rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
34804such users cannot access the log).
34805.next
34806.cindex "log" "full parentage"
34807&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
34808delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
34809parentheses between them.
34810.next
34811.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
34812.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
34813&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
34814to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
34815feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
34816&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
34817privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
34818that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
34819are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
34820because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
34821only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
34822between the caller and Exim.
34823.next
34824.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
34825&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
34826connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
34827.next
34828.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
34829.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
34830&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
34831started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
34832messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
34833process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
34834.next
34835.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
34836&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
34837perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
34838.next
34839.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
34840.cindex "size" "of message"
34841&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
34842the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
34843.next
34844.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
34845.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
34846.cindex "black list (DNS)"
34847&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
34848DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
34849.next
34850.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
34851.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
34852&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
34853is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
34854command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
34855selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
34856.next
34857.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
34858&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
34859any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
34860log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
34861routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
34862.next
34863.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
34864.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
34865&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
34866client's ident port times out.
34867.next
34868.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
34869.cindex "interface" "logging"
34870&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
34871to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
34872followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
34873added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
34874rejection lines.
34875.next
34876.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
34877.cindex "port" "logging remote"
34878.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
34879.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
34880.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
34881&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
34882added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
34883in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
34884changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
34885&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
34886important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
34887.next
34888.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
34889&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
34890connection is unexpectedly dropped.
34891.next
34892.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
34893.cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
34894.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
34895&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
34896containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
34897the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
34898number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
34899.next
34900.cindex "log" "process ids in"
34901.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34902&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
34903immediately after the time and date.
34904.next
34905.cindex "log" "queue run"
34906.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
34907&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
34908.next
34909.cindex "log" "queue time"
34910&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
34911local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
34912&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
34913includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
34914This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
34915delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
34916message has been successfully received.
34917.next
34918&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
34919the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
34920example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
34921message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
34922.next
34923.cindex "log" "recipients"
34924&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
34925as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
34926that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
34927addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
34928has taken place.
34929Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
34930in the list.
34931.next
34932.cindex "log" "sender reception"
34933&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
34934the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
34935&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
34936.next
34937.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
34938&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
34939rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
34940log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
34941rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
34942.next
34943.cindex "log" "retry defer"
34944&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
34945retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
34946message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
34947attempt.
34948.next
34949.cindex "log" "return path"
34950&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
34951the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
34952This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
34953or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
34954.next
34955.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
34956&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
34957and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
34958This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
34959necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
34960.next
34961.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
34962&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
34963gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
34964the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
34965detail is lost.
34966.next
34967.cindex "log" "size rejection"
34968&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
34969it is too big.
34970.next
34971.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
34972.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
34973&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
34974queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
34975it.
34976.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
34977The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
34978.next
34979.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
34980.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
34981.cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
34982&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
34983outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
34984A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
34985response.
34986.next
34987.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
34988.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
34989&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
34990established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
34991&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
34992only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
34993processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
34994dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
34995not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
34996of connections unless this selector is enabled.
34997
34998For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
34999included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
35000reset if the daemon is restarted.
35001Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
35002subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
35003whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
35004match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
35005logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
35006.next
35007.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
35008.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
35009&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
35010RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
35011and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
35012line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
35013.next
35014.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
35015.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
35016&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
35017connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
35018the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
35019does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
35020an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
35021already have their own log lines.
35022
35023The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
35024way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
35025If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
35026an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
35027DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
35028the same logging options.
35029
35030Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
35031is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
35032.code
35033C=EHLO,QUIT
35034.endd
35035shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
35036than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
35037the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
35038setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
35039have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
35040.next
35041&%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
35042colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
35043log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
35044was accepted or used.
35045.next
35046.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
35047.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
35048&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
35049encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
35050because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
35051been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
35052it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
35053received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
35054.next
35055.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
35056.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
35057.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
35058.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
35059.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
35060&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
35061encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
35062external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
35063using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
35064.next
35065.cindex "log" "subject"
35066.cindex "subject, logging"
35067&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
35068preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
35069Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
35070specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
35071unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
35072.next
35073.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
35074&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
35075when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
35076verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
35077.next
35078.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
35079.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
35080&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35081connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
35082.next
35083.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
35084.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
35085&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35086connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
35087added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
35088.next
35089.cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
35090.cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
35091&%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
35092the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
35093added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
35094.next
35095.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
35096&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
35097result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
35098.endlist
35099
35100
35101.section "Message log" "SECID260"
35102.cindex "message" "log file for"
35103.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
35104.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
35105.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
35106In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
35107that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
35108they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
35109message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
35110makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
35111to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
35112is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
35113only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
35114
35115On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
35116per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
35117&%message_logs%& option false.
35118.ecindex IIDloggen
35119
35120
35121
35122
35123. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35124. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35125
35126.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
35127.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
35128A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
35129described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
35130the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
35131
35132.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
35133.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
35134 "list what Exim processes are doing"
35135.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
35136.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
35137.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
35138.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
35139 various criteria"
35140.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
35141.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
35142 "extract statistics from the log"
35143.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
35144 "check address acceptance from given IP"
35145.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
35146.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
35147.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
35148.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
35149.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
35150.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
35151.endtable
35152
35153Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
35154&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
35155&url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
35156
35157
35158
35159
35160.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
35161.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
35162.cindex "process, querying"
35163.cindex "SIGUSR1"
35164On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
35165(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
35166a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
35167Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
35168processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
35169second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
35170order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
35171send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
35172
35173&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
35174use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
35175script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
35176
35177
35178Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
35179varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
35180but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
35181system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
35182it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
35183options:
35184.display
35185&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
35186&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
35187&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
35188&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
35189.endd
35190An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
35191.code
35192164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3519310483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3519410492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
35195 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3519610592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3519710628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
35198.endd
35199The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
35200been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
35201
35202
35203
35204.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
35205.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
35206.cindex "queue" "grepping"
35207This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
35208.code
35209exim -bpu
35210.endd
35211or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
35212.code
35213exim -bp
35214.endd
35215The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
35216contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
35217
35218to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
35219that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
35220
35221.vlist
35222.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
35223Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35224tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
35225.code
35226exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
35227.endd
35228.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
35229Match a recipient address using a case-insensitve search. The field that is
35230tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
35231
35232.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
35233Match against the size field.
35234
35235.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35236Match messages that are younger than the given time.
35237
35238.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35239Match messages that are older than the given time.
35240
35241.vitem &*-z*&
35242Match only frozen messages.
35243
35244.vitem &*-x*&
35245Match only non-frozen messages.
35246.endlist
35247
35248The following options control the format of the output:
35249
35250.vlist
35251.vitem &*-c*&
35252Display only the count of matching messages.
35253
35254.vitem &*-l*&
35255Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
35256the default.
35257
35258.vitem &*-i*&
35259Display message ids only.
35260
35261.vitem &*-b*&
35262Brief format &-- one line per message.
35263
35264.vitem &*-R*&
35265Display messages in reverse order.
35266
35267.vitem &*-a*&
35268Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
35269.endlist
35270
35271There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
35272
35273
35274
35275.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
35276.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
35277.cindex "queue" "summary"
35278The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
35279-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
35280running a command such as
35281.code
35282exim -bp | exiqsumm
35283.endd
35284The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
35285it, as in the following example:
35286.code
352873 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
35288.endd
35289Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
35290volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
35291been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
35292number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
35293
35294A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
35295domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
35296the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
35297respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
35298domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
35299separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
35300sender.
35301
35302The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
35303this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
35304generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
35305option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
35306level"& addresses).
35307
35308
35309
35310
35311.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
35312 "SECTextspeinf"
35313.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
35314.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
35315The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
35316files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
35317extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
35318match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
35319given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
35320The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
35321If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
35322included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
35323.new
35324.display
35325&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
35326.endd
35327.wen
35328If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
35329
35330The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
35331condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
35332they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
35333
35334By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
35335makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
35336large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
35337option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
35338case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
35339
35340The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
35341pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
35342regular expression.
35343
35344The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
35345if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
35346
35347.new
35348The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
35349that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
35350normally.
35351
35352Example of &%-M%&:
35353user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
35354&'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
35355displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
35356the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
35357when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
35358&"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
35359search term.
35360.wen
35361
35362If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
35363ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
35364whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
35365
35366
35367.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
35368.cindex "&'exipick'&"
35369John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
35370lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
35371of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
35372&url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
35373the &%--help%& option.
35374
35375
35376.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
35377.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35378.cindex "cycling logs"
35379.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35380The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
35381&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
35382you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
35383&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
35384for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
35385There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
35386.ilist
35387&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
35388default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
35389.next
35390&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
35391&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
35392overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
35393configuration.
35394.endlist
35395
35396Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
35397the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
35398run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
35399&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
35400&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
35401logs are handled similarly.
35402
35403If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
35404&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
35405to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
35406any existing log files.
35407
35408If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
35409the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
35410using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
35411setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
35412root &%crontab%& entry of the form
35413.code
354141 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
35415.endd
35416assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
35417&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
35418
35419
35420
35421.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
35422.cindex "statistics"
35423.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
35424A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
35425information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
35426Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
35427LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
35428
35429The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
35430latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
35431lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
35432various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
35433list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
35434.code
35435eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
35436.endd
35437By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
35438messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
35439both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
35440are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
35441addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
35442options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
35443also produced per user.
35444
35445The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
35446histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
35447hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
35448example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
35449as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
35450
35451Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
35452have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
35453messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
35454and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
35455recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
35456an entirely separate message.
35457
35458&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
35459of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
35460each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
35461not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
35462least one address that failed.
35463
35464The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
35465or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
35466transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
35467(default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
35468a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
35469senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
35470and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
35471
35472The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
35473came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
35474without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
35475
35476There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
35477outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
35478by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
35479.code
35480perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
35481.endd
35482
35483.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
35484.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
35485.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
35486.cindex "checking access"
35487The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
35488debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
35489policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
35490familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
35491sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
35492access?"& without bothering with any further details.
35493
35494The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
35495two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
35496.code
35497exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
35498.endd
35499The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
35500given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
35501connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
35502is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
35503.code
35504Rejected:
35505550 Relay not permitted
35506.endd
35507When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
35508for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
35509options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
35510that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
35511you can use:
35512.code
35513exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
35514 -f himself@there.example
35515.endd
35516Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
35517mandatory arguments.
35518
35519Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
35520while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
35521&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
35522
35523
35524
35525.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
35526.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
35527.cindex "building DBM files"
35528.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
35529.cindex "lower casing"
35530.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
35531The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
35532the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
35533&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
35534names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
35535can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
35536
35537A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
35538the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
35539&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
35540strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
35541files.
35542
35543The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
35544single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
35545It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
35546well.
35547
35548.cindex "USE_DB"
35549If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
35550configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
35551names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
35552a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
35553.code
35554exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
35555.endd
35556reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
35557&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
35558
35559In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
35560Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
35561environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
35562&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
35563when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
35564recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
35565
35566If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
35567finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
35568option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
35569this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
35570&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
35571There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
35572&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
35573return code is 2.
35574
35575
35576
35577
35578.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
35579.cindex "retry" "times"
35580.cindex "&'exinext'&"
35581A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
35582fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
35583complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
35584information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
35585is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
35586output. For example:
35587.code
35588$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
35589kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
35590 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
35591 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
35592 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
35593roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
35594 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
35595 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
35596 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
35597 past final cutoff time
35598.endd
35599You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
35600will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
35601A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
35602message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
35603suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
35604&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
35605run very often.
35606
35607The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
35608of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
35609passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
35610configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
35611file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
35612environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
35613
35614
35615
35616.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
35617.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
35618.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
35619Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
35620uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
35621arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
35622second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
35623
35624.ilist
35625&'retry'&: the database of retry information
35626.next
35627&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
35628for remote hosts
35629.next
35630&'callout'&: the callout cache
35631.next
35632&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
35633.next
35634&'misc'&: other hints data
35635.endlist
35636
35637The &'misc'& database is used for
35638
35639.ilist
35640Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
35641.next
35642Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
35643&(smtp)& transport)
35644.endlist
35645
35646
35647
35648.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
35649.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
35650The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
35651&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
35652spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
35653.code
35654exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
35655.endd
35656Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
35657.code
35658T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3565931-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
35660.endd
35661The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
35662of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
35663transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
35664a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
35665address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
35666transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
35667to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
35668and a textual description of the error.
35669
35670The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
35671the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
35672ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
35673exceeded.
35674
35675Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
35676consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
35677waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
35678one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
35679may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
35680may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
35681cross-references.
35682
35683
35684
35685.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
35686.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
35687The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
35688database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
35689days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
35690updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
35691since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
35692for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
35693updated sufficiently often.
35694
35695The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
35696followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
35697the retry database:
35698.code
35699exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
35700.endd
35701Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
35702message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
35703they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
35704are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
35705types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
35706message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
35707queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
35708&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
35709For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
35710removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
35711whenever it removes information from the database.
35712
35713Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
35714needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
35715down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
35716first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
35717records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
35718
35719It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
35720hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
35721a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
35722work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
35723but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
35724After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
35725point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
35726tidied.
35727
35728&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
35729databases is likely to keep on increasing.
35730
35731
35732
35733
35734.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
35735.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
35736The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
35737Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
35738getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
35739is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
35740key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
35741displayed.
35742
35743If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
35744except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
35745out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
35746data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
35747by new data, for example:
35748.code
35749> 4 951102:1000
35750.endd
35751resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
35752sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
35753used as optional separators.
35754
35755
35756
35757
35758.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
35759.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
35760.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
35761.cindex "locking mailboxes"
35762The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
35763Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
35764&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
35765a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
35766the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
35767argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
35768second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
35769is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
35770is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
35771
35772.vlist
35773.vitem &%-fcntl%&
35774Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
35775
35776.vitem &%-flock%&
35777Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
35778supports it.
35779
35780.vitem &%-interval%&
35781This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
35782interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
35783
35784.vitem &%-lockfile%&
35785Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
35786
35787.vitem &%-mbx%&
35788Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
35789
35790.vitem &%-q%&
35791Suppress verification output.
35792
35793.vitem &%-retries%&
35794This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
35795the lock (default 10).
35796
35797.vitem &%-restore_time%&
35798This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
35799locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
35800example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
35801subsequently sees.
35802
35803.vitem &%-timeout%&
35804This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
35805timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
35806default), a non-blocking call is used.
35807
35808.vitem &%-v%&
35809Generate verbose output.
35810.endlist
35811
35812If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
35813default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
35814mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
35815&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
35816requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
35817file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
35818more than 30 minutes old.
35819
35820The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
35821&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
35822to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
35823&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
35824number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
35825can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
35826
35827The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
35828&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
35829suppresses all output except error messages.
35830
35831A command such as
35832.code
35833exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
35834.endd
35835runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
35836.display
35837&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
35838<&'some commands'&>
35839&`End`&
35840.endd
35841runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
35842suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
35843such as
35844.code
35845exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
35846 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
35847.endd
35848Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
35849second argument &-- hence the quotes.
35850.ecindex IIDutils
35851
35852
35853. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35854. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35855
35856.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
35857.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
35858.cindex "X-windows"
35859.cindex "&'eximon'&"
35860.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
35861.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
35862The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
35863about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
35864perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
35865such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
35866monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
35867
35868
35869
35870.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
35871The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
35872script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
35873binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
35874be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
35875&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
35876parameters are for.
35877
35878The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
35879a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
35880preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
35881.code
35882EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
35883.endd
35884(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
35885the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
35886overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
35887&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
35888syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
35889
35890X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
35891way. For example, a resource setting of the form
35892.code
35893Eximon*background: gray94
35894.endd
35895changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
35896stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
35897black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
35898data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
35899&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
35900For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
35901reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
35902.code
35903xrdb -merge <<End
35904Eximon*highlight: gray
35905End
35906.endd
35907.cindex "admin user"
35908In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
35909&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
35910
35911The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
35912contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
35913if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
35914binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
35915versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
35916
35917The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
35918more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
35919main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
35920delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
35921different parts of the display.
35922
35923
35924
35925
35926.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
35927.cindex "stripchart"
35928The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
35929be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35930&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
35931configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
35932it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
35933hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
35934received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
35935period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
35936parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35937
35938The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
35939displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
35940title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
35941For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
35942
35943It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
35944a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
35945to a single partition.
35946
35947.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
35948This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
35949the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
35950this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
35951100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
35952SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35953&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35954
35955
35956
35957
35958.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
35959.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
35960.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
35961.cindex "window size"
35962Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
35963to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
35964shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
35965stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
35966the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
35967in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
35968
35969When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
35970currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
35971size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
35972remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
35973
35974The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
35975stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
35976the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
35977The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
35978&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
35979the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35980
35981Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
35982built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
35983START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35984
35985
35986
35987.section "The log display" "SECID267"
35988.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
35989The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
35990the main log is maintained.
35991To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
35992removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
35993The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
35994syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
35995to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
35996
35997The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
35998move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
35999scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
36000LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
36001to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
36002much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
36003a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
36004only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
36005available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
36006normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
36007configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36008
36009Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
36010and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
36011respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
36012It cannot go further back up the log.
36013
36014The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
36015normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
36016by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
36017by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
36018back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
36019the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
36020
36021Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
36022There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
36023the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
36024happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
36025&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
36026^C is typed the search is cancelled.
36027
36028The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
36029widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
36030&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
36031eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
36032However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
36033provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
36034come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
36035unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
36036on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
36037window.
36038
36039
36040
36041.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
36042.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
36043The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
36044are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
36045as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
36046parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
36047at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
36048the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
36049there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
36050to force an update of the queue display at any time.
36051
36052When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
36053and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
36054with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
36055pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
36056type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
36057such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
36058of the texts, the message is not displayed.
36059
36060If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
36061are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
36062example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
36063&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
36064has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
36065cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
36066a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
36067
36068While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
36069else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
36070queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
36071pressing the &"Hide"& button.
36072
36073The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
36074time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
36075message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
36076a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
36077recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
36078listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
36079an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
36080not shown.
36081
36082.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
36083If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
36084
36085The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
36086of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
36087The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
36088available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
36089display is updated.
36090
36091
36092
36093.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
36094.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
36095If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
36096pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
36097line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
36098any selected text.
36099
36100If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
36101MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
36102set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
36103value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
36104run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
36105.code
36106EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
36107.endd
36108The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
36109follows:
36110
36111.ilist
36112&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
36113in a new text window.
36114.next
36115&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
36116information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
36117&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
36118.next
36119&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
36120displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
36121amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
36122option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
36123.next
36124&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
36125delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
36126frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
36127a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
36128up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
36129.next
36130&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
36131that the message be frozen.
36132.next
36133.cindex "thawing messages"
36134.cindex "unfreezing messages"
36135.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
36136&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
36137that the message be thawed.
36138.next
36139.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
36140&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
36141that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
36142for any remaining undelivered addresses.
36143.next
36144&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
36145that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
36146message.
36147.next
36148&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
36149be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36150is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36151Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36152causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
36153additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
36154which case no action is taken.
36155.next
36156&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
36157can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36158is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36159Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36160causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
36161recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
36162case no action is taken.
36163.next
36164&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
36165mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
36166.next
36167&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
36168sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
36169&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
36170in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
36171bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
36172not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
36173the address is qualified with that domain.
36174.endlist
36175
36176When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
36177other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
36178particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
36179output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
36180from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
36181&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
36182if no output is generated.
36183
36184The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
36185thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
36186&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
36187force an update of the display after one of these actions.
36188
36189In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
36190cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
36191and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
36192.ecindex IIDeximon
36193
36194
36195
36196
36197
36198. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36199. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36200
36201.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
36202.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
36203This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
36204which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
36205
36206For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
36207Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
36208existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
36209chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
36210security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
36211its security as compared with other MTAs.
36212
36213What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
36214have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
36215absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
36216as soon as possible.
36217
36218
36219.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
36220.cindex "security" "build-time features"
36221There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
36222to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
36223Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
36224penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
36225
36226.ilist
36227ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
36228start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
36229names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
36230value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
36231&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
36232default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
36233
36234If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
36235which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
36236into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
36237configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
36238.next
36239
36240If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
36241or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
36242file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
36243the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
36244root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
36245right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
36246reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
36247it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
36248privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
36249separate commands.
36250
36251.next
36252The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
36253with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
36254CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
36255requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
36256the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
36257but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
36258previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
36259.next
36260If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
36261is disabled.
36262.next
36263FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
36264never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
36265option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
36266to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
36267is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
36268.endlist
36269
36270
36271
36272.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
36273.cindex "setuid"
36274.cindex "root privilege"
36275The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
36276privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
36277example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
36278may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
36279discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
36280is required for two things:
36281
36282.ilist
36283To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
36284the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
36285not required.
36286.next
36287To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
36288perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
36289configuration.
36290.endlist
36291
36292It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
36293receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
36294obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
36295For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
36296&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
36297group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
36298is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
36299&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
36300
36301Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
36302abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
36303&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
36304
36305After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
36306uid and gid in the following cases:
36307
36308.ilist
36309.oindex "&%-C%&"
36310.oindex "&%-D%&"
36311If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
36312the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
36313calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
36314the calling process.
36315However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
36316option may not be used at all.
36317If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
36318can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
36319user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
36320.next
36321.oindex "&%-be%&"
36322.oindex "&%-bf%&"
36323.oindex "&%-bF%&"
36324If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
36325(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
36326calling process.
36327.next
36328If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
36329process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
36330uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
36331runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
36332testing address verification
36333.oindex "&%-bv%&"
36334.oindex "&%-bh%&"
36335(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
36336option).
36337.next
36338For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
36339remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
36340.endlist
36341
36342The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
36343
36344.ilist
36345A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
36346user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
36347function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
36348will be used during message reception.
36349.next
36350A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
36351job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
36352.next
36353A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
36354but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
36355subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
36356deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
36357remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
36358subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
36359while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
36360generating bounce and warning messages.
36361
36362While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
36363process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
36364this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
36365gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
36366.next
36367A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
36368the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
36369.endlist
36370
36371
36372
36373
36374.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
36375.cindex "privilege, running without"
36376.cindex "unprivileged running"
36377.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
36378Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
36379operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
36380by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
36381gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
36382(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
36383routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
36384to any other uid.
36385
36386.cindex SIGHUP
36387.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
36388Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
36389that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
36390correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
36391
36392An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
36393to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
36394process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
36395when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
36396SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
36397
36398It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
36399stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
36400been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
36401effect.
36402
36403If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
36404set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
36405to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
36406
36407In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
36408those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
36409Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
36410that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
36411discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
36412have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
36413number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
36414address this problem at this time.
36415
36416For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
36417is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
36418&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
36419be used in the most straightforward way.
36420
36421If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
36422number of restrictions on what you can do:
36423
36424.ilist
36425You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
36426&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
36427normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
36428work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
36429explicit specification of another user causes an error.
36430.next
36431Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
36432not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
36433.next
36434Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
36435the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
36436and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
36437enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
36438.next
36439Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
36440some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
36441
36442.olist
36443They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
36444implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
36445mode of the mailbox files themselves.
36446.next
36447You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
36448owned by the Exim user.
36449.next
36450You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
36451on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
36452mailboxes need to be created manually.
36453.endlist olist
36454.endlist ilist
36455
36456
36457These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
36458However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
36459gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
36460gives more security at essentially no cost.
36461
36462If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
36463&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
36464
36465
36466
36467
36468.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
36469Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
36470are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
36471
36472
36473
36474.section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
36475.cindex "security" "local commands"
36476.cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
36477There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
36478commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
36479configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
36480run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
36481
36482.ilist
36483Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
36484injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
36485be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
36486allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
36487has &%use_shell%& enabled.
36488.next
36489A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
36490&%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
36491&_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
36492hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
36493NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
36494forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
36495need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
36496.next
36497The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
36498administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
36499Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
36500.next
36501Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
36502taint checking might apply to their usage.
36503.next
36504Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analagous to shell's eval builtin and
36505administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
36506instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
36507.next
36508Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
36509Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
36510each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
36511of opaque strings.
36512The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
36513real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
36514injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
36515Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
36516.endlist
36517
36518
36519
36520
36521.section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
36522.cindex "security" "data sources"
36523.cindex "security" "regular expressions"
36524.cindex "regular expressions" "security"
36525.cindex "PCRE" "security"
36526If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
36527are some issues to be aware of:
36528
36529.ilist
36530Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
36531.next
36532Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
36533.next
36534Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
36535data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
36536"backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
36537expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
36538when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
36539possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
36540data.
36541.next
36542It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
36543&%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
36544items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
36545.next
36546Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
36547expected to yield one result.
36548.endlist
36549
36550
36551
36552
36553.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
36554.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
36555.cindex "IP source routing"
36556Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
36557some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
36558IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
36559IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
36560
36561
36562
36563.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
36564Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
36565be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
36566
36567
36568
36569
36570.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
36571.cindex "trusted users"
36572.cindex "admin user"
36573.cindex "privileged user"
36574.cindex "user" "trusted"
36575.cindex "user" "admin"
36576Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
36577able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
36578addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
36579local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
36580permit a remote host to be specified.
36581
36582.oindex "&%-f%&"
36583However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
36584in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
36585message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
36586but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
36587permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
36588the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
36589
36590Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
36591other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
36592the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
36593as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
36594group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
36595
36596Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
36597can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
36598them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
36599the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
36600includes the contents of files on the spool.
36601
36602.oindex "&%-M%&"
36603.oindex "&%-q%&"
36604By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
36605delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
36606restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
36607Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
36608queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
36609setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
36610
36611Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
36612the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
36613the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
36614group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
36615the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
36616unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
36617files.
36618
36619
36620
36621.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
36622.cindex "spool directory" "files"
36623Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
36624set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
36625&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
36626any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
36627
36628
36629
36630.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
36631Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
36632of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
36633with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
36634to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
36635this.
36636
36637
36638
36639.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
36640The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
36641are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
36642Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
36643converted output.
36644
36645
36646
36647.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
36648Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
36649to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
36650does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
36651arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
36652
36653
36654
36655.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
36656Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
36657defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
36658loading it.
36659
36660
36661.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
36662.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
36663A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
36664&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
36665The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
36666that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
36667conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
36668
36669The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
36670the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
36671string.
36672
36673
36674
36675.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
36676Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
36677formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
36678the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
36679
36680
36681
36682.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
36683These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
36684enough to hold the result.
36685.ecindex IIDsecurcon
36686
36687
36688
36689
36690. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36691. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36692
36693.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
36694.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
36695.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
36696.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
36697.cindex "spool files" "editing"
36698A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
36699followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
36700the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
36701kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
36702two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
36703is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
36704themselves are recoverable.
36705
36706Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
36707need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
36708on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
36709
36710.ilist
36711You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
36712fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
36713which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
36714place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
36715lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
36716.next
36717.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
36718If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
36719&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
36720present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
36721will always be the case.
36722.next
36723If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
36724.next
36725If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
36726signature.
36727.endlist
36728All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
36729
36730Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
36731its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
36732files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
36733the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
36734the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
36735is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
36736file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
36737-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
36738attempt.
36739
36740.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
36741.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
36742.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
36743The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
36744process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
36745gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
36746message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
36747normally the Exim user.
36748
36749The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
36750transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
36751empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
36752in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
36753created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
36754&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
36755leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
36756&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
36757
36758The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
36759was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
36760start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
36761warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
36762
36763There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
36764order, and are omitted when not relevant:
36765
36766.vlist
36767.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36768This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
36769&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
36770recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
36771this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
36772identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
36773the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
36774the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
36775the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
36776newlines.
36777
36778.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36779A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
36780defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
36781The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36782starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36783character. It may contain internal newlines.
36784
36785.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36786A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
36787Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
36788length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36789starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36790character. It may contain internal newlines.
36791
36792.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
36793This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
36794&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
36795
36796.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
36797This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
36798lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
36799transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
36800messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
36801
36802.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
36803This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
36804(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
36805time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
36806hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
36807
36808.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
36809The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
36810&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
36811
36812.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
36813The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
36814&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
36815
36816.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
36817This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
36818present.
36819
36820.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
36821This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
36822present if the number is greater than zero.
36823
36824.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
36825This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
36826file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
36827
36828.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
36829.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
36830The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
36831
36832.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
36833This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
36834command.
36835
36836.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
36837This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
36838the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
36839messages.
36840
36841.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
36842If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
36843the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
36844&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
36845
36846.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
36847This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
36848address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
36849
36850.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
36851.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
36852.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
36853This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
36854if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
36855received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
36856
36857.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
36858For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
36859unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
36860ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
36861supplied by the remote host, if any.
36862
36863.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
36864This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
36865which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
36866generated messages.
36867
36868.vitem &%-local%&
36869The message is from a local sender.
36870
36871.vitem &%-localerror%&
36872The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
36873
36874.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
36875This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
36876when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
36877variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
36878
36879.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
36880The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
36881Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
36882
36883.vitem &%-N%&
36884A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
36885actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
36886&%-N%& is assumed.
36887
36888.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
36889This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
36890the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
36891
36892.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
36893The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
36894to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
36895
36896.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
36897If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
36898of &$spam_score_int$&.
36899
36900.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
36901A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
36902certificate was verified by the server.
36903
36904.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
36905When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
36906name of the cipher suite that was used.
36907
36908.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
36909When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
36910was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
36911certificate.
36912.endlist
36913
36914Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
36915is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
36916line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
36917is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
36918the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
36919balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
36920to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
36921original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
36922addresses are complete.
36923
36924If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
36925the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
36926Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
36927tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
36928right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
36929follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
36930.code
36931YY darcy@austen.fict.example
36932NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
36933NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36934.endd
36935After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
36936This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
36937recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
36938delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
36939example:
36940.code
369414
36942editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36943darcy@austen.fict.example
36944rdo@foundation
36945alice@wonderland.fict.example
36946.endd
36947However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
36948result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
36949line is of the following form:
36950.display
36951<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
36952 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
36953.endd
36954The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
36955the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
36956fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
36957original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
36958envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
36959length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
36960characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
36961that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
36962
36963
36964A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
36965which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
36966when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
36967character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
36968embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
36969following:
36970
36971.table2 50pt
36972.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
36973.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
36974.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
36975.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
36976.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
36977.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
36978.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
36979.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
36980.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
36981.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
36982.endtable
36983
36984Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
36985purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
36986typical set of headers:
36987.code
36988111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
36989id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36990049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
36991038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
36992042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
36993049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
36994099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
36995darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36996104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
36997darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36998038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36999.endd
37000The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
37001&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
37002unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
37003.ecindex IIDforspo1
37004.ecindex IIDforspo2
37005.ecindex IIDforspo3
37006
37007. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37008. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37009
37010.chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
37011 "DKIM Support"
37012.cindex "DKIM"
37013
37014DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
37015linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
37016be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
37017DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
37018
37019Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
37020disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
37021
37022Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
37023.olist
37024Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
37025It can co-exist with all other Exim features
37026(including transport filters)
37027except cutthrough delivery.
37028.next
37029Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
37030ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
37031different signature contexts.
37032.endlist
37033
37034In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
37035default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
37036Exim's standard controls.
37037
37038Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
37039on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
37040exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
37041signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
37042.code
370432009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
37044 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
37045 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
37046 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
37047.endd
37048You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
37049or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
37050control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
37051where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
37052senders).
37053
37054
37055.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
37056.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
37057
37058Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
37059These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
37060
37061.option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
37062MANDATORY:
37063The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
37064option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
37065
37066.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
37067MANDATORY:
37068This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
37069variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
37070variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
37071option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
37072
37073.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
37074MANDATORY:
37075This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
37076&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
37077The result can either
37078.ilist
37079be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
37080.next
37081start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
37082the private key.
37083.next
37084be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
37085be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
37086is set.
37087.endlist
37088
37089.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
37090OPTIONAL:
37091This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
37092The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
37093The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
37094only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
37095
37096.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
37097OPTIONAL:
37098This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
37099should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
37100either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
37101unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
37102variables here.
37103
37104.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
37105OPTIONAL:
37106When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
37107list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
37108signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
37109used.
37110
37111
37112.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
37113.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
37114
37115Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
37116&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
37117syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
37118A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
37119If any ACL call does not acccept, the message is not accepted.
37120If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
37121summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
37122
37123To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
37124containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
37125runtime of the ACL.
37126
37127Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
37128more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
37129&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
37130&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
37131
37132The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
37133list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
37134called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
37135the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
37136list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
37137&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
37138it defaults as:
37139.code
37140dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
37141.endd
37142This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
37143DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
37144call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
37145.code
37146dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
37147.endd
37148This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
37149and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
37150You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
37151.code
37152dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
37153.endd
37154
37155If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
37156&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
37157
37158
37159Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
37160available (from most to least important):
37161
37162
37163.vlist
37164.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
37165The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
37166an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
37167&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
37168.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
37169A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
37170.ilist
37171&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
37172identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37173.next
37174&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
37175More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37176.next
37177&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
37178available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37179.next
37180&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
37181.endlist
37182.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
37183A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
37184"fail" or "invalid". One of
37185.ilist
37186&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
37187key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
37188.next
37189&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
37190record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
37191.next
37192&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
37193body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
37194means that the message body was modified in transit.
37195.next
37196&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
37197could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
37198re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
37199DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
37200.endlist
37201.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
37202The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
37203an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
37204reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37205.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
37206The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
37207if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
37208identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37209.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
37210The key record selector string.
37211.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
37212The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
37213.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
37214The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37215.vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
37216The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37217.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
37218A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
37219(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
37220.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
37221The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
37222limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
37223that this variable always expands to an integer value.
37224.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
37225UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
37226When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
37227.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
37228UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
37229signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
37230signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
37231integer size comparisons against this value.
37232.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
37233A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
37234.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
37235"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
37236.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
37237"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
37238.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
37239Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37240in the key record.
37241.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
37242Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37243in the key record.
37244.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
37245Notes from the key record (tag n=).
37246.endlist
37247
37248In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
37249
37250.vlist
37251.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
37252ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
37253for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
37254(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
37255verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
37256
37257.code
37258# Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
37259warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
37260 sender_domains = gmail.com
37261 dkim_signers = gmail.com
37262 dkim_status = none
37263.endd
37264
37265.vitem &%dkim_status%&
37266ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
37267results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
37268to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
37269
37270.code
37271deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
37272 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
37273 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
37274 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
37275.endd
37276
37277The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
37278see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
37279for more information of what they mean.
37280.endlist
37281
37282. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37283. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37284
37285.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
37286 "Adding drivers or lookups"
37287.cindex "adding drivers"
37288.cindex "new drivers, adding"
37289.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
37290The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
37291authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
37292
37293.olist
37294Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
37295existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
37296.next
37297Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
37298.display
37299<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
37300.endd
37301where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
37302code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
37303should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
37304.next
37305Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
37306.code
37307#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
37308.endd
37309.next
37310Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
37311and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
37312.next
37313Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
37314near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
37315Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
37316As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
37317simple form that most lookups have.
37318.next
37319Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
37320&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
37321driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
37322.next
37323Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
37324&_src_&.
37325.next
37326Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
37327as for other drivers and lookups.
37328.endlist
37329
37330Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
37331proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
37332occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
37333options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
37334searched using a binary chop procedure.
37335
37336There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
37337the interface that is expected.
37338
37339
37340
37341
37342. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37343. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37344
37345. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37346. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
37347. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
37348. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
37349. processors.
37350. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37351
37352.literal xml
37353<?sdop
37354 format="newpage"
37355 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
37356 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
37357?>
37358.literal off
37359
37360.makeindex "Options index" "option"
37361.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
37362.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
37363
37364
37365. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37366. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////